Clean docs for next release
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.86"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2015
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .new
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 .wen
381
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 very wide interest.
390
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 information.
408
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411 .cindex "change log"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429 directory are:
430
431 .table2 100pt
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .endtable
440
441 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
442 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
443 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
444
445
446
447 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
448 .cindex "web site"
449 .cindex "FTP site"
450 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
451 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
452 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
453 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
454 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
455 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
456
457 .cindex "wiki"
458 .cindex "FAQ"
459 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
460 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
461 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
462 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
463 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
464
465 .cindex Bugzilla
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469
470
471
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476 .table2 140pt
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 .endtable
482
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 via this web page:
489 .display
490 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491 .endd
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493 lists.
494
495 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
496 .cindex "training courses"
497 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
498 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
499 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
500 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
501
502 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503 .cindex "bug reports"
504 .cindex "reporting bugs"
505 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
507 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
509
510
511
512 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
513 .cindex "FTP site"
514 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
516 .display
517 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
518 .endd
519 This is mirrored by
520 .display
521 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
522 .endd
523 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531 .display
532 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
534 .endd
535 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
538
539 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
541 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
543 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
544 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
545 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
546 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
547 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
548 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
549 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
550
551 At time of last update, releases were being made by Phil Pennock and signed with
552 key &'0x403043153903637F'&, although that key is expected to be replaced in 2013.
553 A trust path from Nigel's key to Phil's can be observed at
554 &url(https://www.security.spodhuis.org/exim-trustpath).
555
556 Releases have also been authorized to be performed by Todd Lyons who signs with
557 key &'0xC4F4F94804D29EBA'&. A direct trust path exists between previous RE Phil
558 Pennock and Todd Lyons through a common associate.
559
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561 .display
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564 .endd
565 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
566 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
567 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568
569 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
570 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
571 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
572 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573 .display
574 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 .endd
579 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
580 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
581
582
583 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584 .ilist
585 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
586 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
587 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
588 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
589 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
590 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
591 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592 .next
593 .cindex "domainless addresses"
594 .cindex "address" "without domain"
595 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
596 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
597 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
598 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
599 arrival.
600 .next
601 .cindex "transport" "external"
602 .cindex "external transports"
603 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
604 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
605 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
606 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
607 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
608 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609 .next
610 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
611 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
612 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
613 other means.
614 .next
615 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
616 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
617 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
618 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
619 a number of common scanners are provided.
620 .endlist
621
622
623 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
624 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
625 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
626 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
627 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
628 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
629
630
631 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
632 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
633 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
634 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
635 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
636 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
637 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
638 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
639 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
640 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
641 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
642 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643
644 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
645 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
646 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
647 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
648
649
650
651 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
652 .cindex "terminology definitions"
653 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
654 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
655 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
656 below) by a blank line.
657
658 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
659 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
660 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
661 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
662 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
663 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
664 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
665 rise to further bounce messages.
666
667 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
668 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
669 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
670 otherwise.
671
672 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
673 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
674 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
675 until a later time.
676
677 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
678 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
679 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680
681 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
682 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
683 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
684 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
685 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
686 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
687 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
688 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689
690 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
691 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
692 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
693 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
694 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
695 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
696 line.
697
698 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
699 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
700 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
701 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
702 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703
704 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
705 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
706 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
707 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
708 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
709 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710
711 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
712 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
713 message's envelope.
714
715 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
716 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
717 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
718 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
719 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720
721 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
722 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
723 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
724 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
725 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726
727 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
728 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
729 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
730 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
731 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
732 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
733
734
735
736
737
738
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741
742 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
743 .cindex "incorporated code"
744 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
745 .cindex "PCRE"
746 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
747 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
748
749 .ilist
750 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
751 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
752 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
753 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
754 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
755 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756 .next
757 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
758 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
759 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
760 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
761 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
762 following statements:
763
764 .blockquote
765 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766
767 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
768 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
769 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770 version.
771 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
772 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
773 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
774 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
775 restrictions applied to it).
776 .endblockquote
777 .next
778 .cindex "SPA authentication"
779 .cindex "Samba project"
780 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
781 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
782 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
783 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
784 under the Gnu GPL.
785 .next
786 .cindex "Cyrus"
787 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
788 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
789 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
790 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
791 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
792 conditions expressed therein.
793
794 .blockquote
795 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796
797 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
798 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
799 are met:
800
801 .olist
802 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
803 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804 .next
805 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
806 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
807 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
808 distribution.
809 .next
810 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
811 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
812 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
813 details, please contact
814 .display
815 Office of Technology Transfer
816 Carnegie Mellon University
817 5000 Forbes Avenue
818 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
819 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
820 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
821 .endd
822 .next
823 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
824 acknowledgment:
825
826 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
827 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828
829 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
830 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
831 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
832 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
833 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
834 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
835 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
836 .endlist
837 .endblockquote
838
839 .next
840 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
841 .cindex "X-windows"
842 .cindex "Athena"
843 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
844 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
845 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
846 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
847
848 .blockquote
849 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
850 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
851
852 All Rights Reserved
853
854 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
855 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
856 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
857 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
858 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
859 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
860 software without specific, written prior permission.
861
862 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
863 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
864 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
865 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
866 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
867 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
868 SOFTWARE.
869 .endblockquote
870
871 .next
872 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
873 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
874 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
875 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
876 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
877 source code.
878
879 .next
880 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
881 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
882 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
883 .endlist
884
885
886
887
888
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891
892 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
893 "Receiving and delivering mail"
894
895
896 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
897 .cindex "design philosophy"
898 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
899 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
900 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
901 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
902 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
903 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
904
905
906 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
907 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
908 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
909 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
910 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
911 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
912 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
913
914 .ilist
915 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
916 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
917 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
918 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
919 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
920 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
921 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
922 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
923 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
924 error code.
925 .next
926 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
927 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928 .next
929 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
930 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
931 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
932 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933 .next
934 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
935 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
936 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
937 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
938 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939 .next
940 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
941 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
942 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943 .next
944 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
945 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
946 runs at the start of every delivery process.
947 .endlist
948
949
950
951 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
952 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
953 .cindex "Sieve filter"
954 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
955 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
956 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
957 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
958 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
959 of filtering are available:
960
961 .ilist
962 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
963 by RFC 3028.
964 .next
965 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
966 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
967 .endlist
968
969 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
970
971
972
973 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
974 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
975 .cindex "format" "of message id"
976 .cindex "id of message"
977 .cindex "base62"
978 .cindex "base36"
979 .cindex "Darwin"
980 .cindex "Cygwin"
981 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
982 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
983 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
984 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
985 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
986 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
987 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
988 not always case-sensitive.
989
990 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
991 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
992 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
993 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
994 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
995 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
996 somewhat eccentric:
997
998 .ilist
999 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1000 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1001 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1002 way of representing the date and time of day).
1003 .next
1004 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1005 received the message.
1006 .next
1007 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008 .olist
1009 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1010 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1011 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1012 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1013 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014 .next
1015 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1016 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1017 (1/100) of a second.
1018 .endlist
1019 .endlist
1020
1021 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1022 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1023 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1024 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1025 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026
1027
1028 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1029 .cindex "receiving mail"
1030 .cindex "message" "reception"
1031 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1032 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1033 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1034 there are several possibilities:
1035
1036 .ilist
1037 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1038 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1039 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040 .next
1041 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1042 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1043 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1044 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1045 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1046 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047 .next
1048 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1049 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1050 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1051 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1052 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053 .next
1054 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1055 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1056 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1057 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1058 .endlist
1059
1060
1061 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1062 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1063 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1064 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1065 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1066 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1067 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1068 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1069 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1070 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1071 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1072 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1073 users to change sender addresses.
1074
1075 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1076 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1077 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1078 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1079 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1080 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1081 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082
1083 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1084 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1085 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1086 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1087 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1088 message is received.
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1095 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1096 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1097 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1098 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1099 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1100 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1101 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102
1103 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1104 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1105 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1106 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1107 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1108 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1109 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1110 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1111 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1112 affect file system performance.
1113
1114 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1115 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1116 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1117 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1118 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119
1120 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1121 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1122 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1123 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1124 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1125 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1126 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1127 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1128 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1129 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1130 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1131 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1132
1133
1134
1135 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1136 .cindex "message" "life of"
1137 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1138 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1139 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1140 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1141 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1142 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1143 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144
1145 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1146 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1147 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1148 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1149 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1150 to be sent.
1151
1152 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1153 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1154 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1155 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1156 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1157
1158 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1159 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1160 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1161 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1162 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1163 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1164 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1165 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1166 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1167 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1168 systems.
1169
1170 .cindex "journal file"
1171 .cindex "file" "journal"
1172 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1173 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1174 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1175 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1176 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1177 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1178 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1179 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180
1181 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1182 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1183 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1184 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1185 deliveries caused by crashes.
1186
1187
1188
1189 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1190 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1193 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1194 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1195 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1196 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1197 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198
1199 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1200 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1201 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1202 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1203 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1204 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1205 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1206 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1207 the driver's features in general.
1208
1209 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1210 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1211 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1212 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1213 to be bounced.
1214
1215 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1216 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1217 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1218 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1219 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1220 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221
1222 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1223 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1224 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1225 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1226 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1227 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228
1229 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1230 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1231 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1232 configuration.
1233
1234 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1235 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1236 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1237 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1238 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1239 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1240 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1241 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1242 configured to fail the address.
1243
1244 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1245 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1246 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1247 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1248 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1249 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250
1251 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1252 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1253 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1254 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1255 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1256 the address is bounced.
1257
1258
1259
1260 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1261 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1262 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1263 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1264 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1265 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1266 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1267 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1268
1269 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1270 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1271 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1272 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1273 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1274 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1275 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1276 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1277
1278
1279
1280
1281 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1282 .cindex "router" "running details"
1283 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1284 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1285 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1286 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1287 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1288 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1289 the following:
1290
1291 .ilist
1292 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1293 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1294 original address ceases,
1295 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1296 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1297 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1298 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1299 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1300 end of routing.
1301
1302 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1303 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1304 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1305 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1306 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307 .next
1308 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1309 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1310 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1311 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1312 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313 .next
1314 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1315 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1316 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1317 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1318 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319 .next
1320 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1321 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1322 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323 .next
1324 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1325 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1326 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1327 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328 .next
1329 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1330 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1331 .endlist
1332
1333 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1334 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1335 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1336 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1337 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338
1339 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1340 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1341 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1342 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1343 facility for this purpose.
1344
1345
1346 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1347 .cindex "case of local parts"
1348 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1349 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1350 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1351 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1352 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1353 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1354 routed addresses are shown.
1355
1356
1357
1358 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1359 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1360 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1361 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1362 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1363 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1364
1365 .ilist
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1372 .next
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376 address.
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382 .next
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388 .next
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392 .next
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395 .next
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1398 .next
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1403 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1404 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1405 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1406 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1407 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1408 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1409 .next
1410 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$home$&"
1413 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1414 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1415 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1416 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1417 remaining preconditions.
1418 .next
1419 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1420 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1421 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1422 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1423 could lead to confusion.
1424 .next
1425 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1426 set of addresses that it defines.
1427 .next
1428 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1429 specified files is tested.
1430 .next
1431 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1432 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1433 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1434 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1435 .endlist
1436
1437
1438 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1439 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1440 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1441 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1442 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1443 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1444 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1445
1446
1447
1448 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1449 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1450 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1451
1452 .ilist
1453 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1454 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1455 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1456 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1457 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1458 filtering'&.
1459 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1460 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1461
1462 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1463 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1464 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1465 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1466 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1467 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1468 filter.
1469 .next
1470 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1471 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1472 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1473 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1474 processed entirely independently of each other.
1475 .next
1476 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1477 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1478 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1479 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1480 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1481 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1482 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1483 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1484 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1485 .next
1486 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1487 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1488 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1489 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1490 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1491 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1492 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1493 addresses to the same domain.
1494 .next
1495 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1496 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1497 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1498 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1499 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1500 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1501 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1502 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1503 .next
1504 .cindex "queue runner"
1505 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1506 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1507 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1508 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1509 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1510 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1511 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1512 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1513 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1514 .next
1515 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1516 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1517 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1518 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1519 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1520 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1521 .next
1522 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1523 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1524 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1525 messages to other addresses.
1526 .next
1527 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1528 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1529 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1530 &'deferred'&.
1531 .next
1532 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1533 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1534 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1535 .endlist
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1541 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1542 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1543 .cindex "queue runner"
1544 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1545 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1546 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1547 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1548 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1549 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1550 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1551 passed its retry time.
1552 You can run several queue runners at once.
1553
1554 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1555 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1556 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1557 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1558 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1559 as permanent.
1560
1561
1562
1563 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1564 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1565 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1566 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1567 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1568 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1569 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1570 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1571 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1572 also apply.
1573
1574 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1575 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1576 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1577 deferred,
1578 .cindex "hints database"
1579 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1580 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1581 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1582 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1583 one connection.
1584
1585
1586
1587 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1588 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1589 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1590 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1591 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1592 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1593 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1594 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1595 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1596 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1597 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1598
1599 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1600 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1601 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1602 automatically.
1603
1604 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1605 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1606 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1607 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1608 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1609 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1610 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1611 of the list.
1612
1613
1614
1615 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1616 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1617 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1618 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1619 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1620 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1621 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1622 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1623
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630
1631 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1632 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1633
1634 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1635 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1636 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1637 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1638
1639 .table2 140pt
1640 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1641 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1642 documented"
1643 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1644 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1645 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1646 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1647 instructions"
1648 .endtable
1649
1650 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1651 following subdirectories are created:
1652
1653 .table2 140pt
1654 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1655 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1656 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1657 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1658 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1659 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1660 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1661 .endtable
1662
1663 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1664 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1665 that may be useful to some sites.
1666
1667
1668 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1669 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1670 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1671 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1672 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1673 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1674 system.
1675 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1676 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1677 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1678 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1679 overridden if necessary.
1680
1681
1682 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1683 .cindex "PCRE library"
1684 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1685 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1686 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1687 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1688 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1689 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1690 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1691 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1692 If your operating system has no
1693 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1694 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1695 More information on PCRE is available at &url(http://www.pcre.org/).
1696
1697 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1698 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1699 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1700 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1701 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1702 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1703 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1704
1705 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1706 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1707 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1708 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1709 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1710 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1711 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1712 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1713
1714 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1715 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1716 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1717 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1718 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1719 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1720 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1721 Berkeley DB library.
1722
1723 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1724 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1725 possibilities:
1726
1727 .olist
1728 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1729 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1730 .next
1731 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1732 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1733 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1734 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1735 file name is used unmodified.
1736 .next
1737 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1738 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1739 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1740 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1741 .next
1742 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1743 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1744 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1745 .next
1746 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1747 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1748 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1749 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1750 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1751 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1752 .next
1753 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1754 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1755 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1756 operates on a single file.
1757 .endlist
1758
1759 .cindex "USE_DB"
1760 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1761 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1762 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1763 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1764 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1765 .code
1766 USE_DB=yes
1767 .endd
1768 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1769 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1770
1771 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1772 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1773 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1774 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1775 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1776 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1777
1778 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1779 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1780 in one of these lines:
1781 .code
1782 DBMLIB = -ldb
1783 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1784 .endd
1785 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1786 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1787 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1788 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1789 this example:
1790 .code
1791 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1792 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1793 .endd
1794 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1795 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1796
1797
1798
1799 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1800 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1801 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1802 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1803 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1804 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1805 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1806 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1807 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1808 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1809 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1810 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1811
1812 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1813 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1814 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1815 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1816 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1817 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1818
1819 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1820 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1821 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1822 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1823 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1824 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1825 be logged.
1826
1827 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1828 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1829 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1830 facilities, you need to set
1831 .code
1832 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1833 .endd
1834 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1835 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1836
1837
1838 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1839 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1840 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1841 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1842 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1843 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1844 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1845
1846 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1847 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1848 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1849 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1850 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1851 do this.
1852
1853
1854
1855 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1856 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1857 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1858 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1859 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1860 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1861 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1862 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1863 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1864 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1865
1866 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1867 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1868 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1869 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1870 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1871 .code
1872 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1873 .endd
1874 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1875
1876
1877
1878 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1879 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1880 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1881 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1882 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1883 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1884 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1885 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1886 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1887 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1888 line option).
1889
1890 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1891 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1892 implementing SSL.
1893
1894 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1895 .code
1896 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1897 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1898 .endd
1899 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1900 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1901 .code
1902 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1903 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1904 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1905 .endd
1906 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1907 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1908 .code
1909 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1910 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1911 .endd
1912 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1913 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1914 .code
1915 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1916 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1917 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1918 .endd
1919 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1920 library and include files. For example:
1921 .code
1922 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1923 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1924 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1925 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1926 .endd
1927 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1928 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1929 .code
1930 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1933 .endd
1934
1935 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1936 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1937 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1938
1939
1940
1941
1942 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1943
1944 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1945 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1946 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1947 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1948 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1949 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1950 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1951 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1952 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1953 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1954 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1955 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1956 you might have
1957 .code
1958 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1959 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1960 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1961 .endd
1962 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1963 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1964 .code
1965 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1966 .endd
1967 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1968 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1969 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1970 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1971 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1972 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1973 further details.
1974
1975
1976 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1977 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1978 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1979 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1980 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1981 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1982 library files.
1983
1984 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1985 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1986 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1987 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1988 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1989 Exim used to
1990 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1991 withdrawn.
1992
1993
1994
1995 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
1996 .cindex "lookup modules"
1997 .cindex "dynamic modules"
1998 .cindex ".so building"
1999 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2000 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2001 on demand.
2002 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2003 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2004 dependencies.
2005 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2006
2007 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2008 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2009 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2010 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2011 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2012 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2013
2014 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2015 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2016 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2017 on demand:
2018 .code
2019 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2020 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2021 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2022 .endd
2023
2024
2025 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2026 .cindex "build directory"
2027 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2028 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2029 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2030 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2031 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2032 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2033 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2034
2035 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2036 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2037 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2038 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2039 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2040 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2041 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2042 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2043
2044 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2045 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2046 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2047
2048
2049
2050 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2051 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2052 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2053 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2054 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2055 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2056 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2057 .code
2058 FULLECHO='' make -e
2059 .endd
2060 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2061 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2062 given in addition to the short output.
2063
2064
2065
2066 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2067 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2068 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2069 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2070 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2071 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2072 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2073 order:
2074 .display
2075 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2076 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2077 &_Local/Makefile_&
2078 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2079 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2080 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2081 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2082 .endd
2083 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2084 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2085 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2086 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2087 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2088 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2089 and are often not needed.
2090
2091 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2092 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2093 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2094 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2095 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2096 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2097 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2098 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2099 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2100
2101
2102 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2103 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2104 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2105 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2106 default values are.
2107
2108
2109 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2110 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2111 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2112 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2113 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2114 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2115 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2116 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2117 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2118 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2119 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2120 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2121 containing the lines
2122 .code
2123 CC=cc
2124 CFLAGS=-std1
2125 .endd
2126 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2127 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2128
2129 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2130 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2131 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2132
2133
2134 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2135 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2136 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2137 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2138 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2139 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2140 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2141 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2142 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2143 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2144 .code
2145 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2146 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2147 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2148 .endd
2149 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2150 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2151 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2152 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2153 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2154 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2155 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2156 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2157 errors.
2158
2159 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2160 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2161 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2162 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2163 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2164 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2165 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2166 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2167 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2168 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2169 syntax. For instance:
2170 .code
2171 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2172 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2173 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2174 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2175 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2176 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2177 .endd
2178
2179 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2180 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2181 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2182 .code
2183 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2184 .endd
2185 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2186 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2187
2188 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2189 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2190 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2191 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2192 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2193 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2194 .code
2195 X11=/usr/X11R6
2196 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2197 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2198 .endd
2199 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2200 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2201 .code
2202 X11=/usr/openwin
2203 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2204 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2205 .endd
2206 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2207 definition of all three of these variables into your
2208 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2209
2210 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2211 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2212 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2213 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2214 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2215
2216 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2217 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2218 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2219 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2220 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2221 libraries.
2222
2223 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2224 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2225 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2226 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2227 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2228
2229
2230 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2231 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2232 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2233 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2234 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2235 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2236 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2237 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2238
2239
2240
2241 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2242 .cindex "building Eximon"
2243 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2244 where the files that are involved are
2245 .display
2246 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2247 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2248 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2249 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2250 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2251 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2252 .endd
2253 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2254 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2255 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2256 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2257 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2258 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2259 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2260 .ecindex IIDbuex
2261
2262
2263 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2264 .cindex "installing Exim"
2265 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2266 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2267 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2268 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2269 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2270 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2271 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2272 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2273 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2274 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2275 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2276 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2277
2278 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2279 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2280 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2281 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2282 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2283 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2284 alternative files, no default is installed.
2285
2286 .cindex "system aliases file"
2287 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2288 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2289 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2290 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2291 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2292 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2293 and outputs a comment to the user.
2294
2295 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2296 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2297 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2298 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2299 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2300
2301 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2302 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2303 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2304 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2305 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2306 over SMTP.
2307
2308 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2309 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2310 command such as
2311 .code
2312 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2313 .endd
2314 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2315 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2316 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2317 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2318 but this usage is deprecated.
2319
2320 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2321 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2322 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2323 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2324 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2325 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2326
2327 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2328 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2329 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2330 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2331 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2332 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2333 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2334
2335 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2336 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2337 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2338 command:
2339 .code
2340 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2341 .endd
2342 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2343 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2344 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2345 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2346 command:
2347 .code
2348 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2349 .endd
2350 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2351 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2352
2353 .ilist
2354 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2355 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2356 .next
2357 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2358 installed binary.
2359 .endlist
2360
2361 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2362 .code
2363 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2364 .endd
2365 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2366 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2367 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2368 .code
2369 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2370 .endd
2371
2372
2373
2374 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2375 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2376 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2377 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2378 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2379 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2380
2381 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2382 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2383 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2384
2385
2386
2387 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2388 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2389 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2390 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2391 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2392 necessary.
2393
2394
2395
2396
2397 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2398 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2399 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2400 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2401 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2402 .code
2403 exim -bV
2404 .endd
2405 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2406 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2407 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2408 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2409 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2410 example,
2411 .display
2412 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2413 .endd
2414 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2415 .display
2416 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2417 .endd
2418 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2419 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2420 user agent. For example:
2421 .code
2422 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2423 From: user@your.domain.example
2424 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2425 Subject: Testing Exim
2426
2427 This is a test message.
2428 ^D
2429 .endd
2430 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2431 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2432 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2433
2434 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2435 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2436 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2437 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2438 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2439 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2440 .display
2441 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2442 .endd
2443 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2444 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2445 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2446 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2447 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2448
2449 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2450 .cindex "lock files"
2451 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2452 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2453 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2454 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2455 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2456 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2457 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2458 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2459 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2460 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2461 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2462 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2463
2464 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2465 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2466 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2467 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2468 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2469 incoming SMTP mail.
2470
2471 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2472 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2473 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2474 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2475 production version.
2476
2477
2478 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2479 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2480 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2481 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2482 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2483 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2484 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2485 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2486 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2487 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2488 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2489 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2490 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2491
2492 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2493 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2494 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2495 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2496 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2497 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2498 as follows:
2499 .code
2500 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2501 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2502 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2503 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2504 .endd
2505 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2506 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2507 favourite user agent.
2508
2509 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2510 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2511 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2512 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2513 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2514 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2515
2516
2517
2518 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2519 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2520 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2521 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2522 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2523 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2524 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2525 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2526 configuration file.
2527
2528
2529
2530
2531 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2532 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2533 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2534 .code
2535 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2536 .endd
2537 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2538 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2539 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2540 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2541 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2542 .code
2543 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2544 .endd
2545 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2546
2547 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2548 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2549 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2550
2551
2552
2553
2554 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2555 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2556
2557 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2558 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2559 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2560 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2561 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2562 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2563 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2564 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2565 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2566
2567
2568 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2569 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2570 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2571 were present before any other options.
2572 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2573 standard output.
2574 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2575 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2576 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2577
2578 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2579 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2580 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2581 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2582 format.
2583
2584 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2585 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2586 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2587 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2588
2589 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2590 .cindex "queue runner"
2591 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2592 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2593 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2594
2595 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2596 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2597 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2598 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2599 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2600 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2601 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2602 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2603
2604
2605 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2606 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2607 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2608 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2609 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2610 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2611
2612 .ilist
2613 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2614 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2615 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2616 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2617 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2618 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2619
2620 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2621 .cindex "envelope sender"
2622 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2623 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2624 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2625 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2626 users to set envelope senders.
2627
2628 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2629 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2630 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2631 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2632 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2633
2634 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2635 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2636 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2637 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2638 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2639 that are available to trusted users.
2640 .next
2641 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2642 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2643 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2644 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2645 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2646
2647 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2648 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2649 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2650 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2651
2652 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2653 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2654 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2655 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2656
2657 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2658 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2659 false.
2660 .endlist
2661
2662
2663 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2664 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2665 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2666 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2667
2668
2669
2670
2671 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2672 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2673 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2674 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2675 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2676 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2677 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2678 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2679
2680 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2681 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2682 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2683 . creates a man page for the options.
2684 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2685
2686 .literal xml
2687 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2688 .literal off
2689
2690
2691 .vlist
2692 .vitem &%--%&
2693 .oindex "--"
2694 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2695 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2696 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2697 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2698
2699 .vitem &%--help%&
2700 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2701 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2702 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2703 no arguments.
2704
2705 .vitem &%--version%&
2706 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2707 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2708 displayed.
2709
2710 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2711 &%-Am%&
2712 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2713 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2714 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2715 ignored by Exim.
2716
2717 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2718 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2719 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2720 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2721 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2722 clean; it ignores this option.
2723
2724 .vitem &%-bd%&
2725 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2726 .cindex "daemon"
2727 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2728 .cindex "queue runner"
2729 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2730 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2731 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2732
2733 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2734 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2735 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2736 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2737
2738 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2739 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2740 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2741 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2742
2743 When a listening daemon
2744 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2745 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2746 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2747 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2748 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2749 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2750 running as root.
2751
2752 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2753 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2754 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2755
2756 The SIGHUP signal
2757 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2758 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2759 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2760 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2761 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2762 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2763 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2764 because these are reread each time they are used.
2765
2766 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2767 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2768 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2769 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2770
2771 .vitem &%-be%&
2772 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2773 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2774 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2775 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2776 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2777 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2778 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2779
2780 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2781 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2782 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2783 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2784 test data. A line history is supported.
2785
2786 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2787 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2788 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2789 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2790 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2791 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2792 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2793
2794 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2795 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2796 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2797 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2798
2799 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2800 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2801 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2802 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2803 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2804 of a file. For example:
2805 .code
2806 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2807 .endd
2808 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2809 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2810 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2811 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2812 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2813 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2814 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2815 &%-be%&).
2816
2817 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2818 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2819 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2820 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2821 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2822 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2823 system filters are recognized.
2824
2825 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2826 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2827 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2828 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2829 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2830 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2831 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2832 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2833 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2834 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2835 supplied.
2836
2837 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2838 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2839 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2840 .code
2841 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2842 .endd
2843 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2844 variables that are used by the user filter.
2845
2846 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2847 .code
2848 # Exim filter
2849 # Sieve filter
2850 .endd
2851 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2852 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2853 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2854 redirection lists.
2855
2856 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2857 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2858 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2859 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2860
2861 When testing a filter file,
2862 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2863 .cindex "envelope sender"
2864 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2865 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2866 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2867 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2868 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2869 options).
2870
2871 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2872 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2873 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2874 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2875 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2876 &$qualify_domain$&.
2877
2878 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2879 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2880 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2881 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2882 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2883 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2884 actually being delivered.
2885
2886 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2887 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2888 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2889 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2890 prefix.
2891
2892 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2893 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2894 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2895 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2896 suffix.
2897
2898 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2899 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2900 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2901 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2902 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2903 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2904 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2905 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2906 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2907 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2908 after a full stop. For example:
2909 .code
2910 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2911 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2912 .endd
2913 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2914 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2915 conversion to the canonical form is
2916 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2917
2918 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2919 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2920 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2921 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2922 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2923
2924 &*Warning 1*&:
2925 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2926 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2927 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2928 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2929 connection.
2930
2931 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2932 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2933 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2934
2935 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2936 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2937 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2938 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2939 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2940 session were authenticated.
2941
2942 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2943 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2944 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2945
2946 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2947 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2948 specialized SMTP test program such as
2949 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2950
2951 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2952 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2953 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2954 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2955 updating the callout cache database.
2956
2957 .vitem &%-bi%&
2958 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2959 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2960 .cindex "building alias file"
2961 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2962 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2963 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2964 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2965 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2966 recognized.
2967
2968 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2969 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2970 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2971 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2972 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2973 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2974 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2975
2976 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2977 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
2978 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2979 .cindex "querying exim information"
2980 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2981 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2982 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
2983 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
2984 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
2985
2986 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
2987 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
2988 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
2989 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
2990 recognised DSCP names.
2991
2992 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
2993 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
2994 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
2995 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
2996 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
2997 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
2998 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
2999 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3000 way to guarantee a correct response.
3001
3002 .vitem &%-bm%&
3003 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3004 .cindex "local message reception"
3005 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3006 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3007 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3008 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3009 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3010 if no other conflicting option is present.
3011
3012 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3013 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3014 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3015 suppressing this for special cases.
3016
3017 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3018 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3019
3020 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3021 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3022 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3023
3024 The format
3025 .cindex "message" "format"
3026 .cindex "format" "message"
3027 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3028 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3029 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3030 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3031 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3032 .code
3033 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3034 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3035 .endd
3036 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3037 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3038 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3039 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3040 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3041
3042 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3043 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3044 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3045 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3046 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3047
3048 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3049 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3050 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3051 .cindex "malware scan test"
3052 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
3053 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3054 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3055 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3056 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3057 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3058
3059 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3060 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3061 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3062 This option requires admin privileges.
3063
3064 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3065 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3066 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3067
3068 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3069 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3070 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3071 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3072 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3073 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3074 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3075 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3076 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3077
3078 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3079 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3080 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3081 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3082 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3083
3084 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3085 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3086 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3087 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3088
3089
3090 .vitem &%-bP%&
3091 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3092 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3093 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3094 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3095 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3096 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3097 arguments, for example:
3098 .code
3099 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3100 .endd
3101 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3102 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3103 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3104 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3105 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3106 users, the output is as in this example:
3107 .code
3108 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3109 .endd
3110 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3111 configuration file is output.
3112 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3113 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3114
3115 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3116 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3117 name will not be output.
3118
3119 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3120 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3121 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3122 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3123 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3124 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3125 written directly into the spool directory.
3126
3127 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3128 .code
3129 exim -bP +local_domains
3130 .endd
3131 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3132 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3133
3134 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3135 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3136 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3137 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3138 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3139 that driver are output. For example:
3140 .code
3141 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3142 .endd
3143 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3144 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3145 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3146 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3147 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3148 &%authenticators%&.
3149
3150 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3151 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3152 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3153 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3154 The output format is one item per line.
3155
3156 .vitem &%-bp%&
3157 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3158 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3159 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3160 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3161 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3162 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3163 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3164 to allow any user to see the queue.
3165
3166 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3167 .code
3168 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3169 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3170 <other addresses>
3171 .endd
3172 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3173 .cindex "size" "of message"
3174 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3175 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3176 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3177 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3178 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3179 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3180 before the sender address.
3181
3182 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3183 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3184 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3185
3186 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3187 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3188 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3189 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3190 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3191 complete.
3192
3193
3194 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3195 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3196 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3197 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3198 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3199 of just &"D"&.
3200
3201
3202 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3203 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3204 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3205 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3206 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3207 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3208
3209
3210 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3211 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3212 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3213 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3214 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3215 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3216
3217 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3218 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3219 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3220
3221 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3222 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3223 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3224
3225
3226 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3227 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3228 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3229 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3230 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3231 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3232
3233
3234 .vitem &%-brt%&
3235 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3236 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3237 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3238 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3239 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3240 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3241 .code
3242 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3243 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3244 .endd
3245 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3246 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3247 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3248 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3249 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3250 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3251 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3252 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3253 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3254 .code
3255 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3256 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3257 .endd
3258
3259 .vitem &%-brw%&
3260 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3261 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3262 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3263 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3264 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3265 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3266 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3267 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3268
3269 .vitem &%-bS%&
3270 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3271 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3272 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3273 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3274 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3275 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3276 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3277 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3278 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3279 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3280
3281 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3282 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3283 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3284
3285 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3286 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3287 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3288 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3289
3290 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3291 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3292 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3293
3294 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3295 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3296 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3297 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3298 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3299
3300 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3301 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3302
3303 .vitem &%-bs%&
3304 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3305 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3306 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3307 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3308 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3309 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3310 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3311 messages to the MTA.
3312
3313 In
3314 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3315 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3316 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3317 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3318 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3319 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3320 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3321
3322 .cindex "inetd"
3323 The
3324 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3325 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3326 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3327 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3328 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3329 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3330 the listening daemon.
3331
3332 .vitem &%-bt%&
3333 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3334 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3335 .cindex "address" "testing"
3336 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3337 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3338 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3339 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3340 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3341
3342 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3343 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3344
3345 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3346 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3347 security issues.
3348
3349 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3350 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3351 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3352 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3353 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3354 program.
3355
3356 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3357 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3358 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3359 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3360
3361 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3362 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3363 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3364 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3365 always shown.
3366
3367 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3368 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3369 message,
3370 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3371 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3372 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3373 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3374 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3375 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3376 doing such tests.
3377
3378 .vitem &%-bV%&
3379 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3380 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3381 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3382 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3383 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3384 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3385 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3386
3387 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3388 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3389 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3390 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3391 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3392 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3393 dynamic testing facilities.
3394
3395 .vitem &%-bv%&
3396 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3397 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3398 .cindex "address" "verification"
3399 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3400 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3401 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3402 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3403 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3404 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3405
3406 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3407 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3408 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3409
3410 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3411 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3412
3413 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3414 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3415 security issues.
3416
3417 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3418 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3419 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3420 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3421 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3422
3423 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3424 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3425 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3426 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3427 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3428 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3429 to succeed.
3430
3431 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3432 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3433 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3434
3435 The
3436 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3437 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3438 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3439 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3440
3441 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3442 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3443 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3444 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3445
3446 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3447 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3448 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3449 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3450 might happen.
3451
3452 .vitem &%-bw%&
3453 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3454 .cindex "daemon"
3455 .cindex "inetd"
3456 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3457 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3458 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3459 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3460
3461 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3462 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3463 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3464 each port only when the first connection is received.
3465
3466 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3467 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3468
3469 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3470 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3471 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3472 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3473 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3474 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3475 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3476 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3477 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3478 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3479 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3480
3481 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3482 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3483 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3484 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3485 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3486 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3487 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3488 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3489 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3490
3491 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3492 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3493 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3494 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3495 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3496 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3497 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3498
3499 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3500 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3501 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3502 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3503 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3504 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3505 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3506
3507 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3508 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3509 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3510 configuration file.
3511
3512 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3513 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3514 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3515 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3516 specified by this option.
3517
3518
3519 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3520 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3521 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3522 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3523 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3524 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3525 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3526 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3527
3528 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3529 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3530 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3531 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3532 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3533 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3534 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3535
3536 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3537 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3538 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3539 synonymous:
3540 .code
3541 exim -DABC ...
3542 exim -DABC= ...
3543 .endd
3544 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3545 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3546 example:
3547 .code
3548 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3549 .endd
3550 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3551
3552
3553 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3554 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3555 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3556 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3557 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3558 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3559 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3560 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3561 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3562 return code.
3563
3564 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3565 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3566 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3567 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3568 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3569 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3570 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3571 are:
3572 .display
3573 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3574 &`auth `& authenticators
3575 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3576 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3577 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3578 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3579 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3580 &`filter `& filter handling
3581 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3582 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3583 &`ident `& ident lookup
3584 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3585 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3586 &`load `& system load checks
3587 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3588 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3589 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3590 &`memory `& memory handling
3591 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3592 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3593 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3594 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3595 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3596 &`retry `& retry handling
3597 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3598 &`route `& address routing
3599 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3600 &`tls `& TLS logic
3601 &`transport `& transports
3602 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3603 &`verify `& address verification logic
3604 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3605 .endd
3606 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3607 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3608 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3609 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3610 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3611 turn everything off.
3612
3613 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3614 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3615 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3616 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3617 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3618 rather than stderr.
3619
3620 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3621 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3622 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3623 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3624 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3625 run in parallel.
3626
3627 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3628 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3629 in processing.
3630
3631 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3632 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3633
3634 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3635 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3636 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3637 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3638 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3639 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3640
3641 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3642 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3643 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3644 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3645 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3646
3647 .vitem &%-E%&
3648 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3649 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3650 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3651 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3652 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3653 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3654 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3655 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3656 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3657
3658 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3659 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3660 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3661 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3662 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3663 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3664
3665 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3666 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3667 .cindex "sender" "name"
3668 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3669 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3670 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3671 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3672 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3673 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3674
3675 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3676 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3677 .cindex "sender" "address"
3678 .cindex "address" "sender"
3679 .cindex "trusted users"
3680 .cindex "envelope sender"
3681 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3682 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3683 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3684 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3685 users to use it.
3686
3687 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3688 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3689 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3690 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3691 domain.
3692
3693 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3694 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3695 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3696 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3697 examples of shell commands:
3698 .code
3699 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3700 exim -f "" user@domain
3701 .endd
3702 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3703 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3704 &%-bv%& options.
3705
3706 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3707 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3708 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3709 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3710
3711 White
3712 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3713 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3714 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3715 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3716 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3717 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3718
3719 .vitem &%-G%&
3720 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3721 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3722 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3723 .code
3724 control = suppress_local_fixups
3725 .endd
3726 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3727 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3728 in future.
3729
3730 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3731 this option.
3732
3733 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3734 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3735 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3736 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3737 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3738 headers.)
3739
3740 .vitem &%-i%&
3741 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3742 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3743 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3744 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3745 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3746 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3747 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3748
3749 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3750 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3751 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3752 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3753 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3754 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3755 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3756 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3757
3758 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3759
3760 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3761 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3762 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3763 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3764 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3765 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3766 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3767 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3768 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3769
3770 Retry
3771 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3772 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3773 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3774 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3775 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3776 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3777
3778 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3779 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3780 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3781 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3782
3783 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3784 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3785 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3786 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3787 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3788 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3789 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3790 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3791 can be used only by an admin user.
3792
3793 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3794 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3795 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3796 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3797 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3798 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3799 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3800 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3801 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3802 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3803 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3804
3805 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3806 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3807 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3808 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3809 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3810
3811 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3812 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3813 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3814 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3815 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3816
3817 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3818 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3819 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3820 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3821 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3822
3823 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3824 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3825 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3826 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3827 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3828 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3829 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3830 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3831
3832 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3833 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3834 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3835 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3836 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3837 connection.
3838
3839 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3840 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3841 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3842 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3843 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3844
3845 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3846 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3847 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3848 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3849 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3850 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3851 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3852 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3853 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3854 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3855 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3856 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3857 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3858 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3859 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3860
3861 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3862 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3863 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3864 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3865 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3866 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3867 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3868 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3869 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3870 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3871
3872 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3873 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3874 .cindex "freezing messages"
3875 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3876 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3877 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3878 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3879 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3880 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3881 user.
3882
3883 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3884 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3885 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3886 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3887 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3888 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3889 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3890 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3891 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3892 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3893 user.
3894
3895 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3896 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3897 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3898 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3899 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3900 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3901 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3902
3903 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3904 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3905 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3906 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3907 .cindex "removing recipients"
3908 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3909 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3910 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3911 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3912 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3913 can be used only by an admin user.
3914
3915 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3916 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3917 .cindex "removing messages"
3918 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3919 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3920 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3921 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3922 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3923 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3924 placed on the queue.
3925
3926 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3927 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3928 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3929 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3930 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3931 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3932 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3933 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3934 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3935 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3936 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3937
3938 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3939 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3940 .cindex "thawing messages"
3941 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3942 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3943 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3944 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3945 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3946 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3947 by an admin user.
3948
3949 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3950 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3951 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3952 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3953 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3954 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3955
3956 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3957 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3958 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3959 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
3960 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3961 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3962 only by an admin user.
3963
3964 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3965 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3966 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3967 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3968 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3969 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3970 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3971
3972 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3973 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3974 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3975 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3976 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3977 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3978
3979 .vitem &%-m%&
3980 .oindex "&%-m%&"
3981 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3982 treats it that way too.
3983
3984 .vitem &%-N%&
3985 .oindex "&%-N%&"
3986 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3987 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3988 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3989 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3990 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3991 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3992 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3993 than &"=>"&.
3994
3995 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3996 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3997 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3998 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3999 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4000 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4001 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4002 for that message.
4003
4004 .vitem &%-n%&
4005 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4006 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4007 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4008 When combined with &%-bP%& it suppresses the name of an option from being output.
4009
4010 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4011 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4012 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4013 Exim.
4014
4015 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4016 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4017 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4018 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4019 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4020 description above.
4021
4022 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4023 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4024 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4025 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4026 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4027 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4028 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4029 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4030
4031 .vitem &%-odb%&
4032 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4033 .cindex "background delivery"
4034 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4035 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4036 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4037 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4038 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4039 processes to finish.
4040
4041 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4042 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4043 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4044 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4045
4046 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4047 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4048 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4049 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4050
4051 .vitem &%-odf%&
4052 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4053 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4054 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4055 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4056 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4057 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4058 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4059
4060 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4061 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4062 during deliveries.
4063
4064 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4065 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4066
4067 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4068 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4069 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4070 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4071
4072
4073 .vitem &%-odi%&
4074 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4075 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4076 Sendmail.
4077
4078 .vitem &%-odq%&
4079 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4080 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4081 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4082 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4083 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4084 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4085 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4086 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4087 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4088 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4089 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4090 forces queueing.
4091
4092 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4093 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4094 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4095 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4096 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4097 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4098 configuration file is in effect.
4099
4100 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4101 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4102 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4103 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4104 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4105 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4106 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4107 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4108 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4109 &%-qq%& option.
4110
4111 .vitem &%-oee%&
4112 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4113 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4114 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4115 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4116 message.
4117
4118 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4119 Provided
4120 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4121 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4122 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4123 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4124
4125 .vitem &%-oem%&
4126 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4127 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4128 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4129 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4130 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4131 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4132
4133 .vitem &%-oep%&
4134 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4135 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4136 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4137 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4138 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4139 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4140
4141 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4142 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4143 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4144 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4145 effect as &%-oep%&.
4146
4147 .vitem &%-oew%&
4148 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4149 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4150 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4151 effect as &%-oem%&.
4152
4153 .vitem &%-oi%&
4154 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4155 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4156 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4157 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4158 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4159 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4160 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4161
4162 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4163 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4164 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4165
4166 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4167 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4168 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4169 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4170 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4171 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4172 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4173 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4174
4175 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4176 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4177 .code
4178 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4179 .endd
4180 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4181 followed by a colon and the port number:
4182 .code
4183 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4184 .endd
4185 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4186 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4187 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4188 whichever one is last.
4189
4190 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4191 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4192 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4193 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4194 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4195 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4196 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4197 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4198
4199 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4200 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4201 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4202 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4203 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4204 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4205 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4206 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4207
4208 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4209 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4210 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4211 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4212 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4213 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4214 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4215 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4216 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4217 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4218
4219 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4220 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4221 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4222 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4223 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4224 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4225 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4226
4227 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4228 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4229 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4230 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4231 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4232 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4233 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4234 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4235 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4236
4237 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4238 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4239 is sending the bounce.
4240
4241 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4242 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4243 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4244 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4245 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4246 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4247 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4248 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4249 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4250 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4251 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4252 be set by &%-oMr%&.
4253
4254 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4255 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4256 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4257 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4258 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4259 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4260 uses the name it is given.
4261
4262 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4263 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4264 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4265 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4266 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4267 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4268 used, when there is no default.
4269
4270 .vitem &%-om%&
4271 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4272 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4273 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4274 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4275 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4276
4277 .vitem &%-oo%&
4278 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4279 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4280 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4281 whatever that means.
4282
4283 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4284 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4285 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4286 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4287 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4288 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4289 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4290 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4291 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4292
4293 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4294 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4295 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4296 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4297 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4298 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4299 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4300
4301 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4302 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4303 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4304 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4305 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4306 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4307 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4308 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4309
4310 .vitem &%-ov%&
4311 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4312 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4313
4314 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4315 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4316 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4317 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4318 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4319 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4320 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4321 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4322 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4323 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4324
4325 .vitem &%-pd%&
4326 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4327 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4328 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4329 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4330 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4331 needed.
4332
4333 .vitem &%-ps%&
4334 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4335 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4336 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4337 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4338 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4339 started.
4340
4341 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4342 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4343 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4344 .display
4345 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4346 .endd
4347 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4348 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4349 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4350 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4351 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4352
4353 .vitem &%-q%&
4354 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4355 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4356 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4357 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4358 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4359 and &%-S%& options).
4360
4361 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4362 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4363 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4364 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4365 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4366 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4367
4368 If
4369 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4370 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4371 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4372 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4373 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4374 proceeding.
4375
4376 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4377 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4378 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4379 this to be repeated periodically.
4380
4381 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4382 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4383 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4384 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4385
4386 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4387 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4388 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4389
4390 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4391 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4392 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4393 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4394
4395 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4396 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4397 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4398 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4399 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4400 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4401 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4402 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4403 transports are run.
4404
4405 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4406 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4407 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4408 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4409 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4410 delivered down a single SMTP
4411 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4412 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4413 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4414 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4415 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4416 intermittently.
4417
4418 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4419 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4420 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4421 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4422 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4423 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4424 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4425
4426 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4427 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4428 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4429 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4430 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4431 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4432 their retry times are tried.
4433
4434 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4435 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4436 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4437 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4438 frozen or not.
4439
4440 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4441 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4442 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4443 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4444 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4445 for later delivery.
4446
4447 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4448 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4449 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4450 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4451 starting message id. For example:
4452 .code
4453 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4454 .endd
4455 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4456 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4457 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4458 .code
4459 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4460 .endd
4461 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4462 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4463 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4464 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4465 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4466 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4467
4468 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4469 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4470 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4471 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4472 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4473 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4474 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4475 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4476 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4477 .code
4478 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4479 .endd
4480 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4481 process every 30 minutes.
4482
4483 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4484 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4485
4486 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4487 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4488 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4489 compatibility.
4490
4491 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4492 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4493 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4494
4495 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4496 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4497 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4498 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4499 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4500 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4501 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4502 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4503 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4504
4505 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4506 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4507 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4508 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4509 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4510 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4511
4512 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4513 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4514 .code
4515 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4516 .endd
4517 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4518 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4519 applied to each queue run.
4520
4521 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4522 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4523 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4524 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4525 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4526 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4527 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4528 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4529 address will be skipped.
4530
4531 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4532 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4533 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4534 &'ff'& is present.
4535
4536 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4537 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4538 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4539 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4540 an arbitrary command instead.
4541
4542 .vitem &%-r%&
4543 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4544 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4545
4546 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4547 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4548 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4549 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4550 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4551 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4552 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4553 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4554
4555 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4556 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4557 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4558 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4559 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4560
4561 .vitem &%-t%&
4562 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4563 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4564 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4565 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4566 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4567 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4568 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4569 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4570 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4571 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4572
4573 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4574 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4575 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4576 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4577 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4578 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4579 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4580 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4581 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4582 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4583 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4584
4585 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4586 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4587 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4588 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4589 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4590 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4591
4592 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4593 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4594 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4595 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4596 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4597 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4598 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4599 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4600 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4601
4602 .vitem &%-ti%&
4603 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4604 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4605 compatibility with Sendmail.
4606
4607 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4608 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4609 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4610 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4611 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4612 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4613 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4614 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4615
4616
4617 .vitem &%-U%&
4618 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4619 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4620 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4621 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4622 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4623 set. Exim ignores this option.
4624
4625 .vitem &%-v%&
4626 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4627 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4628 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4629 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4630 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4631 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4632 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4633 unconditional.
4634
4635 .vitem &%-x%&
4636 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4637 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4638 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4639 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4640 this option.
4641
4642 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4643 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4644 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4645 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4646
4647 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4648 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4649 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4650 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4651 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4652 under most shells.
4653 .endlist
4654
4655 .ecindex IIDclo1
4656 .ecindex IIDclo2
4657
4658
4659 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4660 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4661 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4662 . creates a man page for the options.
4663 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4664
4665 .literal xml
4666 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4667 .literal off
4668
4669
4670
4671
4672
4673 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4674 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4675
4676
4677 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4678 "The runtime configuration file"
4679
4680 .cindex "run time configuration"
4681 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4682 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4683 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4684 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4685 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4686 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4687 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4688 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4689 control.
4690
4691 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4692 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4693 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4694 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4695 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4696 actually alter the string.
4697
4698 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4699 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4700 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4701 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4702 existing file in the list.
4703
4704 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4705 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4706 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4707 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4708 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4709 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4710 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4711 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4712 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4713 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4714 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4715
4716 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4717 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4718 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4719 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4720 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4721
4722 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4723 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4724 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4725 compromise the Exim user account.
4726
4727 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4728 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4729 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4730 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4731 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4732 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4733 configuration.
4734
4735
4736
4737 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4738 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4739 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4740 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4741 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4742 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4743 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4744 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4745 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4746 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4747 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4748
4749 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4750 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4751 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4752 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4753 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4754 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4755 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4756 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4757 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4758 &%-M%&).
4759
4760 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4761 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4762 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4763 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4764 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4765
4766 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4767 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4768 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4769 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4770 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4771 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4772
4773 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4774 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4775 necessarily be discarded.
4776 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4777 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4778 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4779 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4780 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4781 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4782
4783 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4784 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4785 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4786 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4787 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4788 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4789 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4790
4791 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4792 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4793 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4794
4795
4796
4797 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4798 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4799 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4800 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4801 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4802 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4803 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4804 optional parts are:
4805
4806 .ilist
4807 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4808 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4809 .next
4810 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4811 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4812 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4813 .next
4814 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4815 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4816 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4817 .next
4818 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4819 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4820 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4821 .next
4822 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4823 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4824 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4825 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4826 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4827 .next
4828 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4829 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4830 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4831 .next
4832 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4833 want to use this feature, you must set
4834 .code
4835 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4836 .endd
4837 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4838 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4839 .endlist
4840
4841 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4842 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4843 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4844 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4845
4846 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4847 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4848 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4849 and does not introduce a comment.
4850
4851 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4852 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4853 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4854 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4855 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4856
4857 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4858 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4859 change settings as required.
4860
4861 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4862 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4863 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4864 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4865 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4866 described.
4867
4868
4869
4870 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4871 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4872 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4873 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4874 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4875 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4876 using this syntax:
4877 .display
4878 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4879 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4880 .endd
4881 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4882 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4883 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4884 name is required.
4885
4886 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4887 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4888 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4889 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4890
4891 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4892 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4893 for example:
4894 .code
4895 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4896 .include /some/file
4897 .endd
4898 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4899 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4900 inclusion appears.
4901
4902
4903
4904 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4905 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4906 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4907 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4908 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4909 definition, and must be of the form
4910 .display
4911 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4912 .endd
4913 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4914 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4915 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4916 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4917 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4918
4919 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4920 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4921 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4922
4923 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4924 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4925 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4926 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4927 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4928 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4929 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4930 define
4931 .display
4932 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4933 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4934 .endd
4935 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4936 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4937 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4938 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4939 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4940 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4941
4942
4943 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4944 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4945 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4946 &'='&. For example:
4947 .code
4948 MAC = initial value
4949 ...
4950 MAC == updated value
4951 .endd
4952 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4953 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4954 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4955 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4956 .code
4957 MAC = initial value
4958 ...
4959 MAC == MAC and something added
4960 .endd
4961 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4962 from a number of other files.
4963
4964 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4965 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4966 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4967 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4968 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4969 file to be ignored.
4970
4971
4972
4973 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4974 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4975 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4976 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4977 .code
4978 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4979 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
4980 .endd
4981 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4982 .code
4983 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4984 .endd
4985 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4986 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4987 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4988
4989
4990 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4991 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4992 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4993 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4994 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4995 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4996 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4997
4998 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4999 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5000 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5001 line. Thus:
5002 .code
5003 .ifdef AAA
5004 message_size_limit = 50M
5005 .else
5006 message_size_limit = 100M
5007 .endif
5008 .endd
5009 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5010 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5011 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5012 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5013 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5014
5015 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5016 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5017 in this line"& will always be true.
5018
5019 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5020 to clarify complicated nestings.
5021
5022
5023
5024 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5025 .cindex "common option syntax"
5026 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5027 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5028 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5029 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5030 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5031 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5032 space) and then the value. For example:
5033 .code
5034 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5035 .endd
5036 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5037 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5038 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5039 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5040 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5041 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5042 word &"hide"&. For example:
5043 .code
5044 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5045 .endd
5046 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5047 .code
5048 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5049 .endd
5050 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5051 all instances of the same driver.
5052
5053 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5054 that are found in option settings.
5055
5056
5057 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5058 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5059 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5060 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5061 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5062 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5063 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5064 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5065 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5066 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5067 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5068 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5069 .code
5070 queue_only
5071 queue_only = true
5072 .endd
5073 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5074 .code
5075 no_queue_only
5076 queue_only = false
5077 .endd
5078 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5079
5080
5081
5082
5083 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5084 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5085 .cindex "format" "integer"
5086 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5087 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5088 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5089 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5090 hexadecimal number.
5091
5092 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5093 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
5094 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5095 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5096 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5097 used.
5098
5099
5100 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5101 .cindex "integer format"
5102 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5103 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5104 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5105 Such options are always output in octal.
5106
5107
5108 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5109 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5110 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5111 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5112 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5113
5114
5115
5116 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5117 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5118 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5119 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5120 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5121
5122 .table2 30pt
5123 .irow &%s%& seconds
5124 .irow &%m%& minutes
5125 .irow &%h%& hours
5126 .irow &%d%& days
5127 .irow &%w%& weeks
5128 .endtable
5129
5130 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5131 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5132 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5133
5134
5135
5136 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5137 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5138 .cindex "format" "string"
5139 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5140 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5141 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5142 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5143 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5144 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5145 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5146 therefore equivalent:
5147 .code
5148 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5149 trusted_users = uucp:\
5150 # This comment line is ignored
5151 mail
5152 .endd
5153 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5154 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5155 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5156 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5157 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5158
5159 .table2 100pt
5160 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5161 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5162 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5163 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5164 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5165 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5166 character"
5167 .endtable
5168
5169 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5170 character, that character replaces the pair.
5171
5172 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5173 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5174 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5175 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5176 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5177 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5178
5179
5180 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5181 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5182 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5183 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5184 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5185 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5186 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5187 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5188 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5189 within a quoted configuration string.
5190
5191
5192 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5193 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5194 .cindex "format" "user name"
5195 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5196 .cindex "format" "group name"
5197 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5198 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5199 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5200 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5201
5202
5203 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5204 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5205 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5206 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5207 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5208 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5209 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5210 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5211 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5212 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5213 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5214
5215 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5216 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5217 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5218 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5219 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5220 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5221 example, the list
5222 .code
5223 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5224 .endd
5225 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5226
5227 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5228 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5229 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5230 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5231
5232 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5233 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5234 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5235 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5236 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5237 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5238 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5239 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5240 .code
5241 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5242 .endd
5243 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5244 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5245 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5246
5247 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5248 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5249 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5250 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5251 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5252 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5253 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5254 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5255 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5256 .code
5257 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5258 .endd
5259 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5260 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5261 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5262 the value in quotes. For example:
5263 .code
5264 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5265 .endd
5266 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5267 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5268 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5269 enclosing an empty list item.
5270
5271
5272
5273 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5274 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5275 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5276 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5277 .code
5278 senders = user@domain :
5279 .endd
5280 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5281 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5282 items, the second of which is empty:
5283 .code
5284 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5285 .endd
5286 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5287 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5288 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5289 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5290 .code
5291 senders = :
5292 .endd
5293 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5294 is at the end of the list.
5295
5296
5297
5298
5299 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5300 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5301 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5302 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5303 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5304 a sequence of lines like this:
5305 .display
5306 <&'instance name'&>:
5307 <&'option'&>
5308 ...
5309 <&'option'&>
5310 .endd
5311 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5312 followed by three options settings:
5313 .code
5314 localuser:
5315 driver = accept
5316 check_local_user
5317 transport = local_delivery
5318 .endd
5319 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5320 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5321 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5322 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5323 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5324 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5325
5326 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5327 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5328
5329 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5330 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5331 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5332 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5333 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5334 server.
5335
5336 .cindex "generic options"
5337 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5338 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5339 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5340 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5341 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5342 .cindex "private options"
5343 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5344 they all have default values.
5345
5346 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5347 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5348 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5349
5350 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5351 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5352 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5353 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5354 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5355 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5356 configuration lines:
5357 .code
5358 remote_smtp:
5359 driver = smtp
5360 .endd
5361 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5362 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5363 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5364 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5365 thus:
5366 .code
5367 special_smtp:
5368 driver = smtp
5369 port = 1234
5370 command_timeout = 10s
5371 .endd
5372 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5373 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5374 lines.
5375
5376 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5377 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5378 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5379 option.
5380
5381
5382
5383
5384
5385
5386 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5387 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5388
5389 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5390 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5391 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5392 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5393 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5394 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5395 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5396 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5397 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5398 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5399 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5400
5401
5402
5403 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5404 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5405 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5406 the line
5407 .code
5408 # primary_hostname =
5409 .endd
5410 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5411 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5412 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5413 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5414
5415 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5416 .code
5417 domainlist local_domains = @
5418 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5419 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5420 .endd
5421 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5422 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5423 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5424 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5425
5426 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5427 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5428 on the local host.
5429
5430 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5431 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5432 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5433 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5434 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5435 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5436
5437 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5438 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5439 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5440 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5441 domain is permitted.
5442
5443 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5444 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5445 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5446 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5447 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5448 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5449
5450 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5451 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5452 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5453
5454 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5455 .code
5456 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5457 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5458 .endd
5459 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5460 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5461 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5462 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5463 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5464 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5465 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5466 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5467 contents of a message to be checked.
5468
5469 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5470 .code
5471 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5472 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5473 .endd
5474 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5475 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5476 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5477 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5478
5479 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5480 .code
5481 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5482 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5483 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5484 .endd
5485 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5486 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5487 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5488 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5489 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5490 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5491 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5492
5493 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5494 .code
5495 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5496 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5497 .endd
5498 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5499 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5500 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5501 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5502 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5503 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5504 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5505 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5506 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5507 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5508 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5509 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5510 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5511 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5512 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5513 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5514
5515 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5516 .code
5517 # qualify_domain =
5518 # qualify_recipient =
5519 .endd
5520 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5521 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5522 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5523 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5524 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5525 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5526
5527 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5528 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5529 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5530 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5531 .code
5532 # allow_domain_literals
5533 .endd
5534 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5535 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5536 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5537 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5538 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5539 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5540
5541 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5542 .code
5543 never_users = root
5544 .endd
5545 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5546 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5547 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5548 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5549 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5550 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5551 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5552 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5553
5554 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5555 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5556 line,
5557 .code
5558 host_lookup = *
5559 .endd
5560 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5561 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5562 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5563 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5564 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5565 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5566 unreachable.
5567
5568 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5569 1413 (hence their names):
5570 .code
5571 rfc1413_hosts = *
5572 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5573 .endd
5574 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5575 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5576 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5577 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5578 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5579 information, you can change this.
5580
5581 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5582 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5583 .code
5584 prdr_enable = true
5585 .endd
5586
5587 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5588 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5589 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5590 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5591 .code
5592 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5593 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5594 .endd
5595 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5596 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5597
5598 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5599 over the default:
5600 .code
5601 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5602 +tls_certificate_verified
5603 .endd
5604
5605 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5606 .code
5607 # percent_hack_domains =
5608 .endd
5609 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5610 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5611 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5612
5613 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5614 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5615 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5616 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5617 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5618 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5619 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5620 always bounce messages.
5621 .code
5622 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5623 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5624 .endd
5625 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5626 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5627 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5628 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5629 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5630
5631
5632
5633 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5634 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5635 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5636 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5637 It starts with the line
5638 .code
5639 begin acl
5640 .endd
5641 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5642 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5643 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5644
5645 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5646 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5647 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5648 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5649 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5650 result of the ACL processing.
5651 .code
5652 acl_check_rcpt:
5653 .endd
5654 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5655 ACL, and names it.
5656 .code
5657 accept hosts = :
5658 .endd
5659 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5660 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5661 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5662 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5663 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5664 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5665
5666 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5667 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5668 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5669 manner.
5670 .code
5671 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5672 domains = +local_domains
5673 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5674
5675 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5676 domains = !+local_domains
5677 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5678 .endd
5679 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5680 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5681 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5682 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5683 in Internet mail addresses.
5684
5685 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5686 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5687 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5688 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5689 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5690 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5691 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5692 policy of being as safe as possible.
5693
5694 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5695 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5696 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5697 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5698 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5699 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5700
5701 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5702 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5703 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5704 have to modify this rule.
5705
5706 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5707 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5708 common convention of local parts constructed as
5709 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5710 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5711 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5712 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5713 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5714 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5715
5716 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5717 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5718 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5719 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5720 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5721 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5722 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5723 .code
5724 accept local_parts = postmaster
5725 domains = +local_domains
5726 .endd
5727 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5728 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5729 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5730 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5731 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5732
5733 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5734 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5735 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5736 .code
5737 require verify = sender
5738 .endd
5739 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5740 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5741 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5742 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5743 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5744 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5745 discusses the details of address verification.
5746 .code
5747 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5748 control = submission
5749 .endd
5750 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5751 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5752 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5753 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5754 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5755 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5756 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5757 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5758 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5759 .code
5760 accept authenticated = *
5761 control = submission
5762 .endd
5763 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5764 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5765 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5766 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5767 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5768 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5769 .code
5770 require message = relay not permitted
5771 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5772 .endd
5773 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5774 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5775 .code
5776 require verify = recipient
5777 .endd
5778 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5779 fails, the address is rejected.
5780 .code
5781 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5782 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5783 # $dnslist_text
5784 # dnslists = black.list.example
5785 #
5786 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5787 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5788 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5789 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5790 .endd
5791 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5792 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5793 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5794 line.
5795 .code
5796 # require verify = csa
5797 .endd
5798 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5799 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5800 records.
5801 .code
5802 accept
5803 .endd
5804 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5805 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5806 .code
5807 acl_check_data:
5808 .endd
5809 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5810 of this ACL are commented out:
5811 .code
5812 # deny malware = *
5813 # message = This message contains a virus \
5814 # ($malware_name).
5815 .endd
5816 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5817 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5818 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5819 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5820 .code
5821 # warn spam = nobody
5822 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5823 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5824 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5825 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5826 .endd
5827 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5828 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5829 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5830 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5831 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5832 whatever the spam score.
5833 .code
5834 accept
5835 .endd
5836 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5837
5838
5839 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5840 .cindex "default" "routers"
5841 .cindex "routers" "default"
5842 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5843 by the line
5844 .code
5845 begin routers
5846 .endd
5847 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5848 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5849 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5850 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5851 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5852 .code
5853 # domain_literal:
5854 # driver = ipliteral
5855 # domains = !+local_domains
5856 # transport = remote_smtp
5857 .endd
5858 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5859 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5860 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5861 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5862 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5863 .code
5864 dnslookup:
5865 driver = dnslookup
5866 domains = ! +local_domains
5867 transport = remote_smtp
5868 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5869 no_more
5870 .endd
5871 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5872 domains. This is specified by the line
5873 .code
5874 domains = ! +local_domains
5875 .endd
5876 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5877 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5878 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5879 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5880 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5881 passed on to the following routers.
5882
5883 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5884 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5885 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5886 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5887 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5888
5889 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5890 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5891 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5892 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5893 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5894 the address fails and is bounced.
5895
5896 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5897 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5898 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5899 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5900 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5901 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5902 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5903 out.
5904 .code
5905 system_aliases:
5906 driver = redirect
5907 allow_fail
5908 allow_defer
5909 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5910 # user = exim
5911 file_transport = address_file
5912 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5913 .endd
5914 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5915 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5916 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5917 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5918 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5919 the next router.
5920
5921 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5922 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5923 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5924 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5925 .code
5926 userforward:
5927 driver = redirect
5928 check_local_user
5929 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5930 # local_part_suffix_optional
5931 file = $home/.forward
5932 # allow_filter
5933 no_verify
5934 no_expn
5935 check_ancestor
5936 file_transport = address_file
5937 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5938 reply_transport = address_reply
5939 .endd
5940 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5941 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5942 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5943 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5944 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5945 namely:
5946 .code
5947 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5948 # local_part_suffix_optional
5949 .endd
5950 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5951 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5952 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5953 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5954 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5955 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5956 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5957
5958 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5959 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5960 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5961 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5962
5963 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5964 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5965 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5966 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5967 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5968 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5969 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5970
5971 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5972 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5973 There are two reasons for doing this:
5974
5975 .olist
5976 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5977 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5978 unnecessary work.
5979 .next
5980 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5981 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5982 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5983 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5984 this time.
5985 .endlist
5986
5987 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5988 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5989 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5990 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5991
5992 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5993 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5994 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5995 .code
5996 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5997 .endd
5998 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5999 transport.
6000 .code
6001 localuser:
6002 driver = accept
6003 check_local_user
6004 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6005 # local_part_suffix_optional
6006 transport = local_delivery
6007 .endd
6008 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6009 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6010 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6011 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6012 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6013
6014
6015 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6016 .cindex "default" "transports"
6017 .cindex "transports" "default"
6018 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6019 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6020 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6021 .code
6022 begin transports
6023 .endd
6024 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6025 .code
6026 remote_smtp:
6027 driver = smtp
6028 hosts_try_prdr = *
6029 .endd
6030 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6031 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6032 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6033 It is negotiated between client and server
6034 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6035 All other options are defaulted.
6036 .code
6037 local_delivery:
6038 driver = appendfile
6039 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6040 delivery_date_add
6041 envelope_to_add
6042 return_path_add
6043 # group = mail
6044 # mode = 0660
6045 .endd
6046 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6047 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6048 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6049 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6050 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6051 show how this can be done.
6052
6053 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6054 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6055 similarly-named options above.
6056 .code
6057 address_pipe:
6058 driver = pipe
6059 return_output
6060 .endd
6061 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6062 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6063 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
6064 sender.
6065 .code
6066 address_file:
6067 driver = appendfile
6068 delivery_date_add
6069 envelope_to_add
6070 return_path_add
6071 .endd
6072 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6073 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6074 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6075 .code
6076 address_reply:
6077 driver = autoreply
6078 .endd
6079 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6080 filter files.
6081
6082
6083
6084 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6085 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6086 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6087 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6088 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6089 introduced by the line
6090 .code
6091 begin retry
6092 .endd
6093 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6094 errors:
6095 .code
6096 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6097 .endd
6098 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6099 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6100 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6101 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
6102
6103 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6104 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6105 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6106
6107
6108 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6109 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6110 .code
6111 begin rewrite
6112 .endd
6113 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6114 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6115
6116
6117
6118 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6119 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6120 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6121 .code
6122 begin authenticators
6123 .endd
6124 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6125 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6126 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6127 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6128 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6129 to support most MUA software.
6130
6131 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6132 .code
6133 #PLAIN:
6134 # driver = plaintext
6135 # server_set_id = $auth2
6136 # server_prompts = :
6137 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6138 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6139 .endd
6140 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6141 .code
6142 #LOGIN:
6143 # driver = plaintext
6144 # server_set_id = $auth1
6145 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6146 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6147 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6148 .endd
6149
6150 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6151 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6152 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6153 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6154 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6155 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6156 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6157 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6158
6159 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6160 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6161 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6162 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6163
6164 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6165 usercode and password are in different positions.
6166 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6167
6168 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6169
6170
6171
6172 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6173 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6174
6175 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6176
6177 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6178 .cindex "PCRE"
6179 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6180 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6181 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6182 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
6183 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6184 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6185
6186 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6187 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6188 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6189 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6190 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6191 case-insensitive.
6192
6193 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6194 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6195 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6196 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6197 .code
6198 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6199 .endd
6200 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6201 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6202 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6203 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6204 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6205 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6206 matched.
6207
6208 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6209 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6210 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6211 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6212 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6213 match anywhere in the subject string.
6214
6215 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6216 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6217 .code
6218 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6219 .endd
6220 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6221 You need to use:
6222 .code
6223 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6224 .endd
6225 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6226 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6227
6228
6229
6230 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6231 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6232
6233 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6234 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6235 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6236 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6237 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6238 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6239
6240 .olist
6241 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6242 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6243 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6244 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6245 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6246 .next
6247 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6248 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6249 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6250 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6251 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6252 .endlist
6253
6254 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6255 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6256 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6257 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6258 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6259 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6260
6261 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6262 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6263 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6264 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6265 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6266 .code
6267 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6268 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6269 .endd
6270 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6271 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6272 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6273 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6274 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6275 .code
6276 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6277 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6278 .endd
6279 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6280 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6281
6282 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6283 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6284 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6285 .code
6286 domain1:
6287 domain2:
6288 .endd
6289 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6290 matches the list item.
6291
6292 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6293 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6294 .code
6295 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6296 .endd
6297 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6298 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6299 causes a second lookup to occur.
6300
6301 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6302 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6303 lookup is permitted.
6304
6305
6306 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6307 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6308 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6309 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6310
6311 .ilist
6312 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6313 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6314 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6315 .next
6316 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6317 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6318 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6319 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6320 .endlist
6321
6322 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6323 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6324 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6325 .code
6326 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6327 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6328 .endd
6329 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6330 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6331 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6332
6333
6334
6335
6336 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6337 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6338 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6339 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6340
6341 .ilist
6342 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6343 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6344 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6345 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6346 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6347 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6348 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6349 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6350 be found in several places:
6351 .display
6352 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6353 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6354 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6355 .endd
6356 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6357 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6358 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6359 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6360 .next
6361 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6362 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6363 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6364 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6365 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6366 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6367 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6368
6369 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6370 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6371 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6372 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6373 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6374 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6375 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6376 .next
6377 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6378 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6379 .cindex "sasldb2"
6380 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6381 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6382 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6383 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6384 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6385 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6386 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6387 .next
6388 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6389 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6390 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6391 .cindex "Courier"
6392 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6393 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6394 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6395 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6396 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6397 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6398 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6399 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6400 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6401 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6402 .next
6403 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6404 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6405 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6406 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6407 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6408 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6409 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6410 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6411 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6412 .next
6413 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6414 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6415 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6416 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6417 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6418 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6419 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6420 .code
6421 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6422 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6423 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6424 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6425 .endd
6426 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6427 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6428 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6429 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6430 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6431
6432 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6433 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6434 lookup types support only literal keys.
6435
6436 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6437 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6438 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6439 .next
6440 .cindex "linear search"
6441 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6442 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6443 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6444 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6445 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6446 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6447 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6448 in the file is used.
6449
6450 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6451 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6452 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6453 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6454 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6455 colon, for example:
6456 .code
6457 baduser: :fail:
6458 .endd
6459 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6460 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6461 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6462 wildcarding of any kind.
6463
6464 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6465 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6466 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6467 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6468 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6469 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6470 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6471 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6472 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6473
6474 .next
6475 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6476 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6477 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6478 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6479 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6480 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6481 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6482 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6483
6484 .next
6485 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6486 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6487 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6488 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6489 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6490 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6491 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6492 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6493 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6494
6495 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6496 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6497 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6498 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6499
6500 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6501 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6502
6503 .olist
6504 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6505 .code
6506 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6507 *fish data for anythingfish
6508 .endd
6509 .next
6510 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6511 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6512 .code
6513 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6514 .endd
6515 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6516 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6517 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6518 .code
6519 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6520 .endd
6521 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6522 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6523 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6524 .code
6525 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6526 .endd
6527
6528 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6529 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6530 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6531 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6532 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6533
6534 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6535 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6536 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6537 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6538 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6539
6540 .next
6541 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6542 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6543 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6544 example:
6545 .code
6546 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6547 .endd
6548 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6549 .endlist olist
6550
6551 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6552 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6553 be followed by optional colons.
6554
6555 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6556 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6557 lookup types support only literal keys.
6558 .endlist ilist
6559
6560
6561 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6562 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6563 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6564 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6565 many of them are given in later sections.
6566
6567 .ilist
6568 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6569 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6570 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6571 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6572 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6573 .next
6574 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6575 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6576 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6577 .next
6578 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6579 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6580 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6581 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6582 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6583 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6584 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6585 .next
6586 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6587 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6588 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6589 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6590 .next
6591 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6592 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6593 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6594 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6595 .next
6596 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6597 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6598 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6599 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6600 .next
6601 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6602 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6603 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6604 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6605 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6606 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6607 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6608 password value. For example:
6609 .code
6610 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6611 .endd
6612 .next
6613 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6614 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6615 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6616 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6617
6618 .next
6619 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6620 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6621 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6622 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6623
6624 .next
6625 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6626 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6627 .next
6628 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6629 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6630 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6631 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6632 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6633 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6634 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6635 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6636 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6637 .code
6638 require condition = \
6639 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6640 .endd
6641 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6642 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6643 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6644 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6645 .endlist
6646
6647
6648
6649 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6650 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6651 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6652 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6653 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6654 options such as a list of local domains.
6655
6656 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6657 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6658 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6659 or may give up altogether.
6660
6661
6662
6663 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6664 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6665 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6666 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6667 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6668 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6669 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6670 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6671
6672 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6673 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6674 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6675
6676 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6677 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6678 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6679
6680 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6681 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6682 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6683 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6684 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6685 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6686 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6687 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6688 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6689 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6690 .code
6691 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6692 .endd
6693 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6694 looks up these keys, in this order:
6695 .code
6696 jane@eyre.example
6697 *@eyre.example
6698 *
6699 .endd
6700 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6701 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6702 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6703 Exim move on to try the next key.
6704
6705
6706
6707 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6708 .cindex "partial matching"
6709 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6710 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6711 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6712 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6713 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6714 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6715 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6716 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6717 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6718 a key in a DBM file is
6719 .code
6720 *.dates.fict.example
6721 .endd
6722 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6723 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6724 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6725 file.
6726
6727 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6728 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6729 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6730
6731 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6732 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6733 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6734 partial matching keys
6735 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6736 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6737 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6738
6739 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6740 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6741 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6742 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6743 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6744 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6745 remains.
6746
6747 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6748 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6749 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6750 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6751 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6752 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6753 .code
6754 2250.dates.fict.example
6755 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6756 *.dates.fict.example
6757 *.fict.example
6758 .endd
6759 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6760 finishes.
6761
6762 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6763 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6764 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6765 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6766 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6767 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6768 .code
6769 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6770 .endd
6771 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6772 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6773 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6774 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6775 .code
6776 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6777 .endd
6778 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6779 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6780
6781 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6782 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6783 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6784
6785 .ilist
6786 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6787 .next
6788 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6789 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6790 .next
6791 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6792 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6793 for &"*"& on its own.
6794 .next
6795 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6796 .endlist
6797
6798
6799 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6800 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6801 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6802 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6803 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6804 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6805 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6806
6807 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6808 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6809 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6810 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6811 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6812
6813
6814
6815
6816 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6817 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6818 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6819 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6820 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6821 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6822 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6823
6824 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6825 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6826 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6827 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6828 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6829 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6830
6831 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6832 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6833 complete.
6834
6835
6836
6837
6838 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6839 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6840 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6841 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6842 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6843 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6844 .code
6845 [name=$local_part]
6846 .endd
6847 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6848 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6849 .code
6850 [name="$local_part"]
6851 .endd
6852 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6853 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6854 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6855 of the following form is provided:
6856 .code
6857 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6858 .endd
6859 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6860 .code
6861 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6862 .endd
6863 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6864 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6865 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6866
6867
6868
6869
6870 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6871 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6872 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6873 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6874 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6875 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6876 an expansion string could contain:
6877 .code
6878 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6879 .endd
6880 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6881 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6882 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6883 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6884
6885 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
6886 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
6887 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
6888
6889 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
6890 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6891 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6892 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6893 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6894 .code
6895 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6896 .endd
6897 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6898 white space is ignored.
6899 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
6900 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
6901 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
6902
6903 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6904 When the type is PTR,
6905 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6906 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6907 .code
6908 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6909 .endd
6910 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6911 altered and nothing is added.
6912
6913 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6914 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6915 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6916 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6917 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6918 The field separator can be modified as above.
6919
6920 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6921 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6922 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
6923 unless a field separator is specified.
6924 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
6925 For SPF records the
6926 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
6927 .code
6928 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
6929 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
6930 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
6931 .endd
6932 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6933 white space is ignored.
6934
6935 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6936 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
6937 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
6938 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
6939 specified.
6940 .code
6941 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
6942 .endd
6943
6944 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
6945 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
6946 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
6947 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
6948 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
6949 each followed by a comma,
6950 that may appear before the record type.
6951
6952 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6953 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6954 a defer-option modifier.
6955 The possible keywords are
6956 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
6957 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6958 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6959 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6960 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6961 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6962 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6963 .code
6964 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6965 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6966 .endd
6967 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6968 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6969
6970 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
6971 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
6972 The possible keywords are
6973 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
6974 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
6975 with the lookup.
6976 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
6977 is not labelled as authenticated data
6978 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
6979 The default is &"never"&.
6980
6981 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
6982
6983 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
6984 .cindex "DNS" timeout
6985 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
6986 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
6987 (e.g. &"5s"&).
6988 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
6989
6990 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
6991 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
6992 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
6993
6994
6995 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6996 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6997 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6998 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6999 the pseudo-type MXH:
7000 .code
7001 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7002 .endd
7003 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7004 returned.
7005
7006 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7007 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7008 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7009 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7010 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7011 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7012 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7013 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7014 .code
7015 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7016 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7017 .endd
7018 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7019 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7020 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7021
7022 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7023 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7024 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7025 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7026 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7027 such a list.
7028
7029 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7030 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7031 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7032 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7033 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7034 result of a successful lookup such as:
7035 .code
7036 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7037 .endd
7038 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7039 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7040 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7041
7042 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7043 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7044 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7045 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7046 .code
7047 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7048 .endd
7049
7050
7051 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7052 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7053 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7054 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7055 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7056 .code
7057 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7058 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7059 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7060 .endd
7061 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7062 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7063 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7064 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7065
7066 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7067 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7068 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7069
7070
7071
7072
7073 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7074 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7075 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7076 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7077 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7078 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7079 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7080 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7081 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7082 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7083 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7084 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7085 .code
7086 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7087 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7088 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7089 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7090 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7091 .endd
7092 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7093 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7094
7095 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7096 the way they handle the results of a query:
7097
7098 .ilist
7099 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7100 gives an error.
7101 .next
7102 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7103 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7104 .next
7105 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7106 from all of them are returned.
7107 .endlist
7108
7109
7110 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7111 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7112 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7113 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7114
7115
7116 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7117 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7118 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7119 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7120 .code
7121 data = ${lookup ldap \
7122 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7123 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7124 .endd
7125 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7126 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7127 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7128 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7129
7130 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7131 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7132 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7133
7134 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7135 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7136 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7137 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7138 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7139 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7140 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7141 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7142 &_exim.conf_&.
7143
7144
7145 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7146 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7147 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7148 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7149 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7150 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7151
7152 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7153 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7154 the string:
7155 .code
7156 * => \2A
7157 ( => \28
7158 ) => \29
7159 \ => \5C
7160 .endd
7161 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7162 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7163 .code
7164 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7165 .endd
7166 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7167 .code
7168 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7169 .endd
7170 yields
7171 .code
7172 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7173 .endd
7174 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7175 .code
7176 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7177 .endd
7178 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7179 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7180 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7181 .code
7182 , + " \ < > ;
7183 .endd
7184 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7185 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7186 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7187 .code
7188 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7189 .endd
7190 yields
7191 .code
7192 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7193 .endd
7194 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7195 .code
7196 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7197 .endd
7198 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7199 authentication below.
7200
7201
7202 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7203 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7204 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7205 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7206 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7207 by starting it with
7208 .code
7209 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7210 .endd
7211 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7212 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7213 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7214 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7215 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7216 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7217 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7218 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7219 failures, and timeouts.
7220
7221 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7222 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7223 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7224 doubled. For example
7225 .code
7226 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7227 .endd
7228 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7229 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7230 the local host) is used.
7231
7232 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7233 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7234 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7235 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7236 not available.
7237
7238 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7239 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7240 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7241 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7242 .code
7243 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7244 .endd
7245 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7246 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7247 .code
7248 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7249 .endd
7250 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7251 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7252 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7253 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7254 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7255 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7256 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7257 backup host.
7258
7259 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7260 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7261 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7262
7263 .ilist
7264 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7265 interface.
7266 .next
7267 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7268 .endlist
7269
7270
7271 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7272 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7273
7274
7275
7276 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7277 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7278 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7279 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7280 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7281 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7282 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7283 them. The following names are recognized:
7284 .display
7285 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7286 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7287 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7288 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7289 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7290 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7291 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7292 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7293 .endd
7294 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7295 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7296 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7297 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7298
7299 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7300 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7301 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7302 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7303 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7304 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7305 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7306 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7307 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7308
7309 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7310 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7311
7312 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7313 to use for an individual lookup. The global ldap_servers option provides a
7314 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7315 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7316 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7317 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7318 alternate list (colon-separated).
7319
7320 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7321 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7322 .code
7323 ${lookup ldap
7324 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7325 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7326 {$value}fail}
7327 .endd
7328 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7329 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7330 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7331 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7332
7333 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7334 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7335 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7336
7337 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7338 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7339 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7340 quoting has two advantages:
7341
7342 .ilist
7343 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7344 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7345 .next
7346 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7347 .endlist
7348
7349 For example, a setting such as
7350 .code
7351 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7352 .endd
7353 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7354
7355 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7356 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7357 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7358 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7359 .code
7360 PASS=${quote:$3}
7361 .endd
7362 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7363 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7364 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7365
7366
7367
7368 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7369 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7370 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7371 as a sequence of values, for example
7372 .code
7373 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7374 .endd
7375 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7376 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7377 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7378 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7379 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7380 directory.
7381
7382 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7383 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7384 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7385
7386 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7387 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7388 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7389 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7390 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7391 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7392 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7393 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7394 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7395
7396 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7397 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7398 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7399 &%attr2%& has only one value:
7400 .code
7401 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7402 value1.1,value1,,2
7403
7404 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7405 value two
7406
7407 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7408 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7409
7410 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7411 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7412 .endd
7413 You can
7414 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7415 results of LDAP lookups.
7416 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7417 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7418 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7419 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7420 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7421 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7422
7423
7424
7425
7426 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7427 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7428 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7429 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7430 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7431 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7432 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7433 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7434 .code
7435 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7436 .endd
7437 might return the string
7438 .code
7439 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7440 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7441 .endd
7442 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7443 .code
7444 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7445 .endd
7446 would just return
7447 .code
7448 Martin Guerre
7449 .endd
7450 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7451 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7452 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7453
7454
7455
7456 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7457 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7458 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7459 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7460 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7461 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7462 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7463 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7464 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7465 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7466 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7467 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7468 might be
7469 .code
7470 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7471 {$value}fail}
7472 .endd
7473 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7474 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7475 .code
7476 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7477 {$value}}
7478 .endd
7479 might be
7480 .code
7481 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7482 .endd
7483 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7484 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7485 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7486 .code
7487 Mister X
7488 .endd
7489 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7490 with a newline between the data for each row.
7491
7492
7493 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7494 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7495 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7496 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7497 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7498 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7499 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7500 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7501 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7502 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7503 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7504 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7505 information.
7506 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7507 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7508 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7509 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7510 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7511 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7512 .code
7513 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7514 .endd
7515 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7516 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7517 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7518 .code
7519 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7520 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7521 .endd
7522 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7523 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7524 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7525 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7526 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7527 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7528
7529 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7530 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7531 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7532 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7533 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7534 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7535 characters are not special.
7536
7537 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7538 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7539 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7540 done by starting the query with
7541 .display
7542 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7543 .endd
7544 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7545 .olist
7546 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7547 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7548 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7549 taken from there.
7550 .next
7551 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7552 .endlist
7553 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7554 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7555 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7556
7557 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7558 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7559 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7560 like this:
7561 .code
7562 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7563 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7564 master/db/name/pw
7565 .endd
7566 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7567 .code
7568 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7569 .endd
7570 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7571 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7572 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7573 .code
7574 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7575 .endd
7576
7577
7578 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7579 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7580 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7581 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7582 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7583 .display
7584 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7585 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7586 .endd
7587 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7588 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7589
7590 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7591 the queries.
7592
7593 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7594 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7595
7596 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7597 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7598 is zero because no rows are affected.
7599
7600
7601 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7602 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7603 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7604 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7605 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7606 looks like this:
7607 .code
7608 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7609 .endd
7610 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7611 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7612 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7613
7614 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7615 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7616 affected.
7617
7618 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7619 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7620 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7621 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7622 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7623 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7624 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7625 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7626 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7627 .code
7628 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7629 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7630 .endd
7631 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7632 .code
7633 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7634 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7635 .endd
7636 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7637 quote, which it doubles.
7638
7639 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7640 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7641 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7642 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7643 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7644 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7645 option.
7646 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7647 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7648
7649
7650 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7651 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7652
7653 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7654 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7655 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7656 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7657 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7658 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7659 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7660 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7661 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7662
7663 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7664 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7665 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7666 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7667
7668 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7669 support all the complexity available in
7670 domain, host, address and local part lists.
7671
7672
7673
7674 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7675 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7676 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7677 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7678 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7679 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7680 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7681 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7682
7683
7684 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7685 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7686 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7687
7688 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7689 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7690 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7691 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7692 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7693 .code
7694 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7695 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7696 .endd
7697 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7698 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7699 senders based on the receiving domain.
7700
7701
7702
7703
7704 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7705 .cindex "list" "negation"
7706 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7707 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7708 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7709 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7710 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7711 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7712
7713 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7714 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7715 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7716 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7717 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7718 .code
7719 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7720 .endd
7721 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7722 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7723 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7724 .code
7725 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7726 .endd
7727 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7728 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7729 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7730
7731 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7732 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7733 item.
7734
7735
7736
7737 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7738 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7739 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7740 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7741 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7742 file names are not allowed,
7743 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7744 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7745 lines:
7746
7747 .ilist
7748 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7749 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7750 .next
7751 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7752 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7753 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7754 .code
7755 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7756 .endd
7757 .endlist
7758
7759 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7760 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7761 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7762 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7763
7764 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7765 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7766 .code
7767 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7768 .endd
7769 and the file contains the lines
7770 .code
7771 !a.b.c
7772 *.b.c
7773 .endd
7774 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7775 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7776
7777
7778
7779 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7780 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7781 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7782 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7783 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7784 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7785 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7786 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7787
7788 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7789 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7790 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7791 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7792
7793
7794
7795
7796 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7797 .cindex "named lists"
7798 .cindex "list" "named"
7799 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7800 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7801 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7802 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7803 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7804 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7805 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7806 .code
7807 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7808 .endd
7809 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7810 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7811 configured with the line
7812 .code
7813 domains = +local_domains
7814 .endd
7815 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7816 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7817 .code
7818 dnslookup:
7819 driver = dnslookup
7820 domains = ! +local_domains
7821 transport = remote_smtp
7822 no_more
7823 .endd
7824 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7825 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7826 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7827 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7828 .code
7829 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7830 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7831 .endd
7832 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7833 .code
7834 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7835 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7836 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7837 .endd
7838 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7839 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7840 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7841 .code
7842 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7843 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7844 .endd
7845 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7846 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7847 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7848 .code
7849 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7850 .endd
7851 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7852 referenced lists if you can.
7853
7854 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7855 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7856 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7857 .code
7858 domains = +local_domains
7859 .endd
7860 on several of your routers
7861 or in several ACL statements,
7862 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7863 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7864 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7865 the same each time they are referenced.
7866
7867 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7868 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7869 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7870 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7871
7872
7873
7874 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7875 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7876 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7877 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7878 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7879 write
7880 .code
7881 ALIST = host1 : host2
7882 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7883 .endd
7884 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7885 .code
7886 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7887 .endd
7888 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7889 list, and write
7890 .code
7891 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7892 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7893 .endd
7894 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7895 .code
7896 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7897 .endd
7898
7899
7900 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7901 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7902 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7903 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7904 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7905 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7906 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7907 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7908 message. For example:
7909 .code
7910 domainlist special_domains = \
7911 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7912 .endd
7913 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7914 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7915 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7916 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7917 same list each time.
7918
7919 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7920 cache the result anyway. For example:
7921 .code
7922 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7923 .endd
7924 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7925 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7926
7927
7928
7929 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7930 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7931 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7932 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7933 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7934
7935 .ilist
7936 .cindex "primary host name"
7937 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7938 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7939 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7940 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7941 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7942 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7943 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7944 differ only in their names.
7945 .next
7946 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7947 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7948 .cindex "domain literal"
7949 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7950 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7951 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7952 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7953 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7954 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7955 .next
7956 .cindex "@mx_any"
7957 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7958 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7959 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7960 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7961 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7962 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7963 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7964 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7965 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7966 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7967 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7968
7969 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7970 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7971 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7972 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7973 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7974
7975 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7976 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7977 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7978 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7979 on a router). For example:
7980 .code
7981 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7982 .endd
7983 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7984 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7985
7986 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7987 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7988 contain negative items.
7989
7990 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7991 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7992 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7993 .code
7994 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7995 an.other.domain : ...
7996 .endd
7997 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7998 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7999 .code
8000 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8001 an.other.domain ? ...
8002 .endd
8003 .next
8004 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8005 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8006 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8007 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8008 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8009 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8010 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8011 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8012 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8013 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
8014
8015 .next
8016 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8017 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8018 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8019 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8020 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8021 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8022 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8023 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8024 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8025
8026 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8027 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8028 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8029 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8030 expression by expansion, of course).
8031 .next
8032 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8033 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8034 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8035 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8036 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8037 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8038 .code
8039 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8040 .endd
8041 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8042 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8043 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8044 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8045 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8046 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8047 other statements in the same ACL.
8048
8049 .next
8050 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8051 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8052 .code
8053 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8054 .endd
8055 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8056 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8057
8058 .next
8059 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8060 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8061 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8062 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8063 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8064 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8065 expansion variable.
8066 .next
8067 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8068 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8069 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8070 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8071 .code
8072 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8073 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8074 .endd
8075 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8076 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8077 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8078 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8079 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8080 .next
8081 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8082 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8083 between the pattern and the domain.
8084 .endlist
8085
8086 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8087 .code
8088 domainlist funny_domains = \
8089 @ : \
8090 lib.unseen.edu : \
8091 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8092 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8093 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8094 nis;domains.byname : \
8095 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8096 .endd
8097 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8098 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8099 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8100 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8101 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8102 patterns earlier.
8103
8104
8105
8106 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8107 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8108 .cindex "list" "host list"
8109 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8110 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8111 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8112 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8113 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8114 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8115 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8116
8117
8118 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8119 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8120 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8121 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8122 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8123 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8124 not used.
8125
8126 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8127 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8128 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8129
8130
8131
8132 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8133 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8134 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8135 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8136 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8137 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8138 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8139 concerns.)
8140
8141 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8142 inspecting its IP address:
8143
8144 .ilist
8145 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8146 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8147 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8148 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8149 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8150 with the IP address of the subject host.
8151
8152 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8153 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8154 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8155 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8156 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8157
8158 .next
8159 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8160 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8161 domain name, as just described.
8162
8163 .next
8164 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8165 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8166 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8167 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8168 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8169 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8170 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8171 that can never match a client host.
8172
8173 .next
8174 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8175 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8176 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8177 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8178 .code
8179 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8180 accept hosts = @[]
8181 .endd
8182 .next
8183 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8184 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8185 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8186 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8187 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8188 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8189 significant end of the address.
8190
8191 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8192 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8193 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8194 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8195 .code
8196 192.168.23.236/31
8197 .endd
8198 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8199 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8200 matches.
8201
8202 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8203 .code
8204 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8205 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8206 .endd
8207 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8208 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8209 For example:
8210 .code
8211 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8212 .endd
8213 could make use of a file containing
8214 .code
8215 172.16.0.0/12
8216 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8217 .endd
8218 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8219 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8220 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8221 .code
8222 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8223 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8224 .endd
8225 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8226 list.
8227 .endlist
8228
8229
8230
8231 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8232 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8233 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8234 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8235 address, the pattern takes this form:
8236 .display
8237 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8238 .endd
8239 For example:
8240 .code
8241 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8242 .endd
8243 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8244 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8245 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8246 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8247 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8248 returned by the lookup is not used.
8249
8250 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8251 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8252 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8253 patterns of this form:
8254 .display
8255 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8256 .endd
8257 For example:
8258 .code
8259 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8260 .endd
8261 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8262 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8263 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8264 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8265 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8266
8267 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8268 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8269 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8270 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8271 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8272 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8273 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8274 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8275 addresses are always used.
8276
8277 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8278 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8279 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8280 configurations.
8281
8282 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8283 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8284 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8285 case the IP address is used on its own.
8286
8287
8288
8289 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8290 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8291 .cindex "unknown host name"
8292 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8293 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8294 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8295 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8296 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8297 above.)
8298
8299 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8300 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8301 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8302 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8303 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8304 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8305 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8306
8307 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8308 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8309
8310 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8311 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8312 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8313 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8314 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8315 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8316 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8317 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8318 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8319
8320 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8321 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8322
8323 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8324 .cindex "alias for host"
8325 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8326 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8327
8328 .ilist
8329 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8330 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8331 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8332 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8333 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8334 expression.
8335 .next
8336 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8337 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8338 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8339 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8340 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8341 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8342 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8343 example,
8344 .code
8345 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8346 .endd
8347 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8348 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8349 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8350 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8351 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8352 .code
8353 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8354 .endd
8355 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8356 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8357 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8358 required.
8359 .endlist
8360
8361
8362
8363
8364 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8365 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8366 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8367 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8368 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8369 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8370
8371 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8372 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8373
8374 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8375 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8376 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8377 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8378 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8379 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8380 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8381 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8382 not recognized in an indirected file).
8383
8384 .ilist
8385 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8386 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8387 .code
8388 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8389 .endd
8390 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8391 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8392
8393 .next
8394 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8395 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8396 example:
8397 .code
8398 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8399 192.168.4.5
8400 .endd
8401 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8402 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8403 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8404 .endlist
8405
8406 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8407 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8408 list.
8409
8410 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8411 "SECTmixwilhos"
8412 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8413
8414 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8415 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8416 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8417
8418 .ilist
8419 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8420 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8421 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8422 .code
8423 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8424 .endd
8425 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8426 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8427 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8428 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8429 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8430 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8431 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8432
8433 .next
8434 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8435 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8436 .code
8437 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8438 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8439 .endd
8440 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8441 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8442 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8443 this section.
8444 .endlist
8445
8446
8447 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8448 "SECTtemdnserr"
8449 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8450 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8451 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8452 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8453 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8454 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8455 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8456 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8457 host lists such as whitelists.
8458
8459
8460
8461 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8462 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8463 .cindex "unknown host name"
8464 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8465 If a pattern is of the form
8466 .display
8467 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8468 .endd
8469 for example
8470 .code
8471 dbm;/host/accept/list
8472 .endd
8473 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8474 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8475 is not used.
8476
8477 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8478 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8479 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8480 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8481 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8482 lookup, both using the same file.
8483
8484
8485
8486 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8487 If a pattern is of the form
8488 .display
8489 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8490 .endd
8491 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8492 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8493 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8494 .code
8495 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8496 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8497 .endd
8498 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8499 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8500 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8501 operator.
8502
8503 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8504 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8505 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8506
8507 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8508 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8509 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8510 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8511 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8512 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8513
8514
8515
8516
8517
8518 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8519 .cindex "list" "address list"
8520 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8521 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8522 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8523 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8524 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8525 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8526 using this option setting:
8527 .code
8528 senders = :
8529 .endd
8530 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8531 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8532 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8533 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8534
8535 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8536 example:
8537 .code
8538 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8539 .endd
8540 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8541 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8542 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8543 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8544 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8545 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8546 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8547 .code
8548 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8549 *@+hostile_domains:\
8550 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8551 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8552 .endd
8553 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8554 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8555 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8556 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8557 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8558
8559 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8560 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8561 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8562 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8563 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8564 .code
8565 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8566 .endd
8567
8568 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8569 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8570 senders:
8571
8572 .ilist
8573 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8574 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8575 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8576 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8577 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8578 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8579 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8580 .code
8581 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8582 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8583 .endd
8584 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8585 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8586
8587 .next
8588 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8589 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8590 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8591 example:
8592 .code
8593 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8594 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8595 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8596 .endd
8597 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8598 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8599 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8600 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8601
8602 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8603 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8604 panic log.
8605 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8606 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8607 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8608 default. For example, with this lookup:
8609 .code
8610 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8611 .endd
8612 the file could contains lines like this:
8613 .code
8614 user1@domain1.example
8615 *@domain2.example
8616 .endd
8617 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8618 that are tried is:
8619 .code
8620 nimrod@jaeger.example
8621 *@jaeger.example
8622 *
8623 .endd
8624 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8625 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8626
8627 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8628 .code
8629 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8630 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8631 .endd
8632 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8633 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8634 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8635 .endlist
8636
8637
8638 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8639 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8640 always fails.
8641
8642
8643 .ilist
8644 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8645 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8646 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8647 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8648 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8649 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8650 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8651 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8652 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8653
8654 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8655 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8656 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8657 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8658 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8659 with
8660 .code
8661 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8662 .endd
8663 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8664 .code
8665 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8666 .endd
8667 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8668
8669 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8670 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8671 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8672 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8673 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8674 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8675 .code
8676 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8677 spammer3 : spammer4
8678 .endd
8679 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8680 doubling.
8681
8682 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8683 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8684 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8685 might have entries like
8686 .code
8687 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8688 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8689 *: ^\d{8}$
8690 .endd
8691 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8692 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8693 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8694 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8695
8696 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8697 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8698 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8699
8700 .next
8701 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8702 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8703 can only return a single list of local parts.
8704 .endlist
8705
8706 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8707 in these two examples:
8708 .code
8709 senders = +my_list
8710 senders = *@+my_list
8711 .endd
8712 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8713 example it is a named domain list.
8714
8715
8716
8717
8718 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8719 .cindex "case of local parts"
8720 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8721 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8722 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8723 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8724 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8725 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8726 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8727 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8728 default.
8729
8730 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8731 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8732 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8733 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8734 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8735 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8736 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8737 case-independent.
8738
8739 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8740 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8741 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8742 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8743 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8744 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8745 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8746 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8747
8748
8749
8750 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8751 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8752 .cindex "local part" "list"
8753 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8754 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8755 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8756 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8757 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8758 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8759 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8760 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8761
8762 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8763 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8764 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8765 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8766 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8767 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8768 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8769 types.
8770 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8771
8772
8773
8774
8775 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8776 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8777
8778 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8779 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8780 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8781 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8782
8783 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8784 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8785 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8786 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8787 escape character, as described in the following section.
8788
8789 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
8790 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
8791 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
8792 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
8793 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
8794 reasons.
8795
8796
8797
8798 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8799 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8800 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8801 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8802 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8803 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8804 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8805 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8806
8807 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8808 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8809 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8810 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8811 .code
8812 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8813 .endd
8814 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8815 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8816 string.
8817
8818
8819
8820 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8821 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8822 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8823 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8824 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8825 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8826 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8827 encoding.
8828
8829 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8830 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8831 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8832
8833
8834 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8835 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8836 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8837 .oindex "&%-be%&"
8838 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8839 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8840 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8841 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8842 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8843 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8844 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8845 and &%nhash%&.
8846
8847 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8848 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8849 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8850
8851 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
8852 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8853 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8854 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8855 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8856 .code
8857 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8858 .endd
8859 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8860 Exim message identifier. For example:
8861 .code
8862 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8863 .endd
8864 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8865 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8866
8867
8868 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8869 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8870 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8871 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8872 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8873 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8874 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8875 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8876 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8877 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8878 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8879 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8880 being expanded.
8881
8882
8883
8884
8885 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8886 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8887 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8888 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8889 white space is significant.
8890
8891 .vlist
8892 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8893 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8894 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8895 .code
8896 $local_part
8897 ${domain}
8898 .endd
8899 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8900 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8901 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8902 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8903 given, the expansion fails.
8904
8905 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8906 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8907 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8908 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8909 .code
8910 ${lc:$local_part}
8911 .endd
8912 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8913 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8914 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8915 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8916 string easier to understand.
8917
8918 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8919 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8920 expansion item below.
8921
8922
8923 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8924 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
8925 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
8926 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
8927 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
8928 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
8929 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
8930 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
8931 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
8932 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
8933 the result of the expansion.
8934 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
8935 the expansion result is an empty string.
8936 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
8937
8938
8939 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
8940 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8941 .cindex "expansion" "extracting cerificate fields"
8942 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
8943 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
8944 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
8945 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
8946 the certificate. Supported fields are:
8947 .display
8948 &`version `&
8949 &`serial_number `&
8950 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
8951 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
8952 &`notbefore `& time
8953 &`notafter `& time
8954 &`sig_algorithm `&
8955 &`signature `&
8956 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
8957 &`ocsp_uri `& list
8958 &`crl_uri `& list
8959 .endd
8960 If the field is found,
8961 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8962 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8963 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8964 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8965
8966 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8967 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8968 extracted is used.
8969
8970 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
8971
8972 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
8973 output a Distinguished Name string which is
8974 not quite
8975 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
8976 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
8977 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
8978 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
8979 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
8980 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
8981 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
8982 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
8983
8984 The field selectors marked as "time" above
8985 take an optional modifier of "int"
8986 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
8987 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
8988 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
8989
8990 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
8991 newline-separated by default,
8992 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
8993 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
8994 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
8995
8996 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
8997 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
8998 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
8999 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9000 if so the element tags are omitted.
9001
9002 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9003
9004 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9005 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9006 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
9007 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9008 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9009 .code
9010 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9011 .endd
9012 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9013 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9014 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9015
9016 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9017 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9018 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9019 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9020 must have the following type:
9021 .code
9022 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9023 .endd
9024 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9025 function should return one of the following values:
9026
9027 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9028 into the expanded string that is being built.
9029
9030 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9031 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9032
9033 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9034 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9035
9036 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9037
9038 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9039 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9040 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9041
9042
9043 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9044 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9045 .cindex "environment" "value from"
9046 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9047 removed.
9048 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9049 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9050 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9051
9052 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9053 appear, for example:
9054 .code
9055 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9056 .endd
9057 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9058 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9059
9060 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9061 search failure.
9062 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9063 search success.
9064
9065
9066 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9067 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9068 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9069 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9070 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9071 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9072 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
9073 form:
9074 .display
9075 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9076 .endd
9077 .vindex "&$value$&"
9078 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9079 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9080 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9081 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9082 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9083 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9084 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9085 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9086 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9087
9088 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9089 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9090 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9091 yield &"2001"&:
9092 .code
9093 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9094 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9095 .endd
9096 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9097 appear, for example:
9098 .code
9099 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9100 .endd
9101 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9102 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9103
9104
9105 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9106 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9107 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9108 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9109 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9110 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9111 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9112 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9113 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9114 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9115 <&'string3'&> as before.
9116
9117 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9118 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9119 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9120 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9121 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9122 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9123 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9124 provided. For example:
9125 .code
9126 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9127 .endd
9128 yields &"42"&, and
9129 .code
9130 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9131 .endd
9132 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9133 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9134
9135
9136 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9137 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9138 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9139 .vindex "&$item$&"
9140 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9141 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9142 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9143 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9144 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9145 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9146 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9147 .code
9148 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
9149 .endd
9150 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9151 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9152
9153
9154 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9155 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9156 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9157 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9158 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9159 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9160
9161 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9162 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9163 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9164 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9165 .code
9166 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9167 .endd
9168 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9169 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9170 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9171 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9172 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9173 .code
9174 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9175 .endd
9176 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9177 letters appear. For example:
9178 .display
9179 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9180 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9181 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9182 .endd
9183
9184 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9185 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9186 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9187 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9188 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9189 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9190 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9191 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9192 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9193 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9194 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9195 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9196 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9197 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9198 .code
9199 $header_reply-to:
9200 .endd
9201 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9202 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9203 lines) may be present.
9204
9205 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
9206 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9207
9208 .ilist
9209 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9210 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9211 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9212
9213 .next
9214 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9215 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9216 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9217 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9218 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9219 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9220 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9221 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9222
9223 .next
9224 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9225 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9226 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9227 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9228 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9229 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9230 .endlist ilist
9231
9232 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9233 command of the following form:
9234 .code
9235 headers charset "UTF-8"
9236 .endd
9237 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9238 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9239 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9240 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9241 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9242 ISO-8859-1.
9243
9244 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9245 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9246 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9247 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9248
9249 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9250 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9251 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9252 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9253 router or transport are not accessible.
9254
9255 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
9256 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
9257 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9258 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9259 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
9260 by earlier ACLs are visible.
9261
9262 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9263 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9264 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9265 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
9266 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
9267 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
9268 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
9269
9270 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9271 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9272 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9273 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9274 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9275 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9276 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9277 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9278
9279
9280 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9281 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9282 .cindex &%hmac%&
9283 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9284 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9285 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9286 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9287 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9288 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9289 present. For example:
9290 .code
9291 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9292 .endd
9293 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9294 produces:
9295 .code
9296 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9297 .endd
9298 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9299 an Exim configuration:
9300 .code
9301 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9302 .endd
9303 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9304 .code
9305 headers_add = \
9306 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9307 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9308 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9309 .endd
9310 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9311 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9312 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9313 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9314 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9315 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9316
9317
9318 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9319 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9320 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9321 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9322 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9323 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9324 .code
9325 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9326 .endd
9327 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9328 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9329 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9330 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9331 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9332
9333 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9334 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9335 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9336 .code
9337 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9338 .endd
9339 you can use
9340 .code
9341 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9342 .endd
9343
9344 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9345 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9346 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9347 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9348 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9349 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9350 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9351 some of the braces:
9352 .code
9353 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9354 .endd
9355 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
9356 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9357 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9358
9359
9360 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9361 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9362 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9363 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9364 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9365 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9366 apart from an optional leading minus,
9367 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9368
9369 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9370 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9371
9372 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9373 If the number is negative, the fields are
9374 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9375 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9376 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9377
9378 If the modulus of the
9379 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9380 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9381
9382 For example:
9383 .code
9384 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9385 .endd
9386 yields &"42"&, and
9387 .code
9388 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9389 .endd
9390 yields &"result: 99"&.
9391
9392 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9393 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9394 extracted is used.
9395 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9396
9397
9398 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9399 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9400 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9401 described in the next item.
9402
9403 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9404 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9405 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9406 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9407 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9408 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9409 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9410 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9411 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9412
9413 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9414 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9415 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9416 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9417 out by the system administrator.
9418
9419 .vindex "&$value$&"
9420 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9421 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9422 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9423 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9424 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9425 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9426 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9427 original lookup fails.
9428
9429 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9430 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9431 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9432 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9433 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9434 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9435 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9436 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9437
9438 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9439 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9440 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9441 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9442
9443 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9444 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9445 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9446 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9447
9448 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9449 .code
9450 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9451 .endd
9452 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9453 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9454 .code
9455 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9456 {$value}fail}
9457 .endd
9458
9459
9460 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9461 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9462 .vindex "&$item$&"
9463 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9464 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9465 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9466 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9467 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9468 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9469 .code
9470 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9471 .endd
9472 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9473 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9474 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9475
9476 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9477 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9478 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9479 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9480 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9481 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9482 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9483 .code
9484 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9485 .endd
9486 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9487 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9488 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9489 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9490 example,
9491 .code
9492 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9493 .endd
9494 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9495
9496
9497
9498 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9499 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9500 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9501 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9502 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9503 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9504 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9505 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9506
9507 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9508 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9509 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9510 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9511 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9512 not its contents.
9513
9514 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9515 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9516 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9517
9518 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9519 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9520
9521
9522 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9523 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9524 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9525 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9526 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9527 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9528 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9529 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9530
9531 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9532 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9533 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9534 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9535 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9536 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9537 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9538 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9539 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9540 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9541
9542 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9543 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9544 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9545 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9546
9547 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9548 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9549 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9550 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9551 is the expansion of the third argument.
9552
9553 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9554 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9555 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9556
9557 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9558 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9559 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9560 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9561 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9562 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9563 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9564 newlines are left in the string.
9565 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9566 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9567 the string expansion fails.
9568
9569 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9570 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9571
9572
9573
9574 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9575 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9576 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9577 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9578 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9579 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9580 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9581 examples:
9582 .code
9583 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9584 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9585 .endd
9586 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9587 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9588 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9589 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9590 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9591 example:
9592 .code
9593 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9594 .endd
9595 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9596 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9597 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9598 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9599 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9600 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9601 .code
9602 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9603 .endd
9604 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9605 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9606 turns them into spaces:
9607 .code
9608 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9609 .endd
9610 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9611 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9612 addition, the following errors can occur:
9613
9614 .ilist
9615 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9616 .next
9617 Failure to connect the socket;
9618 .next
9619 Failure to write the request string;
9620 .next
9621 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9622 .endlist
9623
9624 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9625 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9626 errors occurs. For example:
9627 .code
9628 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9629 {socket failure}}
9630 .endd
9631 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9632 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9633 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9634 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9635 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9636
9637 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9638 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9639
9640
9641 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9642 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9643 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9644 .vindex "&$value$&"
9645 .vindex "&$item$&"
9646 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9647 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9648 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9649 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9650 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9651 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9652 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9653 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9654 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9655 .code
9656 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9657 .endd
9658 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9659 can be found:
9660 .code
9661 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9662 .endd
9663 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9664 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9665 expansion items.
9666
9667 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9668 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9669 expansion item above.
9670
9671 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9672 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9673 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9674 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9675 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9676 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9677 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
9678 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
9679 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9680
9681 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
9682 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
9683 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
9684 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
9685 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
9686 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
9687 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
9688 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
9689 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
9690 character.
9691
9692 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9693 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9694 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9695 .vindex "&$value$&"
9696 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9697 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9698 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9699 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9700 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9701 &$value$&.
9702
9703 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9704 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9705 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9706 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9707
9708 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
9709 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
9710 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
9711 troubleshoot:
9712 .code
9713 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
9714 log_message = Output of id: $value
9715 .endd
9716 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
9717 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
9718 .code
9719 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
9720 .endd
9721
9722 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9723 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9724 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9725 .code
9726 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9727 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9728 ...
9729 endif
9730 .endd
9731 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9732 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9733 commands.
9734
9735 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9736 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9737 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9738 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9739
9740 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9741 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9742
9743
9744 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9745 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9746 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9747 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9748 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9749 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9750 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9751 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9752 .code
9753 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9754 .endd
9755 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9756 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9757 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9758 .code
9759 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9760 .endd
9761 yields &"defabc"&, and
9762 .code
9763 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9764 .endd
9765 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9766 the regular expression from string expansion.
9767
9768
9769
9770 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
9771 .cindex sorting "a list"
9772 .cindex list sorting
9773 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
9774 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9775 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9776 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
9777 of a two-argument expansion condition.
9778 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
9779 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
9780 if the first value should sort before the second value.
9781 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
9782 the element being placed in &$item$&,
9783 to give values for comparison.
9784
9785 The item result is a sorted list,
9786 with the original list separator,
9787 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
9788
9789 Examples:
9790 .code
9791 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
9792 .endd
9793 sorts a list of numbers, and
9794 .code
9795 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
9796 .endd
9797 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
9798
9799
9800 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9801 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9802 .cindex "substring extraction"
9803 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9804 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9805 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9806 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9807 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9808 .code
9809 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9810 .endd
9811 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9812 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9813 omitted.
9814
9815 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9816 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9817 length required. For example
9818 .code
9819 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9820 .endd
9821 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9822 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9823 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9824 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9825
9826 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9827 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9828 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9829 .code
9830 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9831 .endd
9832 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9833 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9834 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9835 .code
9836 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9837 .endd
9838 yields an empty string, but
9839 .code
9840 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9841 .endd
9842 yields &"1"&.
9843
9844 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9845 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9846 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9847 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9848 .code
9849 ${substr_-1:abcde}
9850 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9851 .endd
9852 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9853
9854
9855
9856 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9857 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9858 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9859 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9860 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9861 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9862 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9863 replacement list. For example
9864 .code
9865 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9866 .endd
9867 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9868 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9869 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9870 place.
9871 .endlist
9872
9873
9874
9875 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9876 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9877 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9878 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9879 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9880 following operations can be performed:
9881
9882 .vlist
9883 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9884 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9885 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9886 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9887 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9888 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9889
9890
9891 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9892 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9893 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9894 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9895 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9896 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9897 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9898 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9899 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9900
9901 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9902 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9903 character. For example:
9904 .code
9905 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9906 .endd
9907 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9908 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9909 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9910 processing lists.
9911
9912 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
9913 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
9914 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
9915 email address separator. For the example header line:
9916 .code
9917 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
9918 .endd
9919 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
9920 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
9921 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
9922 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
9923 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
9924 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
9925 quoted.
9926 .code
9927 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
9928 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
9929 user@example.com
9930 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
9931 Last:user@example.com
9932 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
9933 user@example.com
9934 .endd
9935
9936 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9937 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9938 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9939 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9940 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9941 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9942 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9943 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9944 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9945
9946 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9947 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9948 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9949 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9950 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9951 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9952 string.
9953
9954
9955 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9956 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9957 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9958 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9959 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9960
9961
9962 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9963 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9964 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9965 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9966 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9967 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9968 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9969
9970
9971 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9972 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9973 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9974 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9975 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9976 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9977 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9978 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9979 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9980 C programming language):
9981 .table2 70pt 300pt
9982 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9983 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9984 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9985 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9986 .irow "" "and (&&)"
9987 .irow "" "xor (^)"
9988 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9989 .endtable
9990 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9991 space is permitted before or after operators.
9992
9993 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9994 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9995 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9996 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9997 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9998
9999 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10000 or 1024*1024*1024,
10001 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10002 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10003
10004 .display
10005 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10006 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10007 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10008 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10009 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10010 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10011 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10012 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10013 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10014 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10015 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10016 .endd
10017
10018 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10019 .code
10020 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10021 condition = \
10022 ${if and { \
10023 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10024 { \
10025 < \
10026 {$recipients_count} \
10027 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10028 } \
10029 }{yes}{no}}
10030 .endd
10031 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10032 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10033
10034
10035 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10036 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10037 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10038 example,
10039 .code
10040 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10041 .endd
10042 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10043 and then re-expands what it has found.
10044
10045
10046 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10047 .cindex "Unicode"
10048 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10049 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10050 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10051 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10052 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10053 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10054 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10055 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10056 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10057
10058 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10059 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10060 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10061 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10062 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10063 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10064 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10065
10066
10067 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10068 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10069 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10070 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10071 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10072 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10073 .code
10074 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10075 .endd
10076 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10077 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10078
10079
10080
10081 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10082 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10083 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10084 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10085 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10086 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
10087
10088
10089
10090 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10091 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10092 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10093 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10094 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10095 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10096 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10097
10098
10099 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10100 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10101 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10102 .cindex "lower casing"
10103 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10104 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10105 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10106 .code
10107 ${lc:$local_part}
10108 .endd
10109
10110 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10111 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10112 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10113 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10114 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10115 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10116 .code
10117 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10118 .endd
10119 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10120 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10121 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10122
10123
10124 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10125 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10126 .cindex "list" "item count"
10127 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10128 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10129 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10130
10131
10132 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10133 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10134 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10135 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10136 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10137 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10138 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10139 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10140 matching list is returned.
10141
10142
10143 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10144 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10145 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10146 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10147 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10148 empty.
10149
10150
10151 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10152 .cindex "masked IP address"
10153 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10154 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10155 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10156 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10157 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10158 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10159 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10160 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10161 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10162 .code
10163 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10164 .endd
10165 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10166 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10167 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10168 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10169 .code
10170 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10171 .endd
10172 returns the string
10173 .code
10174 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10175 .endd
10176 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10177
10178
10179 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10180 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10181 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10182 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10183 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10184 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10185 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10186
10187
10188 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10189 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10190 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10191 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10192 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10193 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10194 .code
10195 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10196 .endd
10197 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10198
10199
10200 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10201 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10202 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10203 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10204 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10205 is an empty string or
10206 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10207 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10208 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10209 respectively For example,
10210 .code
10211 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10212 .endd
10213 becomes
10214 .code
10215 "ab\"*\"cd"
10216 .endd
10217 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10218 variable or a message header.
10219
10220 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10221 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10222 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10223 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10224 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10225 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10226 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10227
10228
10229 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10230 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10231 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10232 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10233 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10234 .code
10235 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10236 .endd
10237 returns
10238 .code
10239 two%20%5C2A%20two
10240 .endd
10241 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10242 yields an unchanged string.
10243
10244
10245 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10246 .cindex "random number"
10247 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10248 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10249 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10250 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10251 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10252 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10253 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10254 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10255 random().
10256
10257
10258 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10259 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10260 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10261 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10262 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10263 for DNS. For example,
10264 .code
10265 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10266 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10267 .endd
10268 returns
10269 .code
10270 4.2.0.192
10271 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10272 .endd
10273
10274
10275 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10276 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10277 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10278 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10279 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10280 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10281 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10282 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
10283 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10284 characters
10285 .code
10286 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10287 .endd
10288 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10289 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10290 characters.
10291
10292
10293 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10294 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10295 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10296 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10297 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10298 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10299 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10300 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10301
10302 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10303 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10304 to use this operator as well.
10305
10306
10307
10308 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10309 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10310 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10311 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10312 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10313 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10314 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10315
10316
10317 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10318 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10319 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10320 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10321 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10322 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10323 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10324
10325
10326 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'certificate'&>&*}*&
10327 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10328 .cindex "certificate fingerprint"
10329 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10330 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10331 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the
10332 certificate,
10333 and returns
10334 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10335 Only arguments which are a single variable of certificate type are supported.
10336
10337
10338 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10339 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10340 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10341 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10342 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10343 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10344 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10345 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10346 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10347 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10348 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10349 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10350 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10351
10352 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10353 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10354 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10355
10356 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10357 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10358 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10359 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10360 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10361
10362
10363
10364 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10365 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10366 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10367 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10368 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10369 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10370
10371
10372 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10373 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10374 .cindex "substring extraction"
10375 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10376 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10377 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10378 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10379 .code
10380 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10381 .endd
10382 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10383 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10384
10385 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10386 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10387 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10388 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10389 seconds.
10390
10391 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10392 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10393 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10394 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10395 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10396 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10397 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10398
10399 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10400 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10401 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10402 .cindex "upper casing"
10403 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10404 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10405 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10406
10407 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10408 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10409 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10410 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10411 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10412 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10413 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10414 .endlist
10415
10416
10417
10418
10419
10420
10421 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10422 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10423 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10424 while expanding strings:
10425
10426 .vlist
10427 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10428 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10429 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10430 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10431 condition.
10432
10433 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10434 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10435 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10436 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10437 are:
10438 .display
10439 &`= `& equal
10440 &`== `& equal
10441 &`> `& greater
10442 &`>= `& greater or equal
10443 &`< `& less
10444 &`<= `& less or equal
10445 .endd
10446 For example:
10447 .code
10448 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10449 .endd
10450 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10451 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10452 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10453 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10454 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10455 zero.
10456
10457 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10458 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10459 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10460
10461
10462 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10463 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10464 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10465 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10466 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10467 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10468 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10469 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10470 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10471 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10472 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10473 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10474 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10475 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10476
10477 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10478 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10479 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10480 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10481 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10482 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10483 false if zero.
10484 An empty string is treated as false.
10485 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10486 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10487 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10488
10489 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10490 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10491 For example:
10492 .code
10493 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10494 .endd
10495
10496
10497 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10498 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10499 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10500 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10501 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10502 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10503 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10504 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10505
10506 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10507
10508 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10509 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10510 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10511 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10512 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10513 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10514 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10515 included in the binary.
10516
10517 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10518 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10519 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10520 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10521 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10522 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10523 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10524 string in LDAP form is:
10525 .code
10526 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10527 .endd
10528 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10529 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10530 .code
10531 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10532 .endd
10533 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10534 supported:
10535
10536 .ilist
10537 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10538 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10539 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10540 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10541 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
10542 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
10543 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
10544 comparison fails.
10545
10546 .next
10547 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10548 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
10549 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
10550 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
10551 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
10552 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
10553
10554 .next
10555 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
10556 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
10557 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
10558 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
10559 whatever its length.
10560
10561 .next
10562 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
10563 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
10564 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
10565 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
10566 .endlist
10567 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
10568 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
10569 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
10570 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
10571 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
10572 support &[crypt16()]&.
10573
10574 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
10575 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
10576 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
10577 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
10578 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
10579
10580 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
10581 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
10582 Exim is seen as very low priority.
10583
10584 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
10585 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
10586 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
10587 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
10588 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
10589
10590 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
10591 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
10592 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
10593 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
10594 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
10595 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
10596 .code
10597 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
10598 .endd
10599 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
10600 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
10601
10602 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
10603 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10604 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
10605 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
10606 exists in the message. For example,
10607 .code
10608 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
10609 .endd
10610 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
10611 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
10612
10613 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10614 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10615 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10616 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10617 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
10618 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
10619 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
10620 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
10621 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
10622
10623 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
10624 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
10625 .cindex "file" "existence test"
10626 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
10627 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
10628 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
10629 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
10630 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
10631
10632 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
10633 .cindex "delivery" "first"
10634 .cindex "first delivery"
10635 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
10636 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
10637 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
10638 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
10639
10640
10641 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
10642 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
10643 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10644 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
10645 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
10646 .vindex "&$item$&"
10647 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
10648 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
10649 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
10650 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
10651 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
10652 .ilist
10653 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
10654 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
10655 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
10656 .next
10657 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
10658 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
10659 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
10660 .endlist
10661 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
10662 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
10663 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
10664 list separator is changed to a comma:
10665 .code
10666 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
10667 .endd
10668 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
10669 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
10670
10671 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
10672
10673
10674 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10675 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10676 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10677 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10678 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
10679 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
10680 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10681 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
10682 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
10683 case-independent.
10684
10685 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10686 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10687 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10688 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10689 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
10690 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
10691 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10692 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
10693 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
10694 case-independent.
10695
10696 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10697 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10698 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10699 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
10700 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
10701 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
10702 is true.
10703
10704 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
10705 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
10706 .code
10707 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
10708 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
10709 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
10710 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
10711 .endd
10712
10713 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10714 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10715 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10716 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
10717 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
10718 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
10719 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
10720 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
10721 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
10722 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
10723 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
10724
10725 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
10726 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
10727 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
10728 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10729 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10730
10731 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10732 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10733 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10734 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10735 .code
10736 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10737 .endd
10738 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10739
10740 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10741 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10742 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10743 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10744 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10745 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10746 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10747 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10748 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10749 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10750 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10751 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10752 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10753 this can be used.
10754
10755
10756 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10757 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10758 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10759 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10760 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10761 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10762 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10763 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10764 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10765 case-independent.
10766
10767 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10768 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10769 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10770 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10771 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10772 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10773 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10774 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10775 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10776 case-independent.
10777
10778
10779 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10780 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10781 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10782 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10783 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10784 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10785 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10786 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10787 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10788 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10789 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10790 For example,
10791 .code
10792 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10793 .endd
10794 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10795 backslashes is also required.
10796
10797 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10798 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10799 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10800 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10801 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10802 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10803
10804 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10805 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10806 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10807 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10808 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10809 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10810 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10811 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10812
10813 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10814 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10815 See &*match_local_part*&.
10816
10817 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10818 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10819 See &*match_local_part*&.
10820
10821 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10822 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10823 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10824 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10825 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
10826 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10827 .code
10828 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10829 .endd
10830 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10831
10832 .ilist
10833 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10834 .next
10835 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10836 .next
10837 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10838 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10839 in a single test such as
10840 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10841 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10842 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10843 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10844 .code
10845 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10846 .endd
10847 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10848 .next
10849 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10850 .next
10851 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10852 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10853 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10854 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10855 masks. For example:
10856 .code
10857 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10858 .endd
10859 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10860 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10861 address mask, for example:
10862 .code
10863 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10864 .endd
10865 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10866 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10867 .code
10868 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10869 .endd
10870 .endlist ilist
10871
10872 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10873 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10874
10875 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10876
10877 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10878 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10879 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10880 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10881 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10882 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10883 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10884 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10885 example is:
10886 .code
10887 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10888 .endd
10889 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10890 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10891 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10892 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10893 .code
10894 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10895 .endd
10896 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10897 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10898 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10899 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10900 caselessly.
10901
10902 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
10903 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
10904
10905 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10906 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10907 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10908 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10909
10910 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10911 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10912 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10913 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10914 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10915 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10916 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10917 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10918 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10919 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10920 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10921 .code
10922 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10923 .endd
10924 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10925 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10926
10927 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10928 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10929 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10930 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10931 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10932 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10933 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10934
10935 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10936 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10937 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10938 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10939 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10940 .code
10941 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10942 .endd
10943 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10944 .code
10945 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10946 .endd
10947 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10948 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10949 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10950 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10951 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10952 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10953 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10954 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10955
10956
10957 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10958 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10959 .cindex "Cyrus"
10960 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10961 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10962 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10963 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10964 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10965 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10966
10967 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10968 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10969 building Exim. For example:
10970 .code
10971 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10972 .endd
10973 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10974 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10975 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10976 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10977
10978 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10979 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10980 configuration, you might have this:
10981 .code
10982 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10983 .endd
10984 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
10985 .code
10986 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
10987 .endd
10988 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10989 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10990 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10991 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10992 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10993 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10994
10995
10996 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10997 .cindex "Radius"
10998 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10999 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11000 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11001 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11002 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11003 support.
11004
11005 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11006 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11007 this library, you need to set
11008 .code
11009 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11010 .endd
11011 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11012 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11013 .code
11014 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11015 .endd
11016 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11017 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11018 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11019
11020 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11021 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11022 the authentication is successful. For example:
11023 .code
11024 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11025 .endd
11026
11027
11028 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11029 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11030 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11031 .cindex "Cyrus"
11032 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11033 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11034 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11035 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11036 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11037 by a process that is not running as root.
11038
11039 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11040 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11041 building Exim. For example:
11042 .code
11043 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11044 .endd
11045 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11046 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11047 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11048
11049 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11050 two are mandatory. For example:
11051 .code
11052 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11053 .endd
11054 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11055 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11056 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11057 .endlist vlist
11058
11059
11060
11061 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11062 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11063 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11064 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11065 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11066 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11067 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11068
11069
11070 .vlist
11071 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11072 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11073 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11074 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11075 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11076 For example,
11077 .code
11078 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11079 .endd
11080 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11081 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11082 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11083
11084 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11085 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11086 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11087 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11088 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11089 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11090 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11091 parsed but not evaluated.
11092 .endlist
11093 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11094
11095
11096
11097
11098 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11099 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11100 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11101 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11102 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11103
11104 .vlist
11105 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11106 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11107 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11108 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11109 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11110 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11111 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11112 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11113 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11114 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11115 matching condition.
11116
11117 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11118 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11119 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11120 any unused variables being made empty.
11121
11122 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11123 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11124 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11125 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11126 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11127 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11128 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11129 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11130 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11131 during subsequent delivery.
11132
11133 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11134 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11135 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11136 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11137 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11138 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11139 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11140 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11141 delivery.
11142
11143 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11144 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11145 this variable has the number of arguments.
11146
11147 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11148 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11149 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11150 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11151 be preserved by coding like this:
11152 .code
11153 warn !verify = sender
11154 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11155 .endd
11156 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11157 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11158 failure.
11159
11160 .vitem &$address_data$&
11161 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11162 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11163 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11164 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11165 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11166 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11167 user filter files.
11168
11169 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11170 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11171 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11172 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11173 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11174 from the child's routing.
11175
11176 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11177 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11178 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11179 address.
11180
11181 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11182 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11183 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11184
11185 .vitem &$address_file$&
11186 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11187 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11188 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11189 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11190 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11191 .code
11192 /home/r2d2/savemail
11193 .endd
11194 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11195 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11196 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11197 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11198 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11199 to the relevant file.
11200
11201 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11202 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11203 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11204 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11205
11206 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11207 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11208 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11209 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11210
11211 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11212 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11213 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11214 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11215 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11216 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11217 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11218 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11219 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11220 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11221 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11222 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11223 command line option.
11224
11225 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11226 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11227 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11228 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11229 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11230 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11231 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11232 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11233 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11234 the ACL's as well.
11235
11236
11237 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11238 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11239 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11240 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11241 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11242 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11243 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11244 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11245 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11246 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11247 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11248
11249 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11250 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11251 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11252 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11253 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11254
11255
11256 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11257 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11258 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11259 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11260 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11261 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11262 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11263 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11264 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11265 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11266 an undefined mechanism.
11267
11268 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11269 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11270 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11271 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11272 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11273 the ACL malware condition.
11274
11275 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11276 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11277 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11278 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11279 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11280 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11281
11282 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11283 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11284 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11285 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11286 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11287 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11288 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11289
11290 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11291 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11292 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11293 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11294 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11295
11296 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11297 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11298 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11299 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11300 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11301
11302 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11303 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11304 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11305 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11306 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11307 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11308 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11309
11310 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11311 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11312 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11313 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11314 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11315 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11316 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11317
11318 .vitem &$compile_date$&
11319 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
11320 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
11321
11322 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11323 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11324 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11325 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11326 compilations of the same version of the program.
11327
11328 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11329 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11330 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11331 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11332 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11333 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11334
11335 .vitem &$config_file$&
11336 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11337 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11338
11339 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
11340 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
11341 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
11342 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
11343 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11344
11345 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
11346 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
11347 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11348 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11349 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11350
11351 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11352 &$dkim_verify_status$& &&&
11353 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11354 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11355 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11356 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11357 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11358 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11359 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11360 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11361 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11362 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11363 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11364 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11365 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11366 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11367 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11368 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11369 &$dkim_key_notes$&
11370 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11371 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11372
11373 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11374 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11375 When a message has been received this variable contains
11376 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11377 For details see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
11378
11379 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11380 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11381 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11382 &$dnslist_value$&
11383 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11384 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11385 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11386 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11387 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11388 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11389 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11390 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11391 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11392
11393 .vitem &$domain$&
11394 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11395 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11396 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11397 case for &$domain$&.
11398
11399 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11400 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11401 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11402 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11403
11404 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11405 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11406 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11407 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11408 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11409 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11410
11411 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11412 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11413 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11414
11415 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11416
11417 .ilist
11418 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11419 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11420 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11421 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11422 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11423 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11424 the &(smtp)& transport.
11425
11426 .next
11427 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11428 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11429 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11430 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11431
11432 .next
11433 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11434 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11435 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11436 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11437 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11438 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11439
11440 .next
11441 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11442 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11443 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11444 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11445 .endlist
11446
11447
11448 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11449 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11450 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11451 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11452 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11453 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11454 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11455 used.
11456
11457 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11458 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11459 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11460 to nothing.
11461
11462 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11463 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11464 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11465
11466 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11467 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11468 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11469
11470 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11471 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11472 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11473
11474 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11475 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11476 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11477 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11478 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11479 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11480
11481 .vitem &$found_extension$&
11482 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
11483 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11484 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
11485 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
11486
11487 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11488 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11489 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11490 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11491 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11492
11493 .vitem &$headers_added$&
11494 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11495 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11496 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11497 The headers are a newline-separated list.
11498
11499 .vitem &$home$&
11500 .vindex "&$home$&"
11501 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11502 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11503 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11504 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11505 by a setting on the transport itself.
11506
11507 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11508 of the environment variable HOME.
11509
11510 .vitem &$host$&
11511 .vindex "&$host$&"
11512 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11513 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11514 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11515 to local and remote transports.
11516
11517 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11518 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11519 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11520 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11521 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11522 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11523 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11524 is connected.
11525
11526 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11527 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11528 client is connected.
11529
11530
11531 .vitem &$host_address$&
11532 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
11533 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11534 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11535 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11536
11537 .vitem &$host_data$&
11538 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
11539 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11540 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
11541 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
11542 .code
11543 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
11544 message = $host_data
11545 .endd
11546 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11547 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
11548 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11549 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
11550 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
11551 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
11552 variables is set to &"1"&.
11553
11554 .ilist
11555 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
11556 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11557
11558 .next
11559 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
11560 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
11561 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
11562 .endlist ilist
11563
11564 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
11565 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
11566 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
11567 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
11568 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
11569 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
11570 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
11571 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
11572 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
11573 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
11574
11575 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
11576 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11577 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
11578
11579 .vitem &$host_port$&
11580 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
11581 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
11582 for an outbound connection.
11583
11584
11585 .vitem &$inode$&
11586 .vindex "&$inode$&"
11587 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
11588 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
11589 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
11590 a unique name for the file.
11591
11592 .vitem &$interface_address$&
11593 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
11594 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
11595
11596 .vitem &$interface_port$&
11597 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
11598 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
11599
11600 .vitem &$item$&
11601 .vindex "&$item$&"
11602 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
11603 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
11604 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
11605 empty.
11606
11607 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
11608 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
11609 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
11610 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
11611 lookup.
11612
11613 .vitem &$load_average$&
11614 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
11615 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
11616 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
11617 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
11618
11619 .vitem &$local_part$&
11620 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11621 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
11622 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
11623 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
11624 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
11625
11626 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11627 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
11628 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
11629 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
11630 once.
11631
11632 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11633 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11634 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
11635 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
11636 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
11637 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
11638
11639 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
11640 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
11641 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
11642 &$address_pipe$&).
11643
11644 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
11645 local part of the recipient address.
11646
11647 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11648 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
11649 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
11650
11651 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
11652 the addresses
11653 .code
11654 "abc:xyz"@test.example
11655 abc\:xyz@test.example
11656 .endd
11657 the value of &$local_part$& is
11658 .code
11659 abc:xyz
11660 .endd
11661 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
11662 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
11663 have:
11664 .code
11665 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
11666 .endd
11667 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
11668 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
11669 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
11670
11671 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
11672 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
11673 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
11674 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
11675 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
11676 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
11677 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
11678
11679 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
11680 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
11681 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
11682 variable expands to nothing.
11683
11684 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
11685 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
11686 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11687 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11688 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11689
11690 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
11691 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
11692 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
11693 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
11694 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
11695
11696 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
11697 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
11698 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
11699 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
11700
11701 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
11702 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
11703 See &$local_user_uid$&.
11704
11705 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
11706 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
11707 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
11708 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
11709 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
11710 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
11711 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
11712 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
11713
11714 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
11715 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
11716 This contains the expanded value of the
11717 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
11718 been read.
11719
11720 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
11721 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
11722 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
11723 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
11724 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
11725 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
11726
11727 .vitem &$log_space$&
11728 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
11729 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
11730 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
11731 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
11732 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
11733 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
11734
11735
11736 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
11737 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
11738 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
11739 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
11740 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
11741 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
11742 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
11743 and &"yes"& if it was.
11744 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
11745 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
11746 as authenticated data.
11747
11748 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
11749 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
11750 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
11751 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
11752 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
11753 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
11754 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
11755 variable is empty.
11756
11757 .vitem &$malware_name$&
11758 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
11759 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
11760 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
11761 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
11762
11763 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
11764 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
11765 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
11766 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
11767 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
11768 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
11769 character(s).
11770
11771 .vitem &$message_age$&
11772 .cindex "message" "age of"
11773 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
11774 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
11775 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
11776 delivery attempt.
11777
11778 .vitem &$message_body$&
11779 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11780 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11781 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11782 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
11783 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
11784 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
11785 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
11786 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
11787 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
11788
11789 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
11790 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
11791 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
11792 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
11793 zeros are always converted into spaces.
11794
11795 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
11796 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
11797 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
11798 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
11799 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
11800 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
11801 &$message_body$&.
11802
11803 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
11804 .cindex "body of message" "size"
11805 .cindex "message body" "size"
11806 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
11807 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
11808 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
11809 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
11810 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11811
11812 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
11813 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
11814 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11815 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
11816 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
11817 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
11818 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
11819 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
11820
11821 .vitem &$message_headers$&
11822 .vindex &$message_headers$&
11823 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
11824 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
11825 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11826 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11827
11828 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11829 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11830 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11831 contents of header lines is done.
11832
11833 .vitem &$message_id$&
11834 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
11835
11836 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11837 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11838 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11839 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11840 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11841 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11842 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11843 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11844 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11845 from the body is not counted.
11846
11847 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
11848 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
11849 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
11850 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
11851 header and the body).
11852
11853 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
11854 .code
11855 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11856 condition = \
11857 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11858 .endd
11859 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11860 message has not yet been received.
11861
11862 .vitem &$message_size$&
11863 .cindex "size" "of message"
11864 .cindex "message" "size"
11865 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11866 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11867 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11868 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11869 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11870 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11871 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11872 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11873 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11874
11875 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11876 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
11877 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11878 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11879
11880 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11881 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11882 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11883 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11884
11885 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11886 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11887 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11888
11889 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11890 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11891 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11892 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11893 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11894 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11895 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11896 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11897 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11898 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11899
11900 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11901 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11902 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11903
11904 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11905 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11906 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11907 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11908 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11909 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11910 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11911 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11912 the original address.
11913
11914 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11915 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11916 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11917 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11918 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11919
11920 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11921 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11922 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11923
11924 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11925 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11926 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11927 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11928 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11929 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11930 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11931 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11932 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11933
11934 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11935 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11936 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11937 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11938 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11939 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11940 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11941 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11942 user.
11943
11944 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11945 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11946 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11947 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11948
11949 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11950 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11951 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11952 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11953
11954 .vitem &$pid$&
11955 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11956 .vindex "&$pid$&"
11957 This variable contains the current process id.
11958
11959 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11960 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11961 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11962 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11963 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11964 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11965 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11966 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11967 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11968 variable"& error if encountered.
11969
11970 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11971 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11972 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11973 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11974 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11975 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11976 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11977
11978
11979 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11980 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11981 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11982 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11983
11984 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11985 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11986 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11987 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11988
11989 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11990 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11991 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11992 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11993
11994 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11995 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11996 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11997
11998 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11999 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12000 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12001 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12002
12003 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12004 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12005 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12006 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12007 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12008
12009 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12010 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12011 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12012 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12013 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12014 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12015
12016 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12017 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12018 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12019 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12020 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12021
12022 .vitem &$received_count$&
12023 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12024 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12025 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12026 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12027 delivering.
12028
12029 .vitem &$received_for$&
12030 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12031 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12032 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12033 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12034 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12035
12036 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12037 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12038 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12039 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12040 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12041 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12042 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12043 option.
12044
12045 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12046 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12047 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12048 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12049 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12050 time.
12051 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12052
12053 .vitem &$received_port$&
12054 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12055 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12056
12057 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12058 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12059 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12060 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12061 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12062 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12063 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12064 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12065 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12066
12067 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12068 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12069 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12070 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12071 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12072 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12073
12074 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12075 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12076 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12077
12078 .vitem &$received_time$&
12079 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12080 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12081 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12082
12083 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12084 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12085 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12086 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12087 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12088 .display
12089 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12090 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12091 .endd
12092 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12093 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12094 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12095 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12096
12097 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12098 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12099 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12100 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12101
12102 .ilist
12103 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12104 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12105
12106 .next
12107 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12108
12109 .next
12110 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12111 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12112 MAIL).
12113
12114 .next
12115 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12116 .next
12117
12118 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12119 .endlist
12120
12121 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12122 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12123
12124 .vitem &$recipients$&
12125 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12126 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12127 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12128 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12129 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12130 cases:
12131
12132 .olist
12133 In a system filter file.
12134 .next
12135 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12136 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12137 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12138 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12139 .next
12140 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12141 .endlist
12142
12143
12144 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12145 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12146 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12147 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12148 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12149 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12150
12151
12152 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12153 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12154 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12155 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12156
12157
12158 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12159 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12160 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12161 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12162 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12163 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12164 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12165
12166 .vitem &$return_path$&
12167 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12168 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12169 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12170 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12171 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12172 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12173 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12174 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12175 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12176 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12177 envelope sender.
12178
12179 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12180 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12181 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12182
12183 .vitem &$router_name$&
12184 .cindex "router" "name"
12185 .cindex "name" "of router"
12186 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12187 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12188
12189 .vitem &$runrc$&
12190 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12191 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12192 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12193 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12194 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12195 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12196 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12197 another.
12198
12199 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12200 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12201 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12202 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12203 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12204 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12205 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12206 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12207
12208 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12209 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12210 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12211 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12212 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12213 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12214
12215 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12216 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12217 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12218 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12219 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12220 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12221 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12222 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12223
12224 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12225 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12226 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12227
12228 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12229 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12230 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12231
12232 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12233 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12234 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12235 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12236 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12237 this:
12238 .display
12239 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12240 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12241 .endd
12242 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12243 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12244 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12245 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12246
12247 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12248 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12249 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12250 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12251 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12252 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12253 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12254 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12255 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12256 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12257 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12258 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12259 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12260
12261 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12262 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12263 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12264 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12265 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12266
12267 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12268 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12269 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12270 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12271 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12272 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12273
12274 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12275 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12276 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12277 this variable contains that
12278 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12279
12280 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12281 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12282 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12283 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12284 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12285 &$authenticated_id$&.
12286
12287 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12288 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12289 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12290 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12291 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12292 resolver library states that both
12293 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12294 other times, this variable is false.
12295
12296 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12297 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12298 library, by setting:
12299 .code
12300 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12301 .endd
12302
12303 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12304 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12305
12306 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12307 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12308
12309
12310 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12311 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12312 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12313 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12314 other means, this variable is empty.
12315
12316 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12317 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12318 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12319 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12320 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12321 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12322 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12323
12324 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12325 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12326 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12327 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12328
12329 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12330 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12331 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12332 is set to &"1"&.
12333
12334 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12335 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12336 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12337 following are true:
12338
12339 .ilist
12340 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12341 .next
12342 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12343 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12344 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12345 .next
12346 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12347 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12348 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12349 .next
12350 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12351 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12352 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12353 .next
12354 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12355 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12356 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12357 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12358 .code
12359 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12360 .endd
12361 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12362 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12363 .endlist
12364
12365
12366 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12367 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12368 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12369 number that was used on the remote host.
12370
12371 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12372 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12373 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12374 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12375 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12376 called Exim.
12377
12378 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12379 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12380 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12381 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12382
12383 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12384 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12385 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12386 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12387 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12388 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12389 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12390 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12391 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12392 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12393 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12394 the parentheses.
12395
12396 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12397 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12398 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12399 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12400 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12401
12402 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12403 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12404 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12405 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12406 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12407
12408 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12409 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12410 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12411 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12412 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12413 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12414 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12415
12416 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12417 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12418 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12419 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12420 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12421
12422 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12423 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12424 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12425 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12426 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12427 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12428
12429 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12430 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12431 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12432 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12433 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12434 .code
12435 MAIL FROM:<>
12436 MAIL FROM: <>
12437 .endd
12438 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12439 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12440 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12441 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12442
12443 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12444 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12445 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12446 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12447 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12448 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12449 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12450
12451 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12452 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12453 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12454 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12455 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12456 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12457 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12458 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12459 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12460 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12461 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12462
12463 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12464 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12465 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12466 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12467 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12468 message is junk mail.
12469
12470 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12471 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12472 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12473 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12474
12475
12476 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
12477 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
12478 The name of Exim's spool directory.
12479
12480 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
12481 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12482 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
12483 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
12484 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
12485 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
12486
12487 .vitem &$spool_space$&
12488 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12489 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
12490 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
12491 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
12492 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
12493 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
12494 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
12495 .code
12496 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
12497 .endd
12498 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
12499
12500
12501 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
12502 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
12503 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
12504 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
12505 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
12506 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
12507
12508 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
12509 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
12510 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12511 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
12512 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12513 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12514 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
12515 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
12516
12517 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
12518 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12519 the outbound.
12520
12521 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
12522 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
12523 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
12524 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
12525 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
12526 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
12527
12528 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
12529 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
12530 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12531 inbound connection when the message was received.
12532 It is only useful as the argument of a
12533 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12534 or a &%def%& condition.
12535
12536 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
12537 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
12538 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12539 inbound connection when the message was received.
12540 It is only useful as the argument of a
12541 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12542 or a &%def%& condition.
12543 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12544 which is not the leaf.
12545
12546 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
12547 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
12548 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
12549 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12550 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12551 or a &%def%& condition.
12552
12553 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
12554 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
12555 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
12556 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
12557 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
12558 or a &%def%& condition.
12559 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12560 which is not the leaf.
12561
12562 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
12563 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
12564 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
12565 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
12566
12567 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
12568 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12569 the outbound.
12570
12571 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
12572 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
12573 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
12574 outbound SMTP connection was made,
12575 and &"0"& otherwise.
12576
12577 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
12578 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
12579 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12580 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12581 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
12582 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
12583 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
12584 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
12585 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
12586
12587 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
12588 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
12589 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
12590
12591 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
12592 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
12593 This variable is
12594 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
12595 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
12596 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
12597 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
12598
12599 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
12600 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
12601 When a message is received from a remote client connection
12602 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
12603 .code
12604 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
12605 1 No response to request
12606 2 Response not verified
12607 3 Verification failed
12608 4 Verification succeeded
12609 .endd
12610
12611 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
12612 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
12613 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
12614 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
12615 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
12616
12617 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
12618 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
12619 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
12620 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12621 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
12622 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12623 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12624 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12625 which is not the leaf.
12626
12627 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
12628 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12629 the outbound.
12630
12631 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
12632 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
12633 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
12634 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
12635 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
12636 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
12637 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
12638 which is not the leaf.
12639
12640 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
12641 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
12642 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
12643 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12644 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
12645 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
12646 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
12647 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
12648 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
12649 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
12650 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
12651
12652 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
12653 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
12654 the outbound.
12655
12656 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
12657 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
12658 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
12659 During outbound
12660 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
12661 the transport.
12662
12663 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
12664 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
12665 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
12666 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
12667
12668 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
12669 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
12670 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12671
12672 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
12673 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
12674 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12675
12676 .vitem &$tod_full$&
12677 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
12678 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
12679 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
12680 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
12681 values for those that are behind (west).
12682
12683 .vitem &$tod_log$&
12684 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
12685 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
12686 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
12687
12688 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
12689 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
12690 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
12691 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
12692 flag.
12693
12694 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
12695 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
12696 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
12697 -0500.
12698
12699 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
12700 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
12701 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
12702 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
12703
12704 .vitem &$transport_name$&
12705 .cindex "transport" "name"
12706 .cindex "name" "of transport"
12707 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
12708 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
12709
12710 .vitem &$value$&
12711 .vindex "&$value$&"
12712 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
12713 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
12714 &*reduce*& expansion.
12715
12716 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
12717 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
12718 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode
12719 or for cutthrough delivery,
12720 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
12721 Otherwise, empty.
12722
12723 .vitem &$version_number$&
12724 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
12725 The version number of Exim.
12726
12727 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
12728 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
12729 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12730 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12731
12732 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
12733 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
12734 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
12735 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
12736 .endlist
12737 .ecindex IIDstrexp
12738
12739
12740
12741 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12742 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12743
12744 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
12745 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
12746 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
12747 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
12748 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
12749 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
12750 the line
12751 .code
12752 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
12753 .endd
12754 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
12755
12756
12757 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
12758 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
12759 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
12760 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
12761 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
12762 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
12763 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
12764 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
12765 a newly created Perl interpreter.
12766
12767 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
12768 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
12769 should usually be something like
12770 .code
12771 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
12772 .endd
12773 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
12774 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
12775 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
12776 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
12777 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
12778 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
12779 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
12780 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
12781 two ways:
12782
12783 .ilist
12784 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
12785 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
12786 a startup when Exim is entered.
12787 .next
12788 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
12789 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
12790 .endlist
12791
12792 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
12793 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
12794
12795
12796 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
12797 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
12798 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
12799 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
12800 forms:
12801 .code
12802 ${perl{foo}}
12803 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
12804 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
12805 .endd
12806 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
12807 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
12808 with an error message of the form
12809 .code
12810 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
12811 .endd
12812 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
12813 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
12814 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
12815 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
12816 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
12817 that was passed to &%die%&.
12818
12819
12820 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
12821 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
12822 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
12823 the Perl code
12824 .code
12825 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
12826 .endd
12827 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
12828 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
12829 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
12830
12831 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
12832 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
12833 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
12834 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
12835
12836 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
12837 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
12838 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
12839 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
12840 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
12841 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
12842 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
12843
12844
12845 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
12846 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
12847 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
12848 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
12849 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
12850 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
12851 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
12852 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
12853 avoided, but the output is lost.
12854
12855 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
12856 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
12857 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
12858 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
12859 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
12860 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
12861 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
12862 .code
12863 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
12864 .endd
12865 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
12866 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
12867 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
12868 as the first subroutine argument.
12869 .ecindex IIDperl
12870
12871
12872 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12873 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12874
12875 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
12876 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
12877 "Starting the daemon"
12878 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
12879 .cindex "interface" "listening"
12880 .cindex "network interface"
12881 .cindex "interface" "network"
12882 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
12883 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
12884 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
12885 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12886 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
12887 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
12888 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
12889 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
12890 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
12891 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
12892 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
12893
12894 .olist
12895 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
12896 and ports to listen on.
12897 .next
12898 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
12899 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
12900 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
12901 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
12902 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
12903 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
12904 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
12905 as an error situation.
12906 .next
12907 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
12908 for the outgoing connection.
12909 .endlist
12910
12911
12912 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
12913 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
12914 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
12915 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
12916 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
12917
12918 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
12919 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
12920 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
12921 chapter describes how they operate.
12922
12923 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
12924 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12925
12926
12927
12928 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
12929 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
12930 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
12931 following options:
12932
12933 .ilist
12934 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
12935 or service names.
12936 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
12937 .next
12938 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
12939 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
12940 .endlist
12941
12942 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
12943 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
12944 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
12945 colons. For example:
12946 .code
12947 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
12948 192.168.23.65 ; \
12949 ::1 ; \
12950 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
12951 .endd
12952 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
12953 in &%local_interfaces%&:
12954
12955 .olist
12956 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
12957 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
12958 .code
12959 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
12960 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
12961 .endd
12962 .next
12963 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
12964 with a colon separator, for example:
12965 .code
12966 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
12967 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
12968 .endd
12969 .endlist
12970
12971 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
12972 default setting contains just one port:
12973 .code
12974 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12975 .endd
12976 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
12977 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
12978 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
12979 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
12980 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
12981
12982
12983
12984 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
12985 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
12986 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
12987 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
12988 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
12989 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12990 .code
12991 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
12992 .endd
12993 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
12994 .code
12995 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12996 .endd
12997 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
12998
12999
13000
13001 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13002 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13003 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13004 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13005 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13006 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13007 exim.
13008
13009 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13010 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13011 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13012 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13013 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13014 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13015 .code
13016 -oX 1225
13017 .endd
13018 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13019 whereas
13020 .code
13021 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13022 .endd
13023 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13024 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13025 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13026
13027
13028
13029 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13030 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13031 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13032 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13033 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13034 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
13035 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
13036 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
13037 list of port numbers or service names,
13038 connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
13039 common use of this option is expected to be
13040 .code
13041 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13042 .endd
13043 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
13044 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
13045 this way when a daemon is started.
13046
13047 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13048 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13049 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13050 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13051 connections via the daemon.)
13052
13053
13054
13055
13056 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13057 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13058 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13059 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13060 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13061 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13062 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13063 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13064 .code
13065 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13066 .endd
13067 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13068 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13069 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13070 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13071 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13072 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13073 .code
13074 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13075 .endd
13076 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13077 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13078 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13079 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13080 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13081
13082 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13083 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13084 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13085 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13086 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13087 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13088 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13089 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13090 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13091 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13092 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13093 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13094
13095 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13096 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13097 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13098 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13099 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13100
13101
13102
13103 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13104 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13105 .code
13106 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13107 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13108 .endd
13109 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13110 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13111 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13112 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13113
13114 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13115 .code
13116 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13117 .endd
13118 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13119 .code
13120 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13121 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13122 .endd
13123 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13124 IPv4 loopback address only:
13125 .code
13126 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13127 .endd
13128 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13129 .code
13130 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13131 .endd
13132 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13133
13134
13135
13136 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13137 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13138 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13139 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13140 treated as local.
13141
13142 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13143 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13144 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13145 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13146
13147 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13148 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13149 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13150 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13151 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13152 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13153 used for listening. Consider this example:
13154 .code
13155 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13156 192.168.53.235 ; \
13157 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13158
13159 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13160 .endd
13161 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13162 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13163 Exim is routing.
13164
13165 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13166 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13167 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13168 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13169 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13170 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13171 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13172 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13173
13174
13175
13176 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13177 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13178 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13179 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13180 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13181 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13182 details.
13183
13184
13185
13186
13187 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13188 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13189
13190 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13191 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13192 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13193 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13194
13195 .ilist
13196 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13197 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13198 .next
13199 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13200 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13201 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13202 .next
13203 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13204 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13205 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13206 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13207 settings.
13208 .endlist
13209
13210 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13211 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13212 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13213 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13214 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13215 listed in more than one group.
13216
13217 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13218 .table2
13219 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13220 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13221 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13222 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13223 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13224 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13225 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13226 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13227 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13228 .endtable
13229
13230
13231 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13232 .table2
13233 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13234 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13235 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13236 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13237 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13238 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13239 .endtable
13240
13241
13242
13243 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13244 .table2
13245 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13246 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13247 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13248 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13249 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13250 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13251 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13252 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13253 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13254 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13255 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13256 .endtable
13257
13258
13259
13260 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13261 .table2
13262 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13263 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13264 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13265 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13266 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13267 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13268 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13269 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13270 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13271 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13272 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13273 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13274 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13275 .endtable
13276
13277
13278
13279 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13280 .table2
13281 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13282 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13283 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13284 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13285 .endtable
13286
13287
13288
13289 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13290 .table2
13291 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13292 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13293 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13294 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13295 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13296 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13297 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13298 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13299 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13300 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13301 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13302 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13303 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13304 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13305 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13306 .endtable
13307
13308
13309
13310 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13311 .table2
13312 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13313 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13314 .endtable
13315
13316
13317
13318 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13319 .table2
13320 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13321 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13322 .endtable
13323
13324
13325
13326 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13327 .table2
13328 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13329 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13330 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13331 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13332 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13333 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13334 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13335 .endtable
13336
13337
13338
13339 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13340 .table2
13341 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13342 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13343 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13344 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13345 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13346 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13347 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13348 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13349 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13350 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13351 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13352 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13353 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13354 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13355 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13356 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13357 connection"
13358 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13359 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13360 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13361 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13362 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13363 .endtable
13364
13365
13366
13367 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13368 .table2
13369 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13370 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13371 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13372 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13373 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13374 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13375 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13376 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13377 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13378 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13379 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13380 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13381 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13382 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13383 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13384 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13385 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13386 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13387 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13388 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13389 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13390 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13391 words""&"
13392 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13393 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13394 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13395 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13396 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13397 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13398 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13399 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13400 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13401 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13402 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13403 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13404 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13405 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13406 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13407 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13408 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13409 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13410 .endtable
13411
13412
13413
13414 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13415 .table2
13416 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13417 item"
13418 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13419 item"
13420 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13421 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13422 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13423 .endtable
13424
13425
13426
13427 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
13428 .table2
13429 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13430 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13431 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13432 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13433 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13434 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13435 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13436 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
13437 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
13438 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
13439 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
13440 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
13441 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
13442 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
13443 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
13444 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
13445 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
13446 .endtable
13447
13448
13449
13450 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
13451 .table2
13452 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
13453 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
13454 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
13455 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
13456 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
13457 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
13458 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
13459 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
13460 .endtable
13461
13462
13463
13464 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
13465 .table2
13466 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13467 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13468 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
13469 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13470 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
13471 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
13472 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
13473 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
13474 .endtable
13475
13476
13477
13478
13479 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
13480 .table2
13481 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
13482 .endtable
13483
13484
13485
13486
13487
13488 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
13489 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
13490
13491 .table2
13492 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
13493 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13494 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13495 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
13496 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
13497 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
13498 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
13499 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
13500 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13501 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13502 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13503 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13504 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13505 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13506 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13507 connection"
13508 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13509 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
13510 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
13511 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13512 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13513 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
13514 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
13515 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
13516 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
13517 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
13518 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
13519 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
13520 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
13521 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
13522 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13523 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13524 .endtable
13525
13526
13527
13528 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
13529 .table2
13530 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
13531 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
13532 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
13533 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
13534 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
13535 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
13536 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
13537 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13538 .endtable
13539
13540
13541
13542 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
13543 .table2
13544 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
13545 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
13546 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
13547 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13548 words""&"
13549 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13550 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13551 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
13552 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
13553 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
13554 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
13555 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
13556 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
13557 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
13558 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
13559 .endtable
13560
13561
13562
13563 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
13564 .table2
13565 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
13566 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
13567 directory"
13568 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
13569 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
13570 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
13571 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
13572 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
13573 .endtable
13574
13575
13576
13577 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
13578 .table2
13579 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13580 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
13581 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
13582 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
13583 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
13584 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
13585 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
13586 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
13587 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
13588 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
13589 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
13590 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
13591 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
13592 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
13593 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
13594 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13595 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
13596 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
13597 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
13598 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
13599 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13600 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
13601 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
13602 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
13603 .endtable
13604
13605
13606
13607 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
13608 .table2
13609 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
13610 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
13611 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
13612 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
13613 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
13614 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
13615 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
13616 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
13617 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
13618 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
13619 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
13620 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
13621 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
13622 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
13623 .endtable
13624
13625
13626
13627 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
13628 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
13629 &dagger;.
13630
13631 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
13632 .cindex "8BITMIME"
13633 .cindex "8-bit characters"
13634 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13635 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
13636 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
13637 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
13638 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
13639 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
13640
13641 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
13642 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
13643 It now defaults to true.
13644 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
13645 .display
13646 &url(http://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
13647 .endd
13648
13649 To log received 8BITMIME status use
13650 .code
13651 log_selector = +8bitmime
13652 .endd
13653
13654 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
13655 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
13656 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13657 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
13658 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13659 further details.
13660
13661 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13662 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
13663 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
13664 SMTP messages.
13665
13666 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
13667 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
13668 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
13669 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
13670 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13671
13672 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
13673 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
13674 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
13675 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
13676 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13677
13678 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
13679 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
13680 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
13681 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13682
13683 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
13684 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
13685 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
13686 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
13687 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13688
13689 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
13690 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
13691 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
13692 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
13693 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
13694 This option defines the ACL that,
13695 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
13696 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
13697 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
13698 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13699
13700 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
13701 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
13702 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
13703 of a received message.
13704 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>& for further details.
13705
13706 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
13707 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
13708 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
13709 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13710
13711 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
13712 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
13713 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
13714 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13715
13716 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
13717 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
13718 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
13719 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
13720 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13721
13722
13723 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
13724 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
13725 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
13726 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13727
13728 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
13729 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
13730 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
13731 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
13732 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
13733
13734 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
13735 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
13736 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
13737 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
13738 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
13739
13740 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
13741 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
13742 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
13743 ends without a QUIT command being received.
13744 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13745
13746 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
13747 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
13748 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
13749 further details.
13750
13751 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
13752 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
13753 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
13754 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13755
13756 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
13757 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
13758 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
13759 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13760
13761 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
13762 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
13763 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
13764 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13765
13766 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
13767 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
13768 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
13769 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
13770
13771 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
13772 .cindex "admin user"
13773 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
13774 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
13775 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
13776 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
13777 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
13778 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
13779 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
13780
13781 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
13782 .cindex "domain literal"
13783 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
13784 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
13785 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
13786 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
13787
13788 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
13789 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
13790 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
13791 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
13792 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
13793 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
13794 the local host's IP addresses.
13795
13796
13797 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
13798 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
13799 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
13800 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
13801 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
13802 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
13803 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
13804 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
13805 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
13806
13807 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
13808 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
13809 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
13810 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
13811 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
13812 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
13813 experiment if they wish.
13814
13815 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
13816 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
13817 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
13818 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
13819 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
13820 suitable setting is:
13821 .code
13822 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
13823 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
13824 .endd
13825 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
13826 .code
13827 dns_check_names_pattern =
13828 .endd
13829 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
13830
13831
13832 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
13833 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
13834 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
13835 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
13836 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
13837 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
13838 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
13839 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
13840 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
13841 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
13842 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
13843
13844 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
13845 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
13846 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
13847 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
13848 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
13849 which Exim advertises AUTH.
13850
13851 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
13852 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
13853 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
13854 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
13855 .code
13856 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
13857 .endd
13858 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13859 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
13860 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
13861 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
13862
13863
13864 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
13865 .cindex "thawing messages"
13866 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
13867 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
13868 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
13869 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
13870 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
13871 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
13872
13873 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
13874 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
13875 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
13876
13877
13878 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
13879 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
13880 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
13881 .code
13882 sophie:/var/run/sophie
13883 .endd
13884 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
13885 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
13886
13887
13888 .option bi_command main string unset
13889 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
13890 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
13891 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
13892 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
13893 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
13894
13895
13896 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
13897 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
13898 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
13899 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
13900 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
13901 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
13902
13903
13904 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
13905 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
13906 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
13907 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
13908
13909 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
13910 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
13911 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
13912 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
13913 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
13914 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
13915 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
13916 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
13917 point at which the error was detected are returned.
13918 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
13919
13920 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
13921 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
13922 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
13923 &%bounce_return_body%&.
13924
13925
13926 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
13927 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
13928 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
13929 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
13930 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
13931 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
13932 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
13933 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
13934 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
13935
13936 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
13937 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
13938 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
13939 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
13940 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
13941 messages.
13942
13943 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
13944 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
13945 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
13946 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
13947 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
13948 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
13949 connection. A typical setting might be:
13950 .code
13951 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13952 .endd
13953 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
13954 .code
13955 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
13956 .endd
13957 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
13958 address.
13959
13960 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
13961 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
13962 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
13963 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
13964 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13965 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13966
13967
13968 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
13969 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
13970 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13971 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13972
13973
13974 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
13975 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
13976 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13977 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13978
13979
13980 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
13981 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
13982 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
13983 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
13984
13985
13986 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
13987 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
13988 callout verification. The default value is
13989 .code
13990 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
13991 .endd
13992 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
13993
13994
13995 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
13996 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
13997
13998
13999 .option check_log_space main integer 0
14000 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14001
14002 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14003 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14004 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14005 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14006 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14007 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14008 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14009 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14010 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14011 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14012
14013
14014 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
14015 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14016
14017
14018 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
14019 .cindex "checking disk space"
14020 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14021 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14022 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14023 message is accepted.
14024
14025 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14026 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14027 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14028 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14029 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14030 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14031 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14032 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14033
14034
14035 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14036 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14037 .code
14038 check_spool_space = 10M
14039 check_spool_inodes = 100
14040 .endd
14041 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14042 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14043 transit.
14044
14045 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14046 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14047 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14048
14049 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14050 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14051 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14052 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14053 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14054 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14055
14056 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14057 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14058
14059 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14060 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14061 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14062
14063 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14064 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14065 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14066 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14067 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14068 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14069
14070 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14071 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14072 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14073 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14074 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14075 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14076 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14077
14078 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14079 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14080
14081 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14082 .cindex "warning of delay"
14083 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14084 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14085 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14086 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14087 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14088 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14089 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14090 with
14091 .code
14092 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14093 .endd
14094 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14095 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14096 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14097 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14098 .code
14099 delay_warning = 6h
14100 .endd
14101 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14102 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14103 .code
14104 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14105 .endd
14106 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14107 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14108 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14109
14110 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14111 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14112 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14113 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14114 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14115 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14116 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14117 not sent. The default is:
14118 .code
14119 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14120 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14121 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14122 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14123 } {no}{yes}}
14124 .endd
14125 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14126 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14127 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14128 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14129
14130 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14131 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14132 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14133 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14134 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14135 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14136 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14137 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14138
14139 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14140 .cindex "load average"
14141 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14142 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14143 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14144 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14145 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14146
14147
14148 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14149 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14150 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14151 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14152 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14153 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14154 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14155 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14156
14157 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14158 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14159 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14160 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14161 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14162 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14163 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14164 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14165
14166 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14167 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14168 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14169 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14170
14171
14172 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14173 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14174 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14175 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14176 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14177 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14178 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14179
14180
14181 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14182 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14183 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14184 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14185 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14186 See chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
14187
14188
14189 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14190 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14191 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14192 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14193 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14194 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14195 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14196 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14197 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14198 by a setting such as this:
14199 .code
14200 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14201 .endd
14202 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14203 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14204 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14205 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14206 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14207 options are applied after this global option.
14208
14209 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14210 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14211 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14212 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14213 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14214 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14215 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14216 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14217 value of this option. The default pattern is
14218 .code
14219 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14220 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14221 .endd
14222 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14223 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14224 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14225 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14226 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14227 empty string.
14228
14229 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14230 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14231 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14232
14233 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14234 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14235 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14236 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14237
14238
14239 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14240 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14241 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14242 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14243 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14244 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14245
14246 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14247
14248
14249 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14250 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14251 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14252 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14253 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14254 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14255 domain matches this list.
14256
14257 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14258 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14259 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14260
14261
14262 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14263 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14264 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14265 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14266 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14267 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14268 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14269 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14270 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14271 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14272 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14273 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14274 to set in them.
14275 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14276
14277
14278 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14279 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14280
14281
14282 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14283 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14284 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14285 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14286 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14287 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14288 match with this expanded domain list.
14289
14290 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14291 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14292 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14293 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14294 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14295 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14296
14297 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14298 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14299 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14300
14301 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14302 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14303 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14304 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14305 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14306
14307 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14308 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14309 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14310 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14311 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14312 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14313 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14314 on.
14315
14316 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14317
14318
14319 .option drop_cr main boolean false
14320 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14321 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14322 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14323
14324 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14325 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14326 .cindex "DSN" "success"
14327 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14328 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14329 and accepted from, these hosts.
14330 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14331 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14332 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14333 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14334 are sent.
14335
14336 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14337 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14338 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14339 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14340 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14341 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14342 .code
14343 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14344 .endd
14345 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14346 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14347
14348 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14349 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14350 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14351 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14352 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14353 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14354 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14355 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14356 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14357
14358
14359 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14360 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14361 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
14362 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
14363 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
14364 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
14365 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
14366 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
14367 must be enclosed in double quotes.
14368
14369 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
14370 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
14371 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
14372 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
14373 are examined. For example:
14374 .code
14375 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
14376 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
14377 postmaster@mydomain.example
14378 .endd
14379 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14380 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
14381 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
14382 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
14383 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
14384 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
14385 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
14386
14387
14388 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
14389 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
14390 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
14391 .display
14392 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
14393 .endd
14394 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
14395 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
14396 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
14397 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
14398 overrides the default.
14399
14400 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
14401 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
14402 and warning messages. For example:
14403 .code
14404 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
14405 .endd
14406 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
14407 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
14408 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
14409 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
14410 not used.
14411
14412
14413 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
14414 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
14415 .cindex "Exim group"
14416 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14417 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
14418 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
14419 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
14420 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
14421 security issues.
14422
14423
14424 .option exim_path main string "see below"
14425 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
14426 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
14427 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
14428 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
14429 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
14430 other place.
14431 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
14432 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
14433 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
14434 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
14435
14436
14437 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
14438 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
14439 .cindex "Exim user"
14440 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
14441 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
14442 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
14443 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
14444
14445 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
14446 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
14447 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
14448 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
14449
14450
14451 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
14452 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
14453 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
14454 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
14455
14456
14457 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14458 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14459
14460 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
14461 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
14462 .oindex "&%-t%&"
14463 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
14464 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
14465 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
14466 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
14467 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
14468 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
14469 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
14470 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
14471 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
14472 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
14473 addresses.
14474
14475
14476 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
14477 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
14478 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
14479 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
14480 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
14481 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
14482 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
14483 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
14484 retries.
14485
14486 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
14487 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
14488 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
14489 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
14490
14491
14492
14493 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
14494 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
14495 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
14496 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
14497 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
14498 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
14499 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
14500 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
14501 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
14502 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
14503 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
14504 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
14505 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
14506 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
14507 logging that you require.
14508
14509
14510 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
14511 .cindex "HP-UX"
14512 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
14513 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
14514 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
14515 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
14516 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
14517 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
14518 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
14519 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
14520
14521 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
14522 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
14523 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
14524 user's name.
14525
14526 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
14527 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
14528 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
14529 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
14530 .code
14531 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
14532 gecos_name = $1
14533 .endd
14534
14535 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
14536 See &%gecos_name%& above.
14537
14538
14539 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
14540 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
14541 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
14542 implementations of TLS.
14543
14544
14545 option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
14546 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
14547 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
14548
14549 See
14550 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
14551 for documentation.
14552
14553
14554
14555 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
14556 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
14557 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
14558 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
14559 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
14560 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
14561
14562
14563
14564 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
14565 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
14566 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
14567 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
14568 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
14569 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
14570 sections are rejected.
14571
14572
14573 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
14574 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
14575 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
14576 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
14577 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
14578 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
14579 zero means &"no limit"&.
14580
14581
14582
14583
14584 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14585 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
14586 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
14587 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
14588 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
14589 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
14590 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
14591 if you want to do semantic checking.
14592 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
14593 set.
14594
14595
14596 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
14597 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
14598 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
14599 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
14600 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
14601 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
14602 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
14603 .code
14604 helo_allow_chars = _
14605 .endd
14606 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
14607
14608
14609 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
14610 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14611 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
14612 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
14613 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
14614 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
14615 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
14616 do.
14617
14618
14619 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14620 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
14621 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
14622 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
14623 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
14624 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
14625 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
14626 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
14627 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
14628 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
14629 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
14630 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
14631
14632 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
14633 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
14634 EHLO command either:
14635
14636 .ilist
14637 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
14638 .next
14639 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
14640 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
14641 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
14642 calling host address, or
14643 .next
14644 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
14645 .endlist
14646
14647 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
14648 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
14649 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
14650
14651 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
14652 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14653 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
14654
14655 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14656 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
14657 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
14658 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
14659 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
14660 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
14661 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
14662 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
14663 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
14664 error.
14665
14666 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14667 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
14668 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
14669 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
14670 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
14671 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
14672 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
14673 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
14674 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
14675
14676 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
14677 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
14678 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
14679 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
14680 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
14681
14682 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
14683 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
14684 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
14685 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
14686
14687
14688 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
14689 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
14690 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
14691 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
14692 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
14693 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
14694 default configuration file contains
14695 .code
14696 host_lookup = *
14697 .endd
14698 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
14699 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
14700
14701 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
14702 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
14703 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
14704
14705 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
14706 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
14707 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
14708 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
14709 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
14710 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
14711
14712
14713 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
14714 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
14715 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
14716 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
14717 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
14718 if you want.
14719
14720 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
14721 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
14722 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
14723 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
14724
14725
14726
14727 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
14728 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
14729 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
14730 as soon as the connection is made.
14731 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
14732 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
14733 connections immediately.
14734
14735 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
14736 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
14737 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
14738 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
14739 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
14740
14741
14742 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
14743 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
14744 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
14745 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
14746 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
14747 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
14748 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
14749 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
14750 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
14751 .code
14752 hosts_connection_nolog = :
14753 .endd
14754 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
14755
14756
14757
14758 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
14759 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
14760 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
14761 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
14762 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
14763 records
14764 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
14765 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
14766
14767 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
14768 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
14769 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
14770 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
14771 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
14772 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
14773 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
14774
14775
14776 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
14777 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
14778 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
14779 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14780 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
14781
14782
14783
14784 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
14785 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
14786 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
14787 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
14788 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
14789 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
14790
14791 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
14792 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
14793 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
14794 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
14795 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
14796 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
14797 for frozen messages. For example,
14798 .code
14799 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
14800 .endd
14801 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
14802 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
14803 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
14804 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
14805 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
14806 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
14807
14808
14809 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14810 .cindex "&""From""& line"
14811 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
14812 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
14813 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
14814 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
14815 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
14816 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
14817 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
14818 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
14819
14820
14821 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
14822 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
14823
14824
14825 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
14826 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
14827 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
14828 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
14829 logged.
14830
14831
14832 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
14833 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
14834 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
14835 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14836 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14837 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14838 and constrained to be a directory.
14839
14840
14841 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
14842 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
14843 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
14844 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
14845 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
14846 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
14847 and constrained to be a file.
14848
14849
14850 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
14851 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
14852 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
14853 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14854 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
14855
14856
14857 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
14858 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
14859 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
14860 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
14861 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
14862 identity to be proven.
14863
14864
14865 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
14866 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
14867 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
14868 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
14869 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
14870
14871
14872 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
14873 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
14874 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
14875 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
14876 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
14877 with LDAP support.
14878
14879
14880 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
14881 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
14882 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
14883 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
14884 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
14885 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
14886 to hard/demand.
14887
14888
14889 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
14890 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
14891 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
14892 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
14893 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
14894 of SSL-on-connect.
14895 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
14896 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
14897
14898
14899 .option ldap_version main integer unset
14900 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
14901 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
14902 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
14903 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
14904 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
14905 has been built with LDAP support.
14906
14907
14908
14909 .option local_from_check main boolean true
14910 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
14911 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
14912 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14913 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
14914 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
14915 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
14916
14917 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
14918 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
14919 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14920
14921 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
14922 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
14923 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
14924 and the default qualify domain.
14925
14926 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
14927 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
14928 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
14929 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
14930
14931 .cindex "envelope sender"
14932 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
14933 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
14934 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
14935
14936 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
14937 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
14938 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
14939
14940
14941
14942
14943 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
14944 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
14945 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
14946 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
14947 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
14948 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
14949 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
14950 example, if
14951 .code
14952 local_from_prefix = *-
14953 .endd
14954 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
14955 .code
14956 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
14957 .endd
14958 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
14959 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
14960 qualify domain.
14961
14962
14963 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
14964 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
14965
14966
14967 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
14968 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
14969 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
14970 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
14971 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
14972 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
14973 &%local_interfaces%& is
14974 .code
14975 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14976 .endd
14977 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
14978 .code
14979 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14980 .endd
14981
14982 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
14983 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
14984 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
14985 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
14986 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
14987 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
14988 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
14989 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
14990
14991
14992
14993 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
14994 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
14995 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
14996 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
14997 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
14998 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
14999 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15000 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15001
15002
15003
15004
15005 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15006 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15007 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15008 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15009 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15010 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15011 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15012 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15013 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15014 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15015 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15016 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15017 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15018 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15019 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15020
15021
15022
15023 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15024 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15025 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15026 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15027 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15028 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15029 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15030 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15031 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15032 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15033 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15034 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15035 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15036 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15037 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15038
15039
15040 .option log_selector main string unset
15041 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15042 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15043 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15044 minus characters. For example:
15045 .code
15046 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15047 .endd
15048 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15049 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15050
15051
15052 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15053 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15054 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15055 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15056 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15057 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15058 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15059 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15060 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15061 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15062 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15063 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15064 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15065
15066
15067 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15068 .cindex "too many open files"
15069 .cindex "open files, too many"
15070 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15071 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15072 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15073 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15074 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15075 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15076 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15077 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15078 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15079 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15080 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15081 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15082
15083
15084 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15085 .cindex "length of login name"
15086 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15087 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15088 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15089 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15090 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15091 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15092
15093
15094 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15095 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15096 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15097 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15098 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15099 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15100 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15101 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15102
15103
15104 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15105 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15106 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15107 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15108 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15109 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15110 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15111
15112
15113 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15114 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15115 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15116 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15117 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15118 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15119 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15120 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15121 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15122 empty string, the option is ignored.
15123
15124
15125 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15126 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15127 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15128 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15129 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15130 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15131 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15132 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15133 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15134 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15135 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15136 colons will become hyphens.
15137
15138
15139 .option message_logs main boolean true
15140 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15141 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15142 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15143 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15144 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15145 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15146 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15147 which is not affected by this option.
15148
15149
15150 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15151 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15152 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15153 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15154 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15155 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15156 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15157 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15158 optionally followed by K or M.
15159
15160 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15161 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15162 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15163 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15164 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15165
15166 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15167 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15168 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15169 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15170 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15171 message that an individual transport can process.
15172
15173 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15174 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15175 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15176 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15177 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15178 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15179 some problems may result.
15180
15181 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15182 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15183 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15184
15185
15186 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15187 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15188 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15189 .code
15190 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15191 .endd
15192 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15193 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15194 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15195 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15196 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15197
15198
15199 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15200 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15201 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15202 contains a full description of this facility.
15203
15204
15205
15206 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15207 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15208 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15209 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15210 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15211
15212
15213 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15214 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15215 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15216 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15217 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15218 safety precaution.
15219
15220 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15221 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15222 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15223 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15224 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15225
15226 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15227 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15228 example is
15229 .code
15230 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15231 .endd
15232 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15233 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15234 transport driver.
15235
15236
15237 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2"
15238 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15239 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15240 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15241 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15242
15243 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15244 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15245 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15246 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15247 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15248 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15249 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15250
15251 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15252 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15253 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15254 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15255 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15256
15257 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15258
15259 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15260 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15261 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15262 some now infamous attacks.
15263
15264 Examples:
15265 .code
15266 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15267 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15268 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15269
15270 # Disable older protocol versions:
15271 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15272 .endd
15273
15274 Possible options may include:
15275 .ilist
15276 &`all`&
15277 .next
15278 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15279 .next
15280 &`cipher_server_preference`&
15281 .next
15282 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15283 .next
15284 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
15285 .next
15286 &`legacy_server_connect`&
15287 .next
15288 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15289 .next
15290 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15291 .next
15292 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15293 .next
15294 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15295 .next
15296 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15297 .next
15298 &`no_compression`&
15299 .next
15300 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15301 .next
15302 &`no_sslv2`&
15303 .next
15304 &`no_sslv3`&
15305 .next
15306 &`no_ticket`&
15307 .next
15308 &`no_tlsv1`&
15309 .next
15310 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
15311 .next
15312 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
15313 .next
15314 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15315 .next
15316 &`single_dh_use`&
15317 .next
15318 &`single_ecdh_use`&
15319 .next
15320 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
15321 .next
15322 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
15323 .next
15324 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
15325 .next
15326 &`tls_d5_bug`&
15327 .next
15328 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
15329 .endlist
15330
15331 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
15332 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
15333 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
15334 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
15335 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
15336 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
15337
15338
15339 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
15340 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
15341 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
15342 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15343 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
15344
15345
15346 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15347 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
15348 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
15349 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
15350 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
15351 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
15352 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
15353 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
15354 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
15355 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
15356 an ACL.
15357
15358 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
15359 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
15360 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
15361 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
15362 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
15363 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
15364 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
15365
15366
15367 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
15368 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15369 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15370
15371
15372 .option perl_startup main string unset
15373 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
15374 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
15375
15376
15377 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
15378 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
15379 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
15380 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
15381 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
15382 PostgreSQL support.
15383
15384
15385 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
15386 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
15387 .cindex "pid file, path for"
15388 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
15389 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
15390 to the host name:
15391 .code
15392 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
15393 .endd
15394 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
15395 spool directory.
15396 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
15397 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
15398 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
15399
15400
15401 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15402 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
15403 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
15404 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
15405 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
15406 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
15407 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
15408 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
15409 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
15410
15411
15412 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
15413 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
15414 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
15415 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
15416 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
15417 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
15418 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
15419 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
15420
15421 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
15422 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
15423 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
15424 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
15425 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
15426 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
15427 volume of mail. Use with care!
15428
15429
15430 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
15431 .cindex "name" "of local host"
15432 .cindex "host" "name of local"
15433 .cindex "local host" "name of"
15434 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
15435 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
15436 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
15437 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
15438 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
15439 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
15440
15441 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
15442 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
15443 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
15444 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
15445 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
15446 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
15447
15448
15449 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
15450 .cindex "printing characters"
15451 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15452 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
15453 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
15454 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
15455 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
15456 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
15457 characters.
15458
15459 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
15460 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
15461 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
15462 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
15463 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
15464 standards.
15465
15466
15467 .option process_log_path main string unset
15468 .cindex "process log path"
15469 .cindex "log" "process log"
15470 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
15471 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
15472 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
15473 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
15474 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
15475 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
15476 different spool directories.
15477
15478
15479 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
15480 .oindex "&%-M%&"
15481 .oindex "&%-R%&"
15482 .oindex "&%-q%&"
15483 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
15484 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
15485 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
15486
15487
15488 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
15489 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
15490 .cindex "address" "qualification"
15491 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
15492 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
15493 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
15494 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
15495 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
15496 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15497
15498 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
15499 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
15500 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
15501 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
15502 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
15503 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
15504 &%primary_hostname%& value.
15505
15506
15507 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
15508 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
15509 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
15510
15511
15512
15513 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15514 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
15515 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15516 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
15517 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
15518 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
15519 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
15520 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
15521
15522
15523 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
15524 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
15525 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
15526 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
15527 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
15528
15529
15530 .option queue_only main boolean false
15531 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15532 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
15533 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
15534 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
15535 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
15536 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
15537
15538 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
15539 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
15540 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
15541 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
15542
15543
15544 .option queue_only_file main string unset
15545 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15546 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
15547 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
15548 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
15549 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
15550 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
15551 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
15552 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
15553 .code
15554 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
15555 .endd
15556 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
15557 &_/some/file_& exists.
15558
15559
15560 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
15561 .cindex "load average"
15562 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15563 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
15564 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
15565 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
15566 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
15567 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
15568 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15569 false.
15570
15571 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
15572 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
15573 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
15574 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15575
15576
15577 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
15578 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
15579 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
15580 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
15581 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
15582 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
15583 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
15584 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
15585 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
15586 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
15587 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
15588 re-evaluated for each message.
15589
15590
15591 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
15592 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15593 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
15594 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
15595 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
15596 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
15597
15598
15599 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
15600 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
15601 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
15602 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
15603 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
15604 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
15605 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
15606 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
15607 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
15608 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
15609 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
15610 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
15611 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
15612
15613
15614
15615 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
15616 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
15617 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
15618 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
15619 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
15620 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
15621 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
15622 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
15623 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
15624
15625 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
15626 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
15627 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
15628 the daemon's command line.
15629
15630 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15631 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15632 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
15633 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
15634 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
15635 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
15636 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
15637 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
15638 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
15639 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
15640 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
15641 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
15642 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
15643 &%queue_domains%&.
15644
15645
15646 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
15647 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
15648 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
15649 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
15650 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
15651 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
15652 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
15653
15654 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
15655 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
15656 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
15657 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
15658 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
15659 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
15660 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
15661 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
15662 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
15663 header lines. The default setting is:
15664
15665 .code
15666 received_header_text = Received: \
15667 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
15668 {${if def:sender_ident \
15669 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
15670 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
15671 by $primary_hostname \
15672 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
15673 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
15674 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
15675 ${if def:sender_address \
15676 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
15677 id $message_exim_id\
15678 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
15679 .endd
15680
15681 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
15682 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
15683 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
15684 header lines such as the following:
15685 .code
15686 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
15687 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
15688 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
15689 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
15690 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
15691 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
15692 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
15693 .endd
15694 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
15695 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
15696 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
15697 message was accepted.
15698
15699
15700 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
15701 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
15702 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
15703 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
15704 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
15705 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
15706 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
15707 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
15708
15709
15710 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15711 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15712 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15713 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15714 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
15715 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
15716 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
15717 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
15718 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
15719 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
15720 option was not set.
15721
15722
15723 .option recipients_max main integer 0
15724 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
15725 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
15726 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
15727 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
15728 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
15729 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
15730 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
15731 done.
15732
15733 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
15734 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
15735 RCPT commands in a single message.
15736
15737
15738 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
15739 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
15740 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
15741 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
15742 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
15743 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
15744 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
15745
15746
15747 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
15748 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
15749 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
15750 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
15751 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
15752 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
15753 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
15754 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
15755 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
15756 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
15757 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
15758 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
15759 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
15760 tagged with its process id.
15761
15762 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
15763 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
15764 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
15765 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
15766 is received.
15767
15768 .cindex "number of deliveries"
15769 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
15770 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
15771 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
15772 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
15773 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
15774 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
15775 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
15776 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
15777 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
15778 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
15779
15780 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
15781 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
15782 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
15783 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
15784
15785
15786 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15787 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
15788 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
15789 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
15790 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
15791 .code
15792 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
15793 .endd
15794 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
15795 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
15796
15797
15798 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
15799 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
15800 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
15801 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
15802 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
15803 past failures.
15804
15805
15806 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
15807 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
15808 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
15809 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
15810 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
15811 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
15812 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
15813 the default value.
15814
15815
15816 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
15817 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
15818 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
15819 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
15820 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
15821 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
15822 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
15823 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
15824 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
15825 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
15826
15827
15828 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
15829 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15830
15831
15832 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
15833 .cindex "RFC 1413"
15834 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
15835 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
15836 an item in the list.
15837 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
15838 for the system.
15839
15840 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
15841 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
15842 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
15843 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
15844 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
15845
15846
15847 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15848 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
15849 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
15850 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
15851 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
15852 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
15853 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
15854 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
15855 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
15856 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
15857
15858
15859 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
15860 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
15861 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
15862 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
15863 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
15864 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
15865 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
15866
15867
15868
15869 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
15870 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
15871 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
15872 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
15873 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
15874 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
15875 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
15876 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
15877 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
15878 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
15879 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
15880
15881
15882
15883 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
15884 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
15885 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15886 .cindex "inetd"
15887 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
15888 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
15889 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
15890 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
15891 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
15892 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15893
15894 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
15895 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
15896 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
15897 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
15898
15899
15900 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
15901 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
15902 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
15903 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
15904 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
15905 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
15906 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
15907 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
15908
15909 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
15910 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
15911 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
15912 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
15913 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
15914 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
15915 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
15916 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
15917
15918
15919 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15920 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
15921 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
15922 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
15923 live with.
15924
15925
15926 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15927 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15928 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
15929 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
15930 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
15931 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
15932 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
15933 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
15934 . the option name to split.
15935
15936 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
15937 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15938 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
15939 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
15940 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
15941 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
15942 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
15943 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
15944 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
15945 seen).
15946
15947
15948 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
15949 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
15950 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
15951 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
15952 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
15953 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
15954 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
15955 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
15956 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
15957 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
15958 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
15959
15960 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
15961 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
15962 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
15963 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
15964 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
15965 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
15966
15967
15968
15969 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
15970 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
15971 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15972 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
15973 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
15974 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
15975 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
15976 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
15977 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
15978 to all messages received in the same connection.
15979
15980 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
15981 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
15982 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
15983 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
15984
15985
15986 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
15987
15988 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
15989 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
15990 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
15991 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
15992 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
15993 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
15994 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
15995 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
15996 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
15997 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
15998 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
15999 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16000 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16001
16002
16003 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16004 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16005 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16006 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16007 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16008 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16009 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16010 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16011 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16012 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16013 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16014 individual host.
16015
16016 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16017 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16018 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16019 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16020
16021
16022 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16023 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16024 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16025 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16026 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16027 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16028 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16029 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16030 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16031
16032 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16033 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16034 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16035 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16036
16037 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16038 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16039 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16040 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16041 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16042 For example:
16043 .code
16044 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16045 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16046 .endd
16047
16048 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16049 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16050 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16051 &%helo_data%& value.
16052
16053 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16054 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16055 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16056 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16057 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16058 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16059 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16060 .code
16061 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16062 $version_number $tod_full
16063 .endd
16064 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16065 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16066 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16067 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16068 multiline response).
16069
16070
16071 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16072 .cindex "checking disk space"
16073 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16074 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16075 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16076 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16077 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16078 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16079 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16080
16081
16082 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16083 .cindex "connection backlog"
16084 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16085 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16086 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16087 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16088 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16089 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16090 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16091 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16092 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16093 attacks by SYN flooding.
16094
16095
16096 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16097 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16098 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16099 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16100 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16101 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16102 fewer, but they still exist.
16103
16104 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16105 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16106 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16107 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16108 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16109 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16110 does detect many instances.
16111
16112 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16113 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16114 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16115 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16116
16117
16118
16119 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16120 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16121 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16122 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16123 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16124 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16125 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16126 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16127 example:
16128 .code
16129 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16130 $sender_host_address
16131 .endd
16132 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16133 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16134 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16135 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16136 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16137 the command.
16138
16139
16140 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16141 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16142 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16143 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16144 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16145
16146
16147 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16148 .cindex "load average"
16149 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16150 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16151 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16152 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16153 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16154 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16155
16156
16157
16158 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16159 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16160 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16161 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16162 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16163 .code
16164 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16165 .endd
16166 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16167 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16168 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16169 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16170 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16171
16172 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16173 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16174 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16175 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16176 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16177 not count towards the limit.
16178
16179
16180
16181 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16182 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16183 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16184 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16185 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16186 that subvert web
16187 clients
16188 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16189 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16190
16191
16192
16193 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16194 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16195 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16196 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16197 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16198 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16199 recipients.
16200
16201 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16202 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16203 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16204 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16205
16206 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16207 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16208 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16209 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16210 values:
16211
16212 .ilist
16213 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16214 .next
16215 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16216 fractional parts are allowed here.
16217 .next
16218 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16219 .next
16220 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16221 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16222 .endlist
16223
16224 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16225 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16226 .code
16227 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16228 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16229 .endd
16230 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16231 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16232 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16233 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16234
16235
16236 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16237 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16238
16239
16240 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16241 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16242
16243
16244 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16245 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16246 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16247 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16248 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16249 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16250 the message is abandoned.
16251 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16252 .code
16253 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16254 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16255 .endd
16256 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16257 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16258
16259 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16260 expanded before use and may depend on
16261 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16262
16263
16264 .oindex "&%-os%&"
16265 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16266 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16267 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16268 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16269 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16270
16271
16272 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16273 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16274 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16275
16276
16277 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16278 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16279 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16280 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16281 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16282 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16283 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16284 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16285 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16286 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16287 .code
16288 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16289 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16290 .endd
16291
16292 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
16293 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
16294 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
16295 The default value is
16296 .code
16297 127.0.0.1 783
16298 .endd
16299 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
16300
16301
16302
16303 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
16304 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
16305 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
16306 .cindex "directories, multiple"
16307 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
16308 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
16309 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
16310 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
16311 arrival of the message.
16312
16313 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
16314 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
16315 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
16316 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
16317 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
16318
16319 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
16320 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
16321 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
16322 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
16323 automatically deleted.
16324
16325 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
16326 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
16327 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
16328 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
16329 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
16330 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
16331 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
16332 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
16333 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
16334
16335
16336 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
16337 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
16338 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
16339 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
16340 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
16341 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
16342 &$primary_hostname$&.
16343
16344 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
16345 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
16346 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
16347 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
16348 as failures in the configuration file.
16349
16350 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
16351 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
16352
16353 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
16354 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
16355 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
16356 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
16357
16358 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
16359 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
16360 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
16361 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
16362 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
16363 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
16364
16365 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
16366 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
16367 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
16368 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
16369 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
16370 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
16371 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
16372
16373
16374 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
16375 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
16376 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
16377 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
16378 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
16379 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
16380 domain causes a syntax error.
16381 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
16382 syntax checking.
16383
16384
16385 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
16386 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
16387 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
16388 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
16389 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
16390 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
16391 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
16392 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
16393 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
16394 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
16395 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
16396 the LOG_ALERT priority.
16397
16398
16399 .option syslog_facility main string unset
16400 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
16401 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16402 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
16403 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
16404 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16405 details of Exim's logging.
16406
16407
16408
16409 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
16410 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
16411 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
16412 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
16413 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
16414
16415
16416
16417 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
16418 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
16419 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
16420 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
16421 details of Exim's logging.
16422
16423
16424 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
16425 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
16426 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
16427 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
16428 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
16429 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
16430 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
16431 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
16432 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
16433 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
16434 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
16435
16436
16437 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
16438 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
16439 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
16440 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
16441 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
16442 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16443
16444
16445 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
16446 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
16447 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
16448 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
16449 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
16450
16451 .option system_filter_group main string unset
16452 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
16453 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
16454 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
16455 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
16456
16457 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
16458 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
16459 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
16460 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
16461 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
16462 contains the pipe command.
16463
16464
16465 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
16466 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
16467 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
16468 is used in a system filter.
16469
16470
16471 .option system_filter_user main string unset
16472 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
16473 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
16474 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
16475 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
16476 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
16477 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
16478 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
16479 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
16480 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
16481
16482 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
16483 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
16484 transport option overrides.
16485
16486
16487 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
16488 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
16489 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
16490 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
16491 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
16492 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
16493 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
16494 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
16495 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
16496 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
16497 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
16498 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
16499 TCP_NODELAY.
16500
16501
16502 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
16503 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
16504 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
16505 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
16506 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
16507 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
16508 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
16509 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
16510 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
16511 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
16512
16513 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
16514 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
16515 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
16516
16517
16518 .option timezone main string unset
16519 .cindex "timezone, setting"
16520 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
16521 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
16522 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
16523 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
16524 .code
16525 timezone = UTC
16526 .endd
16527 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
16528 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
16529 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
16530 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
16531 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
16532 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
16533
16534
16535 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16536 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
16537 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
16538 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
16539 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
16540 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
16541 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
16542 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
16543
16544
16545 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
16546 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
16547 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
16548 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16549 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
16550 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
16551 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16552
16553 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
16554 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
16555 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
16556 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
16557
16558 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
16559 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
16560 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
16561 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
16562
16563 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
16564 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
16565 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
16566 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
16567 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
16568
16569 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16570
16571
16572 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
16573 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
16574 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
16575 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
16576 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
16577 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
16578
16579 The value must be at least 1024.
16580
16581 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
16582 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
16583 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
16584
16585 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
16586 number.
16587
16588 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
16589 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
16590 larger prime than requested.
16591
16592
16593 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
16594 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
16595 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
16596 to be used by Exim.
16597
16598 If it is a filename starting with a &`/`&, then it names a file from which DH
16599 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
16600 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
16601 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
16602 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
16603 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
16604 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
16605
16606 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
16607 loaded by Exim.
16608
16609 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
16610 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
16611 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
16612 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
16613
16614 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
16615 a default DH prime; the default is the 2048 bit prime described in section
16616 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
16617 in IKE is assigned number 23.
16618
16619 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
16620 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526 and RFC 5114. As names, Exim uses
16621 "ike" followed by the number used by IKE, of "default" which corresponds to
16622 "ike23".
16623
16624 The available primes are:
16625 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
16626 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
16627 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& (aka &`default`&) and &`ike24`&.
16628
16629 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
16630 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
16631
16632 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
16633 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
16634 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
16635 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
16636 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
16637 userbase.
16638
16639 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
16640 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
16641 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
16642 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
16643 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
16644 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
16645 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
16646
16647
16648 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! prime256v1
16649 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
16650 If built with a recent-enough version of OpenSSL,
16651 this option selects a EC curve for use by Exim.
16652
16653 Curve names of the form &'prime256v1'& are accepted.
16654 For even more-recent library versions, names of the form &'P-512'&
16655 are also accepted, plus the special value &'auto'&
16656 which tell the library to choose.
16657
16658 If the option is set to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
16659
16660
16661 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
16662 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
16663 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
16664 This option
16665 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
16666 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
16667 Certificate Authority.
16668
16669
16670 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
16671 .cindex SSMTP
16672 .cindex SMTPS
16673 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
16674 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
16675 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
16676 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
16677
16678
16679
16680 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
16681 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
16682 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
16683 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
16684 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
16685 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
16686 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
16687
16688 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16689
16690
16691 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
16692 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
16693 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
16694 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
16695 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
16696 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
16697 TLS session.
16698
16699
16700 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
16701 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
16702 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
16703 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
16704 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
16705 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
16706 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
16707 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
16708 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
16709 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
16710 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
16711
16712
16713 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16714 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16715 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16716 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
16717
16718
16719 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
16720 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16721 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16722 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
16723 word "system"
16724 or the absolute path to
16725 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
16726 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
16727
16728 The "system" value for the option will use a
16729 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
16730 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
16731 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
16732 must be specified.
16733
16734 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
16735 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
16736
16737 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
16738 explicitly
16739 either by file or directory
16740 are added to those given by the system default location.
16741
16742 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
16743 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
16744 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
16745 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
16746 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
16747 use the explicit directory version.
16748
16749 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
16750
16751 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
16752 being unset.
16753
16754
16755 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16756 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
16757 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
16758 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
16759 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
16760 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
16761 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
16762 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
16763
16764 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
16765 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
16766 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
16767 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
16768 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
16769 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
16770 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
16771
16772 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
16773 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
16774 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
16775 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
16776 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
16777 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
16778 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
16779 certificate"&.
16780
16781 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
16782 certificates.
16783
16784
16785 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
16786 .cindex "trusted groups"
16787 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
16788 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16789 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
16790 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
16791 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
16792 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
16793 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
16794 are trusted.
16795
16796 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
16797 .cindex "trusted users"
16798 .cindex "user" "trusted"
16799 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
16800 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
16801 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
16802 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
16803 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
16804 Exim user are trusted.
16805
16806 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
16807 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
16808 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
16809 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
16810 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
16811 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
16812 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
16813 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
16814 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
16815 &%-F%& option.
16816
16817 .option unknown_username main string unset
16818 See &%unknown_login%&.
16819
16820 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
16821 .cindex "trusted users"
16822 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
16823 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
16824 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
16825 .cindex "envelope sender"
16826 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
16827 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
16828 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
16829 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
16830 is used) is ignored.
16831
16832 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
16833 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
16834 .code
16835 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
16836 .endd
16837 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
16838 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
16839 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
16840 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
16841 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
16842 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
16843 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
16844 followed by a hyphen
16845 by a setting like this:
16846 .code
16847 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
16848 .endd
16849 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
16850 restriction, you can use
16851 .code
16852 untrusted_set_sender = *
16853 .endd
16854 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
16855 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
16856 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
16857 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
16858 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
16859 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
16860 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
16861 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
16862
16863 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
16864 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
16865 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
16866 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
16867 sender address.
16868
16869
16870 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
16871 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16872 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16873 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
16874 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
16875 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
16876 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
16877 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
16878 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
16879 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
16880 .code
16881 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
16882 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
16883 .endd
16884 The pattern can be seen by running
16885 .code
16886 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
16887 .endd
16888 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
16889 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
16890 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
16891 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
16892 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
16893 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
16894
16895
16896 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
16897 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
16898
16899
16900 .option warn_message_file main string unset
16901 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
16902 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
16903 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
16904 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
16905 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
16906 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
16907 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
16908
16909
16910 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
16911 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
16912 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
16913 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
16914 .ecindex IIDconfima
16915 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
16916
16917
16918
16919
16920 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16921 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16922
16923 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
16924 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
16925 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
16926 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
16927 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
16928
16929 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
16930 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
16931 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
16932 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
16933 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
16934
16935
16936
16937 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
16938 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
16939 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
16940 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
16941 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
16942 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
16943 delivery of the address to be deferred.
16944
16945 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16946 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
16947 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
16948 routers, and the eventual transport.
16949
16950 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
16951 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
16952 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
16953 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
16954 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
16955
16956 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
16957 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
16958 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
16959 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
16960 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
16961
16962 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
16963 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
16964 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
16965 .code
16966 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
16967 .endd
16968 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
16969 .code
16970 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
16971 .endd
16972 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
16973 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
16974
16975 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
16976 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
16977 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
16978 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
16979 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
16980 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
16981 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
16982
16983
16984
16985 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
16986 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
16987 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
16988 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
16989 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
16990 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
16991 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
16992 routing.
16993
16994
16995
16996 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
16997 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
16998 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
16999 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17000 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17001 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17002 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17003 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17004 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17005 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17006 you could put:
17007 .code
17008 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17009 .endd
17010 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17011 and
17012 .code
17013 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17014 .endd
17015 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17016 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17017 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17018 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17019
17020
17021 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17022 .cindex "case of local parts"
17023 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17024 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17025 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17026 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17027 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17028 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17029 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17030 more details.
17031
17032 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17033 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17034 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17035 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17036 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17037 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17038 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17039 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17040 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17041
17042 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17043 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17044 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17045 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17046
17047
17048
17049 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17050 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17051 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17052 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17053 .vindex "&$home$&"
17054 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17055 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17056 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17057 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17058 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17059 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17060 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17061 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17062 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17063 the router is skipped.
17064
17065 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17066 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17067 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17068 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17069 setting to achieve this. For example:
17070 .code
17071 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17072 .endd
17073 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17074 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17075 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17076
17077
17078
17079 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17080 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17081 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17082 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17083 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17084 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17085 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17086 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17087
17088 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17089 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17090
17091 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17092 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17093
17094 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17095 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17096 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17097 .code
17098 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17099 .endd
17100 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17101 .code
17102 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17103 .endd
17104
17105 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17106 .code
17107 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17108 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17109 condition = foobar
17110 .endd
17111
17112 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17113 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17114 be specified using &%condition%&.
17115
17116 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17117 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17118 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17119 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17120 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17121 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17122 Router rules processing behavior.
17123
17124 This is best illustrated in an example:
17125 .code
17126 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17127 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17128
17129 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17130 true {yes} {no}}
17131
17132 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17133 {yes} {no}}
17134 .endd
17135 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17136 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17137 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17138 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17139 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17140 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17141 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17142 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17143
17144 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17145 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17146 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17147 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17148 string characters.
17149
17150 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17151 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17152 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17153 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17154 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17155
17156
17157 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17158 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17159 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17160 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17161 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17162 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17163 output, and Exim carries on processing.
17164 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17165 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17166 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17167 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17168 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17169 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17170 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17171
17172
17173
17174 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
17175 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17176 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17177 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17178 transport option of the same name.
17179
17180 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17181 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17182 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17183 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17184 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17185 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17186 the dnssec request bit set.
17187 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17188
17189 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17190 .cindex "MX record" "security"
17191 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17192 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17193 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17194 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17195 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17196 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17197 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17198
17199
17200 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
17201 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
17202 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
17203 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
17204 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
17205 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
17206 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
17207 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
17208
17209
17210
17211 .option driver routers string unset
17212 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
17213 to be used.
17214
17215
17216 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
17217 .cindex "DSN" "success"
17218 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
17219 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
17220 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
17221 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
17222 Not effective on redirect routers.
17223
17224
17225
17226 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
17227 .cindex "envelope sender"
17228 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
17229 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
17230 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
17231 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
17232 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
17233 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
17234 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
17235
17236 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
17237 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
17238 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
17239 setting.
17240
17241 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
17242 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
17243 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
17244 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
17245
17246 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
17247 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
17248 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
17249 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
17250 settings:
17251 .code
17252 errors_to =
17253 errors_to = ""
17254 .endd
17255 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
17256 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
17257 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
17258 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
17259 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
17260
17261 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17262 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
17263 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
17264 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
17265 setting &%return_path%&.
17266
17267 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
17268 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
17269 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
17270
17271
17272
17273 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
17274 .cindex "address" "testing"
17275 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
17276 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
17277 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
17278 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
17279 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
17280 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
17281 on for the system alias file.
17282 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17283 are evaluated.
17284
17285 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
17286 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
17287 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
17288
17289
17290
17291 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
17292 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
17293 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
17294 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
17295
17296
17297
17298 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
17299 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17300 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
17301
17302
17303
17304 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
17305 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
17306 verifying a sender, verification fails.
17307
17308
17309
17310 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
17311 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
17312 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
17313 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
17314 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
17315 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
17316 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
17317 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
17318 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
17319
17320 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
17321 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
17322 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
17323 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
17324 transport for further details.
17325
17326
17327 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
17328 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
17329 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17330 .cindex "transport" "local"
17331 .cindex "router" "setting group"
17332 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
17333 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
17334 process.
17335 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
17336 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
17337 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
17338 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
17339 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17340
17341
17342
17343 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
17344 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
17345 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
17346 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17347 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17348 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17349 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17350 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17351 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
17352 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
17353 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
17354 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
17355 &"see"& the added header lines.
17356
17357 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
17358 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
17359 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
17360 failures are treated as configuration errors.
17361
17362 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
17363 for a router; all listed headers are added.
17364
17365 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17366 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17367
17368 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17369 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
17370 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17371 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
17372 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
17373 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
17374 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
17375 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
17376 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
17377 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
17378
17379
17380
17381 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
17382 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
17383 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
17384 This option specifies a list of text headers,
17385 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
17386 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
17387 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
17388 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
17389 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
17390 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
17391 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
17392 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
17393 &"see"& the original header lines.
17394
17395 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
17396 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
17397 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
17398 errors.
17399
17400 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
17401 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
17402
17403 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
17404 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
17405
17406 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
17407 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
17408 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
17409 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
17410
17411 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
17412 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
17413 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
17414
17415
17416
17417 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
17418 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
17419 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
17420 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
17421 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
17422 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
17423 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
17424 like
17425 .code
17426 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
17427 .endd
17428 by setting
17429 .code
17430 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
17431 .endd
17432 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
17433 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
17434 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
17435 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
17436 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
17437 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
17438
17439 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
17440 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
17441 .code
17442 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
17443 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
17444 .endd
17445 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
17446 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
17447
17448 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
17449 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
17450 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
17451 domain that is being routed.
17452
17453 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17454 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
17455 checked.
17456
17457 .option initgroups routers boolean false
17458 .cindex "additional groups"
17459 .cindex "groups" "additional"
17460 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
17461 .cindex "transport" "local"
17462 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
17463 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
17464 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
17465 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
17466 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
17467
17468
17469
17470 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
17471 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
17472 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
17473 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
17474 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
17475 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
17476 evaluated.
17477
17478 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
17479 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
17480 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
17481 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
17482 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
17483 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
17484 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
17485 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
17486 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
17487
17488 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17489 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
17490 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
17491 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
17492 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
17493 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
17494 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
17495 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
17496 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
17497 the relevant transport.
17498
17499 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
17500 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
17501 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
17502 callout.
17503
17504 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
17505 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
17506 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
17507 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
17508 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
17509 .code
17510 real_localuser:
17511 driver = accept
17512 local_part_prefix = real-
17513 check_local_user
17514 transport = local_delivery
17515 .endd
17516 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
17517 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
17518 .code
17519 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
17520 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
17521 .endd
17522
17523 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
17524 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
17525 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
17526 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
17527
17528
17529 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
17530 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
17531
17532
17533
17534 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
17535 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
17536 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
17537 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
17538 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
17539 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
17540 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
17541 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
17542 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
17543 &%username-foo%&.
17544
17545
17546 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
17547 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
17548
17549
17550
17551 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
17552 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
17553 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
17554 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
17555 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17556 are evaluated, and
17557 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
17558 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
17559 example:
17560 .code
17561 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
17562 .endd
17563 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
17564 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
17565 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
17566 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
17567 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
17568 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
17569 each virtual domain:
17570 .code
17571 postmaster:
17572 driver = redirect
17573 local_parts = postmaster
17574 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
17575 .endd
17576
17577
17578 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
17579 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
17580 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
17581 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
17582 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
17583 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
17584 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
17585 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
17586 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
17587 redirect addresses.
17588
17589
17590
17591 .option more routers boolean&!! true
17592 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17593 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17594 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17595 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
17596 delivery to be deferred.
17597
17598 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
17599 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
17600 .oindex "&%self%&"
17601 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
17602 means of the setting
17603 .code
17604 self = pass
17605 .endd
17606 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
17607 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
17608 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
17609
17610 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
17611 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
17612 controls what happens next.
17613
17614
17615 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
17616 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
17617 .cindex "router" "timeout"
17618 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
17619 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
17620 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
17621 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
17622 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
17623
17624 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
17625 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
17626 applies to all of them.
17627
17628
17629
17630 .option pass_router routers string unset
17631 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
17632 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
17633 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
17634 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
17635 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
17636 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
17637 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
17638 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
17639 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
17640 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
17641
17642
17643
17644 .option redirect_router routers string unset
17645 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
17646 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
17647 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
17648 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
17649 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
17650
17651 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
17652 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
17653 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
17654 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
17655
17656
17657
17658 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
17659 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
17660 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
17661 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
17662 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
17663 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
17664 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
17665
17666 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
17667 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
17668 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
17669 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
17670
17671 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
17672 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
17673 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
17674 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
17675 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
17676
17677 .cindex "NFS"
17678 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
17679 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
17680 unavailable.
17681
17682 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
17683 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
17684 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
17685 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
17686 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
17687 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
17688 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
17689 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
17690
17691 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
17692 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
17693 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
17694 operates as follows:
17695
17696 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
17697 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
17698 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
17699 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
17700 used. For example:
17701 .code
17702 require_files = mail:/some/file
17703 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
17704 .endd
17705 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
17706 &%require_files%& condition fails.
17707
17708 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
17709 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
17710 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
17711 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
17712
17713 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
17714 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
17715 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
17716 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
17717 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
17718
17719 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
17720 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
17721 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
17722 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
17723 check again in that process.
17724
17725 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
17726 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
17727 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
17728 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
17729 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
17730 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
17731 as if the file did not exist. For example:
17732 .code
17733 require_files = +/some/file
17734 .endd
17735 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
17736 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
17737 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
17738
17739
17740
17741 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
17742 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
17743 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
17744 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
17745 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
17746 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
17747 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
17748 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
17749 latter kind.
17750
17751 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
17752 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
17753 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
17754 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
17755 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
17756 same name.
17757
17758 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
17759 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
17760 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
17761
17762
17763
17764 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
17765 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
17766 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
17767 .vindex "&$home$&"
17768 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
17769 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
17770 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
17771 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
17772 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
17773 cause the router to defer.
17774
17775 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
17776 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
17777 place.
17778 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17779 are evaluated.)
17780 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
17781 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
17782
17783 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
17784 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
17785 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
17786 of these values that is set:
17787
17788 .ilist
17789 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
17790 .next
17791 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
17792 .next
17793 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
17794 .next
17795 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
17796 .endlist
17797
17798 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
17799 router, but not for the transport.
17800
17801
17802
17803 .option self routers string freeze
17804 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
17805 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
17806 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
17807 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
17808 and &(manualroute)& routers.
17809 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
17810 of remote hosts.
17811 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
17812 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
17813 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
17814 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
17815 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
17816
17817 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
17818 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
17819 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
17820 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
17821 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
17822 cases:
17823
17824 .vlist
17825 .vitem &%defer%&
17826 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
17827
17828 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
17829 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
17830 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
17831 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
17832
17833 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
17834 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
17835 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
17836 rewritten.
17837
17838 .vitem &%pass%&
17839 .oindex "&%more%&"
17840 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
17841 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
17842 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
17843 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
17844 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
17845 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
17846 combination
17847 .code
17848 self = pass
17849 no_more
17850 .endd
17851 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
17852 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
17853 be passed to the next router.
17854
17855 .vitem &%fail%&
17856 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
17857
17858 .vitem &%send%&
17859 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
17860 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
17861 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
17862 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
17863 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
17864 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
17865 .endlist
17866
17867
17868
17869 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
17870 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
17871 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
17872 address matches something on the list.
17873 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
17874 are evaluated.
17875
17876 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
17877 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
17878 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
17879 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
17880 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
17881 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
17882 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
17883 matters.
17884
17885
17886 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
17887 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
17888 .cindex "packet radio"
17889 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
17890 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
17891 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
17892 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
17893 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
17894 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
17895 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
17896 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
17897
17898 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
17899 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
17900 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
17901 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
17902 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
17903 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
17904 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
17905 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
17906 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
17907 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
17908 .code
17909 translate_ip_address = \
17910 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
17911 {$value}fail}}
17912 .endd
17913 The file would contain lines like
17914 .code
17915 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
17916 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
17917 .endd
17918 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
17919 are doing.
17920
17921
17922
17923 .option transport routers string&!! unset
17924 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
17925 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
17926 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
17927 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
17928 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
17929 delivery is deferred.
17930
17931 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
17932 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
17933 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
17934
17935
17936
17937 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
17938 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
17939 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
17940 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
17941 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
17942 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
17943 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
17944 overridden by a setting on the transport.
17945 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17946 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17947 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
17948 environment.
17949
17950
17951
17952
17953 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
17954 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
17955 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
17956 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
17957 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
17958 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
17959 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
17960 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
17961 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
17962 logged, and delivery is deferred.
17963
17964 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
17965 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
17966 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
17967 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
17968 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
17969
17970 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
17971 environment.
17972
17973
17974
17975
17976 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
17977 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
17978 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
17979 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
17980 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
17981 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
17982 delivery to be deferred.
17983
17984 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
17985 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
17986 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
17987 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
17988 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
17989 sometimes true and sometimes false).
17990
17991 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
17992 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
17993 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
17994 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
17995 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
17996 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
17997 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
17998 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
17999
18000 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18001 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18002 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18003 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18004 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18005 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18006 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18007 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18008 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18009 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18010
18011 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18012 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18013 subsequent routers.
18014
18015
18016 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18017 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18018 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18019 .cindex "transport" "local"
18020 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18021 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18022 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18023 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18024 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18025 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18026 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18027 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18028 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18029 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18030 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18031 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18032
18033
18034
18035 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18036 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18037 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18038
18039
18040 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18041 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18042 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
18043 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18044 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18045 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18046 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18047 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18048 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18049 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18050
18051 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18052 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18053 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18054 user or group.
18055
18056
18057 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18058 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18059 addresses,
18060 delivering in cutthrough mode
18061 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18062 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18063 are evaluated.
18064 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18065
18066
18067 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18068 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18069 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18070 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18071 are evaluated.
18072 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18073 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18074 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18075
18076
18077
18078
18079
18080
18081 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18082 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18083
18084 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18085 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18086 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18087 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18088 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18089 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18090 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18091 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18092 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18093 .code
18094 localusers:
18095 driver = accept
18096 domains = mydomain.example
18097 check_local_user
18098 transport = local_delivery
18099 .endd
18100 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18101 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18102 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18103 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18104
18105
18106
18107
18108
18109
18110 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18111 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18112
18113 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18114 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18115 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18116 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18117 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18118 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18119
18120 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18121 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18122 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18123 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18124 records.
18125
18126 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18127 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18128 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18129 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18130 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18131 generic option, the router declines.
18132
18133 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18134 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18135 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18136
18137 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18138 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18139 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18140 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18141 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18142 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18143
18144
18145 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18146 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18147 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18148 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18149 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18150 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18151
18152 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18153 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18154 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18155 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18156 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18157 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18158 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18159 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18160 case routing fails.
18161
18162
18163 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18164 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18165 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18166 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18167 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18168
18169 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18170 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18171
18172 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18173 .ilist
18174 The domain does not exist in DNS
18175 .next
18176 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18177 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18178 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18179 .next
18180 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18181 .next
18182 MX record points to a non-existent host.
18183 .next
18184 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18185 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18186 .next
18187 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18188 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18189 .next
18190 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18191 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18192 .next
18193 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18194 not be found in the MX records (see below)
18195 .endlist
18196
18197
18198
18199
18200 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
18201 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
18202 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
18203
18204 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
18205 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
18206 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
18207 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
18208 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
18209 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
18210 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18211
18212
18213 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
18214 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
18215 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
18216 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
18217 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
18218 required. For example,
18219 .code
18220 check_srv = smtp
18221 .endd
18222 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
18223 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
18224 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
18225 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
18226 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
18227 normal way.
18228
18229 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
18230 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
18231 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
18232 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
18233 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
18234 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
18235
18236 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
18237 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
18238 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
18239 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
18240 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
18241 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
18242 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
18243 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
18244
18245 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
18246 when there is a DNS lookup error.
18247
18248
18249
18250
18251 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18252 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
18253 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
18254 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
18255 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
18256 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
18257 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
18258 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
18259 also being queued.
18260
18261
18262 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18263 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
18264 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
18265 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
18266 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
18267 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
18268 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
18269 setting:
18270 .code
18271 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
18272 .endd
18273 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
18274 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
18275 the address record.
18276
18277
18278 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18279 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18280 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
18281 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18282
18283
18284
18285
18286 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
18287 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18288 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
18289 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
18290 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
18291 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
18292 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
18293 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
18294 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
18295 &'resolv.conf'&.
18296
18297
18298
18299 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
18300 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
18301 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
18302 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
18303 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
18304 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
18305 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
18306 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
18307 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
18308 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
18309 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
18310
18311 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
18312 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
18313 sense.
18314
18315 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
18316 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
18317 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
18318 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
18319 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
18320 header rewriting.
18321
18322
18323 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
18324 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18325 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
18326 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
18327 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18328 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18329 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18330 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18331
18332 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18333 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
18334 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18335 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
18336 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
18337 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
18338 without processing them independently,
18339 provided the following conditions are met:
18340
18341 .ilist
18342 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
18343 &%headers_remove%&.
18344 .next
18345 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
18346 the domain.
18347 .endlist
18348
18349
18350
18351
18352 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
18353 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
18354 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
18355 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
18356 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
18357 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
18358 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
18359 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
18360 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
18361 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
18362
18363 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
18364 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
18365 local wildcard.
18366
18367
18368
18369 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
18370 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
18371 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
18372 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
18373
18374
18375
18376
18377 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
18378 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
18379 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
18380 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
18381 if
18382 .code
18383 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
18384 .endd
18385 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
18386 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
18387 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
18388 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
18389 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
18390 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
18391
18392
18393 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
18394 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
18395 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
18396 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
18397 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
18398
18399 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
18400 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
18401 such as that implied by
18402 .code
18403 domains = @mx_any
18404 .endd
18405 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
18406 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
18407 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
18408 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
18409
18410
18411
18412
18413
18414
18415
18416
18417
18418 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18419 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18420
18421 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
18422 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
18423 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
18424 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
18425 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
18426 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
18427 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
18428 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
18429 router handles the address
18430 .code
18431 root@[192.168.1.1]
18432 .endd
18433 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
18434 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
18435 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
18436 .code
18437 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
18438 .endd
18439 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
18440 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
18441
18442 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
18443 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
18444 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
18445 &%self%& option determines what happens.
18446
18447 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
18448 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
18449 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
18450 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
18451
18452
18453
18454 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18455 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18456
18457 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
18458 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
18459 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
18460 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
18461 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
18462 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
18463 must set
18464 .code
18465 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
18466 .endd
18467 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
18468
18469 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
18470 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
18471 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
18472 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
18473 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
18474 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
18475 must not be specified for it.
18476
18477 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
18478 .option hosts iplookup string unset
18479 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
18480 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
18481 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
18482 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
18483 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
18484
18485
18486 .option optional iplookup boolean false
18487 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
18488 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
18489 delivery to the address is deferred.
18490
18491
18492 .option port iplookup integer 0
18493 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
18494 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
18495 call.
18496
18497
18498 .option protocol iplookup string udp
18499 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
18500 protocols is to be used.
18501
18502
18503 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
18504 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
18505 default value is:
18506 .code
18507 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
18508 .endd
18509 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
18510 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
18511
18512
18513 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
18514 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
18515 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
18516 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
18517 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
18518 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
18519 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
18520 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
18521
18522
18523 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
18524 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
18525 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
18526 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
18527 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
18528 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
18529 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
18530 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
18531 following could be used:
18532 .code
18533 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
18534 reroute = $local_part@$1
18535 .endd
18536
18537 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
18538 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
18539 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
18540 call. It does not apply to UDP.
18541
18542
18543
18544
18545 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18546 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18547
18548 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
18549 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
18550 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
18551 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
18552 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
18553 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
18554 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
18555 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
18556 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
18557 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
18558
18559 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
18560 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
18561 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
18562 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
18563 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
18564 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
18565 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
18566
18567 .vindex "&$host$&"
18568 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
18569 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
18570 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
18571 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
18572 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
18573 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
18574 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
18575 text string.
18576
18577 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
18578 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
18579 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
18580 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
18581 below, following the list of private options.
18582
18583
18584 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
18585
18586 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
18587 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
18588
18589 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
18590 See &%host_find_failed%&.
18591
18592 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
18593 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
18594 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
18595 of the following values:
18596 .code
18597 decline
18598 defer
18599 fail
18600 freeze
18601 ignore
18602 pass
18603 .endd
18604 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
18605 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
18606 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
18607 &%pass_router%&),
18608 .oindex "&%more%&"
18609 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
18610 router only if &%more%& is true.
18611
18612 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
18613 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
18614 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
18615 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
18616
18617 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
18618 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
18619 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
18620
18621
18622 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
18623 .cindex "randomized host list"
18624 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
18625 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
18626 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
18627 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
18628 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
18629 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
18630 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
18631 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
18632
18633 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
18634 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
18635 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
18636 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
18637 .code
18638 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
18639 .endd
18640 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
18641 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
18642 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
18643 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
18644 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
18645
18646
18647 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
18648 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
18649 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
18650 example:
18651 .code
18652 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
18653 .endd
18654 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
18655 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
18656 deferred.
18657
18658
18659 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
18660 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
18661 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
18662 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
18663
18664
18665 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
18666 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
18667 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
18668 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
18669 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
18670 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
18671 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
18672 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
18673
18674 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
18675 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
18676 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
18677 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
18678 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
18679 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
18680 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
18681 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
18682
18683
18684
18685
18686 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
18687 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
18688 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
18689 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
18690 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18691 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
18692 .display
18693 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
18694 .endd
18695 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
18696 no options:
18697 .code
18698 route_list = \
18699 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
18700 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18701 .endd
18702 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
18703 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
18704 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
18705 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
18706 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
18707 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
18708 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
18709 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
18710 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
18711 in a &%route_list%&).
18712
18713 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
18714 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
18715 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
18716 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
18717
18718
18719
18720 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
18721 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
18722 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
18723 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
18724 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
18725 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
18726 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
18727 like this:
18728 .code
18729 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
18730 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
18731 .endd
18732 This data can be accessed by setting
18733 .code
18734 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
18735 .endd
18736 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
18737 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
18738 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
18739 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
18740 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
18741
18742
18743
18744
18745 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
18746 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
18747 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
18748 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
18749 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
18750 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
18751 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
18752
18753 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
18754 variables are set during its expansion:
18755
18756 .ilist
18757 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18758 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
18759 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
18760 .code
18761 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
18762 .endd
18763 .next
18764 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
18765 .next
18766 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
18767
18768 .next
18769 .vindex "&$value$&"
18770 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
18771 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
18772 .code
18773 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
18774 .endd
18775 .endlist
18776
18777 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
18778 semicolon is the default route list separator.
18779
18780
18781
18782 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
18783 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
18784 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
18785 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
18786 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
18787 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
18788
18789 .ilist
18790 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
18791 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
18792 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
18793 .code
18794 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
18795 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
18796 .endd
18797 .next
18798 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
18799 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
18800 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
18801 number follows. For example:
18802 .code
18803 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
18804 .endd
18805 .endlist
18806
18807 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
18808 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
18809 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
18810 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
18811 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
18812 transport.
18813
18814 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
18815 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
18816 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
18817 records in the DNS. For example:
18818 .code
18819 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
18820 .endd
18821 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
18822 example:
18823 .code
18824 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
18825 .endd
18826 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
18827 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
18828 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
18829 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
18830 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
18831 happens is controlled by the
18832 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
18833 &%self%& option of the router.
18834
18835 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
18836 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
18837 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
18838 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
18839 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
18840 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
18841 defined by MX preferences.
18842
18843 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
18844 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
18845 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
18846
18847 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
18848 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
18849 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
18850 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
18851
18852 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
18853 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
18854 router.
18855
18856 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
18857 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
18858 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
18859
18860 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
18861 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
18862
18863
18864
18865 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
18866 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
18867 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
18868 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
18869 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
18870 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
18871 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
18872
18873 .ilist
18874 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
18875 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18876 .next
18877 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
18878 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
18879 .next
18880 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
18881 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
18882 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
18883 .next
18884 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
18885 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
18886 timeout), delivery is deferred.
18887 .endlist
18888
18889 For example:
18890 .code
18891 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
18892 domain2 host4:host5
18893 .endd
18894 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
18895 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
18896 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
18897 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
18898 call.
18899
18900 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
18901 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
18902 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
18903 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
18904 function called.
18905
18906
18907
18908 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
18909 &%host_find_failed%& option.
18910
18911 .vindex "&$host$&"
18912 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
18913 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
18914
18915
18916
18917 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
18918 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
18919 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
18920
18921 .ilist
18922 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
18923 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
18924 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
18925 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
18926 .code
18927 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
18928 .endd
18929 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
18930 your first router something like this:
18931 .code
18932 smart_route:
18933 driver = manualroute
18934 domains = !+local_domains
18935 transport = remote_smtp
18936 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
18937 .endd
18938 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
18939 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
18940 they are tried in order
18941 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
18942 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
18943 .code
18944 smart_route:
18945 driver = manualroute
18946 transport = remote_smtp
18947 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
18948 .endd
18949 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
18950 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
18951 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
18952 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
18953 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
18954 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
18955 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
18956 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
18957
18958 .next
18959 .cindex "mail hub example"
18960 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
18961 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
18962 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
18963 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
18964 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
18965 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
18966 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
18967 lookup is easier to manage.
18968
18969 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
18970 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
18971 example:
18972 .code
18973 hub_route:
18974 driver = manualroute
18975 transport = remote_smtp
18976 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
18977 .endd
18978 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
18979 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
18980 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
18981 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
18982 domain can be used to find the host:
18983 .code
18984 through_firewall:
18985 driver = manualroute
18986 transport = remote_smtp
18987 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
18988 .endd
18989 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
18990 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
18991 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
18992 next router.
18993
18994 .next
18995 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
18996 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
18997 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
18998 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
18999 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19000 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19001 .code
19002 save_in_file:
19003 driver = manualroute
19004 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19005 route_list = saved.domain.example
19006 .endd
19007 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19008 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19009 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19010 .code
19011 save_in_file:
19012 driver = manualroute
19013 route_list = \
19014 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19015 *.saved.domain2.example \
19016 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19017 batch_pipe
19018 .endd
19019 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19020 .vindex "&$host$&"
19021 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19022 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19023 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19024 the address if the lookup fails.
19025
19026 .next
19027 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19028 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19029 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19030 one way it can be done:
19031 .code
19032 # Transport
19033 uucp:
19034 driver = pipe
19035 user = nobody
19036 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19037 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19038 return_fail_output = true
19039
19040 # Router
19041 uucphost:
19042 transport = uucp
19043 driver = manualroute
19044 route_data = \
19045 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19046 .endd
19047 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19048 .code
19049 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19050 .endd
19051 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19052 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19053 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19054 .endlist
19055 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19056 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19057
19058
19059
19060
19061
19062
19063
19064
19065 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19066 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19067
19068 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19069 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19070 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19071 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19072 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19073 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19074 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19075 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19076 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19077 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19078 options:
19079 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19080
19081 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19082 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19083 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19084 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19085 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19086
19087
19088 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19089 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19090 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19091 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19092 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19093 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19094
19095
19096 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19097 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19098 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19099 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19100 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19101 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19102 not set, a value for the gid also.
19103
19104 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19105 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19106 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19107 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19108 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19109 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19110 gid.
19111
19112
19113 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19114 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19115 before running the command.
19116
19117
19118 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19119 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19120 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19121 timeout.
19122
19123
19124 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19125 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19126 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19127 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19128 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19129
19130 .ilist
19131 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19132 below).
19133 .next
19134 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19135 &%no_more%& is set.
19136 .next
19137 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19138 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19139 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19140 included in the SMTP response.
19141 .next
19142 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19143 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19144 included in any SMTP response.
19145 .next
19146 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19147 .next
19148 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19149 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19150 .next
19151 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19152 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19153 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19154 .endlist
19155
19156 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19157 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19158 the page):
19159 .code
19160 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19161 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19162 .endd
19163 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19164 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19165 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19166 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19167
19168 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19169 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19170 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19171 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19172 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
19173
19174 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
19175 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
19176 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
19177 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
19178 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
19179
19180 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19181 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
19182 variable. For example, this return line
19183 .code
19184 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
19185 .endd
19186 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
19187 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
19188 .ecindex IIDquerou1
19189 .ecindex IIDquerou2
19190
19191
19192
19193
19194 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19195 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19196
19197 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
19198 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
19199 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
19200 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
19201 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
19202 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
19203 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
19204 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
19205 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
19206 redirected in several different ways:
19207
19208 .ilist
19209 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
19210 independently.
19211 .next
19212 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
19213 .next
19214 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
19215 .next
19216 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
19217 .next
19218 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
19219 .next
19220 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
19221 .next
19222 It can be discarded.
19223 .endlist
19224
19225 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
19226 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
19227 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
19228 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
19229
19230 If success DSNs have been requested
19231 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19232 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19233 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
19234
19235
19236
19237 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
19238 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
19239 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
19240 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
19241 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
19242 aliases, in a configuration like this:
19243 .code
19244 system_aliases:
19245 driver = redirect
19246 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
19247 .endd
19248 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
19249 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
19250 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
19251 cause delivery to be deferred.
19252
19253 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
19254 &_.forward_& files, like this:
19255 .code
19256 userforward:
19257 driver = redirect
19258 check_local_user
19259 file = $home/.forward
19260 no_verify
19261 .endd
19262 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
19263 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
19264 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
19265 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
19266 comments.
19267
19268
19269
19270 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
19271 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
19272 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
19273 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
19274
19275 .ilist
19276 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
19277 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
19278 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
19279 practice the router may not be able to operate.
19280 .next
19281 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
19282 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
19283 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
19284 saves some resources.
19285 .endlist
19286
19287
19288
19289
19290
19291
19292 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
19293 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19294 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
19295 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
19296 can be interpreted in two different ways:
19297
19298 .ilist
19299 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
19300 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
19301 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
19302 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
19303 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
19304 document is intended for use by end users.
19305 .next
19306 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
19307 described in the next section.
19308 .endlist
19309
19310 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
19311 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
19312 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
19313 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
19314 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
19315
19316
19317
19318 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
19319 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
19320 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
19321 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
19322 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
19323 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
19324 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
19325 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
19326 commas or newlines.
19327 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
19328 quotes.
19329
19330 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
19331 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
19332 next newline character is ignored.
19333
19334 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
19335 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
19336 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
19337 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
19338 removed.
19339
19340 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19341 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
19342 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
19343 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
19344 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
19345 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
19346 setting:
19347 .code
19348 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
19349 .endd
19350
19351
19352 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
19353 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
19354 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
19355 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
19356 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
19357 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
19358 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
19359 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
19360 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
19361 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
19362 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
19363
19364 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
19365 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
19366 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
19367 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
19368 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
19369 .code
19370 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
19371 .endd
19372 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
19373 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
19374 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
19375 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
19376 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
19377 synonymously.
19378
19379 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
19380 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
19381 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
19382 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
19383 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
19384
19385 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
19386 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
19387 contains:
19388 .code
19389 Sam.Reman: spqr
19390 .endd
19391 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
19392 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
19393 this forward file:
19394 .code
19395 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19396 .endd
19397 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
19398 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
19399 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
19400 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
19401 should really contain
19402 .code
19403 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
19404 .endd
19405 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
19406 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
19407 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
19408
19409
19410
19411 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
19412 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
19413 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
19414
19415 .ilist
19416 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
19417 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
19418 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
19419 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
19420 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
19421 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19422 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19423
19424 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
19425 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
19426 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
19427 in double quotes, for example:
19428 .code
19429 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
19430 .endd
19431 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
19432 quote just the command. An item such as
19433 .code
19434 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
19435 .endd
19436 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
19437
19438 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
19439 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
19440 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
19441 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
19442 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
19443 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
19444 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
19445 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
19446 an &%accept%& router.
19447
19448 .next
19449 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
19450 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
19451 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
19452 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
19453 .code
19454 /home/world/minbari
19455 .endd
19456 is treated as a file name, but
19457 .code
19458 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
19459 .endd
19460 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
19461 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
19462 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
19463 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
19464
19465 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
19466 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
19467
19468 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
19469 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
19470 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
19471 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
19472
19473 .next
19474 .cindex "included address list"
19475 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
19476 If an item is of the form
19477 .code
19478 :include:<path name>
19479 .endd
19480 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
19481 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
19482 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
19483 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
19484 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
19485 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
19486 .code
19487 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
19488 .endd
19489 It must be given as
19490 .code
19491 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
19492 .endd
19493 .next
19494 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
19495 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
19496 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
19497 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
19498 .cindex "black hole"
19499 .cindex "abandoning mail"
19500 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
19501 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
19502 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
19503
19504 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
19505 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
19506 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
19507 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
19508 &_/dev/null_&.
19509
19510 .next
19511 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
19512 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
19513 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
19514 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
19515 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
19516 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
19517 redirection items of the form
19518 .code
19519 :defer:
19520 :fail:
19521 .endd
19522 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
19523 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
19524 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
19525 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
19526 .code
19527 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
19528 .endd
19529 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
19530 of a
19531 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
19532 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
19533 default.
19534 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
19535 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
19536 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
19537
19538 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19539 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
19540 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
19541 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
19542 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
19543 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
19544 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
19545 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
19546 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
19547 ignored.
19548
19549 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
19550 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
19551 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
19552 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
19553
19554 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
19555 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
19556 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
19557 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
19558 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
19559
19560 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
19561 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
19562 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
19563 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
19564 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
19565 rules still apply.
19566
19567 .next
19568 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
19569 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
19570 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
19571 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
19572 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
19573 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
19574 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
19575 .endlist
19576
19577
19578 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
19579 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19580 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
19581 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
19582 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
19583 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
19584 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
19585 aliasing scheme of the type
19586 .code
19587 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
19588 localpart1: pipe
19589 localpart2: pipe
19590 .endd
19591 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
19592 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
19593 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
19594 such as
19595 .code
19596 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
19597 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
19598 .endd
19599 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
19600 the pipes are distinct.
19601
19602
19603
19604 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
19605 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
19606 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
19607 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
19608 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
19609 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
19610 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
19611 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
19612 can be used to avoid this.
19613
19614
19615 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
19616 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
19617 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
19618 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
19619 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
19620 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
19621 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
19622
19623
19624
19625 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
19626
19627 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
19628 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
19629
19630
19631 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
19632 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
19633 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
19634
19635
19636 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
19637 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
19638 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
19639 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
19640
19641
19642 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
19643 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
19644 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
19645 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
19646 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
19647 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
19648 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
19649
19650 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
19651 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
19652
19653
19654 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
19655 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
19656 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
19657 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
19658 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
19659
19660
19661
19662 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
19663 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
19664 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
19665 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
19666 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
19667 let ordinary users do.
19668
19669
19670
19671 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
19672 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
19673 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
19674 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
19675 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
19676 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
19677
19678 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
19679 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
19680 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
19681 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
19682 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
19683 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
19684 .code
19685 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
19686 .endd
19687 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
19688 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
19689 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
19690 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
19691 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
19692 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
19693 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
19694 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
19695
19696
19697 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
19698 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
19699 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
19700 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
19701 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
19702 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
19703 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
19704 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
19705
19706
19707
19708 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
19709 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
19710 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
19711 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
19712 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
19713 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
19714
19715
19716 .option data redirect string&!! unset
19717 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
19718 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
19719 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
19720 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
19721 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
19722
19723 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
19724 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
19725 terminated with newline characters. For example:
19726 .code
19727 data = #Exim filter\n\
19728 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
19729 .endd
19730 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
19731 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
19732 choice into a newline.
19733
19734
19735 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
19736 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
19737 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19738 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19739 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
19740
19741
19742 .option file redirect string&!! unset
19743 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
19744 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
19745 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
19746 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
19747 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
19748 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
19749 entirely of comments), the router declines.
19750
19751 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
19752 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
19753 runs a check on the containing directory,
19754 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
19755 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
19756 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
19757 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
19758 not, the router declines.
19759
19760
19761 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
19762 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19763 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
19764 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
19765 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
19766 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
19767 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
19768
19769
19770 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
19771 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
19772 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
19773 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
19774 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
19775
19776
19777 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
19778 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
19779 redirection list.
19780
19781
19782 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
19783 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
19784 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19785
19786
19787
19788
19789 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
19790 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
19791 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
19792 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
19793 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
19794 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
19795 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
19796 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
19797 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
19798
19799
19800 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
19801 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
19802 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19803 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
19804 functions.
19805
19806 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
19807 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
19808 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
19809 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
19810
19811 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
19812 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
19813 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
19814 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
19815 &_.forward_& files).
19816
19817
19818 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
19819 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19820 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
19821
19822
19823 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
19824 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
19825 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
19826 of the embedded Perl support.
19827
19828
19829 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
19830 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19831 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
19832
19833
19834 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
19835 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19836 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
19837
19838
19839 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
19840 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
19841 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
19842 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
19843 &%one_time%& is set.
19844
19845
19846 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
19847 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
19848 to make use of &%run%& items.
19849
19850
19851 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
19852 If this option is true, items of the form
19853 .code
19854 :include:<path name>
19855 .endd
19856 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
19857
19858
19859 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
19860 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
19861 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
19862 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
19863 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
19864
19865
19866 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
19867 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
19868 &%allow_filter%& is true.
19869
19870
19871 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
19872 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
19873 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
19874 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
19875 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
19876
19877
19878
19879
19880 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
19881 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
19882 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
19883 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
19884 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
19885 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
19886 bounce may well quote the generated address.
19887
19888
19889 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
19890 .cindex "EACCES"
19891 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19892 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
19893 file did not exist.
19894
19895
19896 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
19897 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
19898 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
19899 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
19900 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
19901
19902 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
19903 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
19904 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
19905 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
19906 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
19907 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
19908 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
19909 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
19910
19911
19912
19913 .option include_directory redirect string unset
19914 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
19915 redirection list must start with this directory.
19916
19917
19918 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
19919 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
19920 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
19921
19922
19923 .option one_time redirect boolean false
19924 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
19925 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
19926 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
19927 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
19928 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
19929 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
19930 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
19931 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
19932 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
19933 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
19934 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
19935 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
19936 before they subscribed.
19937
19938 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
19939 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
19940 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
19941 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
19942 attempt.
19943
19944 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
19945 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
19946 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
19947 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
19948
19949 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
19950 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
19951 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
19952
19953 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
19954 &%one_time%&.
19955
19956 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
19957 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
19958 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
19959 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
19960 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
19961 expansion.
19962
19963
19964 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
19965 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
19966 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
19967 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
19968 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
19969 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
19970 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
19971 See &%check_owner%& above.
19972
19973
19974 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
19975 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
19976 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
19977 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
19978
19979
19980 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
19981 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
19982 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
19983 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
19984 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
19985 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
19986 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
19987
19988
19989 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
19990 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
19991 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
19992 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
19993 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
19994 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
19995 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
19996 &$qualify_recipient$&.
19997
19998 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
19999 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20000 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20001 addresses.
20002
20003 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20004 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20005 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20006 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20007 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20008 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20009 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20010 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20011 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20012 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20013
20014
20015 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20016 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20017 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20018 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20019 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20020 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20021
20022
20023 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20024 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20025 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20026 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20027 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20028 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20029
20030
20031 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20032 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20033 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20034 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20035 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20036
20037
20038 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20039 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20040 :subaddress part of an address.
20041
20042 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20043 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20044 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20045 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20046
20047
20048 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20049 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20050 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20051 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20052 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20053 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20054 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20055
20056
20057
20058 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20059 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20060 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20061 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20062 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20063 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20064 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20065 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20066 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20067 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20068 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20069 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20070 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20071 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20072 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20073 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20074
20075 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20076 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20077 the following routers.
20078
20079 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20080 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20081 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20082 so it is passed to the following routers.
20083
20084 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20085 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20086 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20087 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20088
20089 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20090 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20091 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20092 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20093 .code
20094 userforward:
20095 driver = redirect
20096 allow_filter
20097 check_local_user
20098 file = $home/.forward
20099 file_transport = address_file
20100 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20101 reply_transport = address_reply
20102 no_verify
20103 skip_syntax_errors
20104 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20105 syntax_errors_text = \
20106 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20107 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20108 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20109 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20110 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20111 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20112 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20113 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20114 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20115 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20116 .endd
20117 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20118 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20119 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20120 .code
20121 real_localuser:
20122 driver = accept
20123 check_local_user
20124 local_part_prefix = real-
20125 transport = local_delivery
20126 .endd
20127 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20128 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20129 .code
20130 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20131 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20132 .endd
20133
20134
20135 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20136 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20137
20138
20139 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
20140 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20141 .ecindex IIDredrou1
20142 .ecindex IIDredrou2
20143
20144
20145
20146
20147
20148
20149 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20150 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20151
20152 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
20153 "Environment for local transports"
20154 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
20155 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
20156 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
20157 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
20158 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
20159 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
20160 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
20161
20162 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
20163 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
20164 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
20165 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
20166
20167 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
20168 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
20169 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
20170 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
20171 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
20172
20173
20174
20175 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
20176 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
20177 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
20178 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
20179 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
20180 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
20181 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
20182 time.
20183
20184 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
20185 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
20186 .code
20187 my_transport:
20188 driver = pipe
20189 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
20190 .endd
20191 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
20192 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
20193 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
20194 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
20195
20196
20197
20198
20199 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
20200 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20201 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
20202 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
20203 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
20204 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
20205 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
20206 group (set by the transport). For example:
20207 .code
20208 # Routers ...
20209 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
20210 local_users:
20211 driver = accept
20212 check_local_user
20213 transport = group_delivery
20214
20215 # Transports ...
20216 # This transport overrides the group
20217 group_delivery:
20218 driver = appendfile
20219 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
20220 group = mail
20221 .endd
20222 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
20223 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
20224 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
20225 set.
20226
20227 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
20228 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
20229 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
20230 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
20231 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
20232 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
20233
20234 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
20235 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
20236 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
20237 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
20238 original gid is also used.
20239
20240 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
20241 following that is set is used:
20242
20243 .ilist
20244 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
20245 .next
20246 A &%group%& setting of the router;
20247 .next
20248 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
20249 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
20250 .next
20251 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
20252 .next
20253 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
20254 the uid is the creator's uid;
20255 .next
20256 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
20257 .endlist
20258
20259 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
20260 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
20261 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
20262 The first of the following that is set is used:
20263
20264 .ilist
20265 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
20266 .next
20267 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
20268 .next
20269 A &%user%& setting of the router;
20270 .next
20271 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
20272 .next
20273 The Exim uid.
20274 .endlist
20275
20276 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
20277 &%never_users%& list.
20278
20279
20280
20281
20282
20283 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
20284 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20285 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20286 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
20287 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
20288 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
20289 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
20290 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
20291 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
20292 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20293
20294 .ilist
20295 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20296 .next
20297 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20298 .next
20299 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20300 .next
20301 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20302 .endlist
20303
20304 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
20305
20306 .ilist
20307 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
20308 .next
20309 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
20310 .endlist
20311
20312
20313 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
20314 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
20315 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
20316
20317
20318
20319 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
20320 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20321 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20322 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
20323 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
20324 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
20325 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
20326 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
20327 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
20328 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
20329 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
20330 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
20331 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
20332 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
20333
20334
20335
20336
20337
20338
20339
20340 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20341 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20342
20343 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
20344 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
20345 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
20346 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
20347 The following generic options apply to all transports:
20348
20349
20350 .option body_only transports boolean false
20351 .cindex "transport" "body only"
20352 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
20353 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
20354 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
20355 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
20356 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
20357 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
20358 automatically suppress them.
20359
20360
20361 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
20362 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
20363 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
20364 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
20365 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20366 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20367
20368
20369 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
20370 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
20371 deliveries by the transport or for any
20372 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
20373 what you are doing.
20374
20375
20376 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
20377 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
20378 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
20379 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
20380 transport is run.
20381 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
20382 output, and Exim carries on processing.
20383 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
20384 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
20385 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
20386 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
20387 one.
20388 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
20389 transport and the router that called it.
20390
20391 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
20392 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
20393 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
20394 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
20395 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
20396 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
20397 safely be resent to other recipients.
20398
20399
20400 .option driver transports string unset
20401 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
20402 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
20403
20404
20405 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
20406 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20407 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
20408 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
20409 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
20410 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
20411 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
20412 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
20413 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
20414 resent to other recipients.
20415
20416
20417 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
20418 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
20419 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
20420 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
20421 &%user%& (see below).
20422
20423
20424 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
20425 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
20426 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
20427 This option specifies a list of text headers,
20428 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
20429 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
20430 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
20431 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
20432 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20433 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20434 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20435
20436 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
20437 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
20438
20439
20440 .option headers_only transports boolean false
20441 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
20442 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
20443 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
20444 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
20445 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
20446 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
20447 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
20448
20449
20450 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
20451 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
20452 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
20453 This option specifies a list of header names,
20454 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
20455 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
20456 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
20457 routers.
20458 Each list item is separately expanded.
20459 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
20460 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
20461 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
20462
20463 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
20464 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
20465
20466 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
20467 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
20468 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
20469
20470
20471
20472 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
20473 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
20474 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
20475 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
20476 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
20477 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
20478 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
20479 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
20480 example,
20481 .code
20482 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
20483 x@y w@z
20484 .endd
20485 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
20486 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
20487 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
20488 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
20489 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
20490 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
20491 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
20492 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
20493 change envelope recipients at this time.
20494
20495
20496 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
20497 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
20498 .vindex "&$home$&"
20499 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
20500 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
20501 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
20502 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
20503 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
20504 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
20505 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
20506 deferred.
20507
20508
20509 .option initgroups transports boolean false
20510 .cindex "additional groups"
20511 .cindex "groups" "additional"
20512 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
20513 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
20514 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
20515 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
20516
20517
20518 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
20519 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
20520 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
20521 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
20522 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
20523 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
20524 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
20525 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
20526 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
20527 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
20528 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
20529 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
20530 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
20531 delivered.
20532
20533
20534
20535 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
20536 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
20537 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
20538 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
20539 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
20540 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
20541 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
20542 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
20543 that contains
20544 .code
20545 local_part_prefix = *-
20546 .endd
20547 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
20548 is delivered with
20549 .code
20550 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
20551 .endd
20552 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
20553 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
20554 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
20555 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
20556 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
20557
20558
20559 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
20560 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20561 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
20562 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
20563 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
20564 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
20565 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
20566 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
20567 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
20568
20569 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
20570 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
20571 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
20572 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
20573
20574 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
20575 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
20576 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
20577
20578
20579 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
20580 .cindex "envelope sender"
20581 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
20582 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
20583 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
20584 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
20585 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
20586 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
20587 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
20588 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
20589 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
20590
20591 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
20592 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
20593
20594 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
20595 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
20596 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
20597 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
20598 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
20599 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
20600 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
20601
20602 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
20603 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
20604 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
20605 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
20606 &%errors_to%& in a router.
20607
20608
20609
20610 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
20611 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
20612 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
20613 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
20614 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
20615 have easy access to it.
20616
20617 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
20618 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
20619 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
20620 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
20621 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
20622 recipients.
20623
20624
20625 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
20626 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
20627
20628
20629 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
20630 .cindex "shadow transport"
20631 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
20632 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
20633 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
20634
20635 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
20636 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
20637 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
20638 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
20639 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
20640 cause a log line to be written.
20641
20642 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
20643 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
20644 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
20645 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
20646 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
20647 of the form
20648 .code
20649 ST=<shadow transport name>
20650 .endd
20651 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
20652 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
20653 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
20654 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
20655 headers that some sites insist on.
20656
20657
20658 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
20659 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20660 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20661 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
20662 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
20663 individual users or via a system filter.
20664
20665 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
20666 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
20667 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
20668 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
20669 command must be specified as an absolute path.
20670
20671 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
20672 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
20673 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
20674 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
20675 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
20676 &(pipe)& transports.
20677
20678 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
20679 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
20680 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
20681 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
20682 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
20683
20684 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
20685 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
20686 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
20687 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
20688
20689 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
20690 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
20691 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
20692 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
20693 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
20694 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
20695
20696 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
20697 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
20698 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
20699 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
20700 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
20701 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
20702 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
20703 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
20704
20705 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20706 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
20707 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
20708 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
20709 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
20710 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
20711 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
20712 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
20713 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
20714 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
20715
20716 .vindex "&$host$&"
20717 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20718 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
20719 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
20720 which the message is being sent. For example:
20721 .code
20722 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
20723 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
20724 .endd
20725
20726 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
20727 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
20728 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
20729 .ilist
20730 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
20731 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
20732 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
20733 example:
20734 .code
20735 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
20736 .endd
20737 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
20738 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
20739 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
20740 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
20741 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
20742 Exim tried to expand the first one.
20743 .next
20744 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
20745 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
20746 arguments. Consider this example:
20747 .code
20748 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20749 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20750 .endd
20751 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
20752 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
20753 .code
20754 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
20755 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
20756 .endd
20757 .endlist
20758
20759 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
20760 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
20761 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
20762 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
20763 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
20764 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
20765 bounced from a transport filter.
20766
20767 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
20768 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
20769 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
20770
20771
20772 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
20773 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
20774 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
20775 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
20776 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
20777 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
20778 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
20779 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
20780 becomes a temporary error.
20781
20782
20783 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
20784 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20785 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
20786 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
20787 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
20788 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
20789 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
20790 option is not set.
20791
20792 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
20793 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
20794 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
20795
20796 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
20797 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
20798 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
20799 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
20800 retry data.
20801 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
20802 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
20803 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
20804
20805
20806
20807
20808
20809
20810 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20811 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20812
20813 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
20814 "Address batching"
20815 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
20816 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
20817 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
20818 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
20819 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
20820 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
20821 copy of the message is delivered each time.
20822
20823 .cindex "batched local delivery"
20824 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
20825 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
20826 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
20827 local transport, for example:
20828
20829 .ilist
20830 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
20831 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
20832 recipients saves space.
20833 .next
20834 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
20835 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
20836 .next
20837 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
20838 to a scanner program or
20839 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
20840 acceptable.
20841 .endlist
20842
20843 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
20844 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
20845 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
20846
20847 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
20848 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
20849 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
20850 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
20851 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
20852 to certain conditions:
20853
20854 .ilist
20855 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20856 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
20857 batching is possible.
20858 .next
20859 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20860 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
20861 addresses with the same domain are batched.
20862 .next
20863 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
20864 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
20865 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
20866 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
20867 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
20868 from taking place.
20869 .next
20870 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
20871 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
20872 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
20873 be the same.
20874 .endlist
20875
20876 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
20877 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
20878 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
20879 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
20880 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
20881 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
20882 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
20883 .code
20884 check_string = "."
20885 escape_string = ".."
20886 .endd
20887 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
20888 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
20889 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
20890
20891 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
20892 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
20893 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
20894 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
20895 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
20896 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
20897
20898 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
20899 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20900 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
20901 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
20902 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
20903 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
20904 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
20905 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
20906 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
20907
20908
20909
20910
20911 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20912 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20913
20914 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
20915 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
20916 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
20917 .cindex "directory creation"
20918 .cindex "creating directories"
20919 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
20920 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
20921 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
20922 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
20923 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
20924 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
20925 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
20926 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
20927 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
20928 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
20929
20930 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
20931 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
20932 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
20933 included.
20934
20935 .cindex "quota" "system"
20936 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
20937 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
20938 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
20939
20940 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
20941 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
20942 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
20943 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
20944
20945 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
20946 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
20947 private options.
20948
20949 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
20950 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
20951 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
20952 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
20953 option).
20954
20955
20956
20957 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
20958 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
20959 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
20960 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
20961 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
20962
20963 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20964 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20965 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
20966 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
20967 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
20968 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
20969 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
20970 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
20971 operation. There are two cases:
20972
20973 .ilist
20974 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
20975 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
20976 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
20977 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
20978 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
20979 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
20980 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
20981 .next
20982 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
20983 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
20984 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
20985 .endlist
20986
20987
20988 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
20989 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
20990 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
20991 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
20992 form:
20993 .code
20994 save folder23
20995 .endd
20996 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
20997 .code
20998 require "fileinto";
20999 fileinto "folder23";
21000 .endd
21001 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21002 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21003 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21004 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21005 way of handling this requirement:
21006 .code
21007 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21008 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21009 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21010 {$address_file} \
21011 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21012 }} \
21013 }
21014 .endd
21015 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21016 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21017 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21018
21019 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21020 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21021 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21022 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21023 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21024 path to the transport.
21025
21026 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21027 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21028
21029
21030
21031
21032 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21033 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21034
21035
21036
21037 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21038 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21039 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21040 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21041 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21042 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21043 delivery is deferred.
21044
21045
21046 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21047 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21048 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21049 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21050 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21051 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21052 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21053 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21054
21055
21056 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21057 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21058 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21059 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21060 file.
21061
21062
21063 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21064 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21065
21066
21067 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
21068 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21069 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21070 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21071 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21072
21073
21074 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21075 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21076 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21077 process is running.
21078
21079
21080 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21081 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21082 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21083 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21084 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21085 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21086 contains is significant.
21087
21088 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21089 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21090 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21091 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21092 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21093
21094 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21095 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21096 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21097 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21098 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21099 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21100 .code
21101 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21102 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21103 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21104 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21105 .endd
21106 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21107 .cindex "directory creation"
21108 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
21109 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
21110 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
21111
21112 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
21113 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
21114 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
21115 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
21116 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
21117
21118
21119
21120 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
21121 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
21122 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
21123 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
21124 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
21125 beneath.
21126
21127 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
21128 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
21129 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
21130 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
21131 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
21132 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
21133 &%file_must_exist%&.
21134
21135
21136 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
21137 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
21138 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
21139 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
21140
21141 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
21142 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
21143 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
21144 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
21145 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
21146
21147
21148 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
21149 .cindex "base62"
21150 .vindex "&$inode$&"
21151 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
21152 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
21153 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
21154 .code
21155 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
21156 .endd
21157 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
21158 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
21159 option.
21160
21161
21162 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
21163 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
21164 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
21165
21166
21167 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
21168 See &%check_string%& above.
21169
21170
21171 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
21172 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
21173 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
21174 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
21175 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
21176 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
21177 &%file%&.
21178
21179 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21180 .cindex "locking files"
21181 .cindex "lock files"
21182 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
21183 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
21184
21185 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
21186 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
21187 examples:
21188 .code
21189 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21190 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
21191 file = $home/inbox
21192 .endd
21193 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
21194 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
21195 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
21196 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
21197 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
21198 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
21199
21200
21201
21202 .option file_format appendfile string unset
21203 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
21204 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
21205 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
21206 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
21207 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
21208 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
21209 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
21210 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
21211 this added to it:
21212 .code
21213 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
21214 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
21215 .endd
21216 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
21217 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
21218 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
21219 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
21220 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
21221 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
21222 delivery is deferred.
21223
21224
21225 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
21226 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
21227 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
21228 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
21229
21230
21231 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
21232 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21233 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
21234 .cindex "locking files"
21235 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
21236 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
21237 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
21238 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
21239 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
21240 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
21241 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
21242 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
21243
21244 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
21245 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
21246 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
21247 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
21248
21249 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
21250 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
21251 retries is
21252 .code
21253 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
21254 .endd
21255 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
21256 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
21257 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
21258
21259 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
21260 local deliveries because of errors of the form
21261 .code
21262 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
21263 .endd
21264
21265 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
21266 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
21267 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
21268 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
21269
21270
21271 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
21272 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
21273 for details of locking.
21274
21275
21276 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
21277 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
21278 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
21279
21280
21281 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21282 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
21283 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
21284
21285
21286 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
21287 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
21288 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
21289 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
21290 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
21291
21292
21293 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
21294 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21295 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21296 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21297 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
21298 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
21299 external source that maintains the data.
21300
21301
21302 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
21303 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
21304 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21305 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
21306 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
21307 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
21308 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
21309 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
21310
21311
21312
21313 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
21314 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
21315 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
21316 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
21317 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
21318 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
21319 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
21320 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
21321 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
21322 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21323
21324
21325 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
21326 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
21327 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
21328 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
21329 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
21330 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
21331 calculation. The default value is:
21332 .code
21333 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
21334 .endd
21335 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
21336 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
21337 &_Trash_&
21338 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
21339 .code
21340 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
21341 .endd
21342 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
21343 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
21344 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
21345 directly into that directory.
21346
21347
21348 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
21349 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
21350 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21351
21352
21353 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
21354 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
21355 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
21356
21357
21358 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
21359 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
21360 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
21361 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
21362 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
21363 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
21364 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
21365 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
21366
21367 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
21368 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
21369 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
21370 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
21371 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
21372 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
21373 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
21374 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
21375 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
21376 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
21377
21378
21379 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
21380 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
21381 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
21382 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
21383 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
21384 below for further details.
21385
21386
21387 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
21388 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21389 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21390
21391
21392 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
21393 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
21394 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
21395
21396
21397 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
21398 .cindex "locking files"
21399 .cindex "file" "locking"
21400 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
21401 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
21402 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21403 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
21404 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
21405 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
21406 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
21407
21408 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
21409 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
21410 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
21411 combination:
21412 .code
21413 mbx_format = true
21414 message_prefix =
21415 message_suffix =
21416 .endd
21417 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
21418 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
21419 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
21420 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
21421 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
21422 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
21423 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
21424 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
21425
21426 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
21427 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
21428 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
21429 append messages to it.
21430
21431
21432 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21433 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21434 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21435 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21436 in which case it is:
21437 .code
21438 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
21439 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
21440 .endd
21441 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21442 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21443
21444 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
21445 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21446 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
21447 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
21448 setting
21449 .code
21450 message_suffix =
21451 .endd
21452 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21453 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21454
21455 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
21456 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
21457 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
21458 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
21459 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
21460 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
21461 value, and this option is ignored.
21462
21463
21464 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
21465 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
21466 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
21467 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
21468 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
21469
21470
21471 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
21472 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
21473 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
21474 on users about incoming mail.
21475
21476
21477 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
21478 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
21479 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
21480 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
21481 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
21482 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
21483 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
21484 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
21485 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
21486
21487 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
21488 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
21489 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
21490
21491 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
21492 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
21493 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
21494 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
21495 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
21496 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
21497
21498 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
21499 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
21500 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
21501 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
21502 be handled.
21503
21504 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
21505
21506 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
21507 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
21508 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
21509 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
21510 system quota failures.
21511
21512 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
21513 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
21514 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
21515 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
21516 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
21517 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
21518 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
21519 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
21520 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
21521 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
21522
21523
21524 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
21525 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
21526 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
21527 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
21528 delivery directory.
21529
21530
21531 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
21532 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
21533 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
21534 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
21535 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
21536 &"no quota"&.
21537
21538
21539 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
21540 See &%quota%& above.
21541
21542
21543 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
21544 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
21545 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
21546 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
21547 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
21548 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
21549 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
21550
21551 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
21552 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
21553 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
21554 the file length to the file name. For example:
21555 .code
21556 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
21557 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
21558 .endd
21559 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
21560 number of lines in the message.
21561
21562 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
21563 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
21564 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
21565
21566 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
21567
21568
21569 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
21570 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
21571 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
21572 .code
21573 quota_warn_message = "\
21574 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
21575 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
21576 This message is automatically created \
21577 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
21578 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
21579 a warning threshold that is\n\
21580 set by the system administrator.\n"
21581 .endd
21582
21583
21584 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
21585 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
21586 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
21587 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
21588 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
21589 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
21590 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
21591 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
21592 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
21593 sign. For example:
21594 .code
21595 quota = 10M
21596 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
21597 .endd
21598 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
21599 percent sign is ignored.
21600
21601 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
21602 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
21603 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
21604 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
21605 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
21606 &'From:'& line, the default is:
21607 .code
21608 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
21609 .endd
21610 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
21611 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
21612 option.
21613
21614 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
21615 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
21616 percentage.
21617
21618
21619 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
21620 .cindex "envelope sender"
21621 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
21622 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
21623 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
21624 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
21625 for details of batch SMTP.
21626
21627
21628 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
21629 .cindex "carriage return"
21630 .cindex "linefeed"
21631 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21632 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21633 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
21634 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21635
21636 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
21637 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
21638 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
21639 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
21640 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
21641 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21642
21643
21644 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21645 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
21646 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
21647 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
21648 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21649 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
21650
21651
21652 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
21653 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
21654 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
21655 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
21656 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
21657
21658 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
21659 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
21660 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
21661 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
21662
21663 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
21664 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
21665 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
21666 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
21667 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
21668 error.
21669
21670 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
21671 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
21672
21673
21674 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
21675 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
21676 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
21677 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
21678 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
21679 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
21680 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
21681
21682 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21683 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
21684 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
21685 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
21686 file corruption.
21687
21688 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
21689 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
21690 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
21691
21692
21693 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
21694 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
21695 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
21696 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
21697 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
21698 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
21699 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
21700 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
21701 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
21702
21703 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
21704 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
21705 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
21706 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
21707
21708
21709
21710
21711 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
21712 .cindex "appending to a file"
21713 .cindex "file" "appending"
21714 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
21715
21716 .ilist
21717 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
21718 return is given.
21719
21720 .next
21721 .cindex "directory creation"
21722 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
21723 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
21724 &%directory_mode%& option.
21725
21726 .next
21727 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
21728 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
21729 transport.
21730
21731 .next
21732 .cindex "file" "locking"
21733 .cindex "locking files"
21734 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
21735 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
21736 reliably over NFS, as follows:
21737
21738 .olist
21739 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
21740 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
21741 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
21742 .next
21743 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
21744 .next
21745 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
21746 Unlink the hitching post name.
21747 .next
21748 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
21749 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
21750 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
21751 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
21752 .next
21753 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
21754 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
21755 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
21756 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
21757 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
21758 it before trying again.
21759 .endlist olist
21760
21761 .next
21762 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
21763 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
21764 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
21765
21766 .next
21767 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21768 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21769 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
21770 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
21771 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
21772 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
21773 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
21774 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
21775 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
21776 checked.
21777
21778 .next
21779 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
21780 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
21781 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
21782 delivery is deferred.
21783
21784 .next
21785 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
21786 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
21787 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
21788 permissions.
21789
21790 .next
21791 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
21792 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
21793 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
21794
21795 .next
21796 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
21797 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
21798 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
21799
21800 .next
21801 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
21802 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
21803 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
21804 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
21805 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
21806 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
21807 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
21808 that prevents link following.
21809
21810 .next
21811 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
21812 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
21813 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
21814 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
21815 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
21816
21817 .next
21818 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
21819
21820 .next
21821 .cindex "file" "locking"
21822 .cindex "locking files"
21823 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
21824 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
21825 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
21826 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
21827 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
21828 .code
21829 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
21830 .endd
21831 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
21832 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
21833 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
21834
21835 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
21836 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
21837 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
21838
21839 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
21840 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
21841 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
21842 delivery is deferred.
21843
21844 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
21845 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
21846 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
21847 immediately. It retries up to
21848 .code
21849 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
21850 .endd
21851 times (rounded up).
21852 .endlist
21853
21854 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
21855 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
21856
21857
21858 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
21859 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
21860 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21861 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
21862 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
21863 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
21864 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
21865 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
21866 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
21867 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
21868
21869 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
21870 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
21871 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
21872 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
21873 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
21874 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
21875 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
21876
21877 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
21878 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
21879 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
21880 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
21881
21882
21883 .cindex "maildir format"
21884 .cindex "mailstore format"
21885 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
21886 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
21887 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
21888 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
21889 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
21890
21891 .cindex "directory creation"
21892 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
21893 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
21894 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
21895 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
21896 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
21897 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
21898 deferred.
21899
21900
21901
21902 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
21903 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
21904 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
21905 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
21906 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
21907 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
21908 &_new_& subdirectory.
21909
21910 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
21911 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
21912 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
21913 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
21914 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
21915 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
21916 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
21917
21918 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
21919 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
21920 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
21921 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
21922 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
21923 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
21924 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
21925 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
21926
21927 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
21928 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
21929 folders. Consider this example:
21930 .code
21931 maildir_format = true
21932 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
21933 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
21934 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
21935 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
21936 .endd
21937 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
21938 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
21939 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
21940 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
21941 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
21942 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
21943
21944 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
21945 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
21946 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
21947 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
21948 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
21949
21950 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
21951 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
21952 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
21953
21954 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
21955 .cindex "maildir++"
21956 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
21957 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
21958 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
21959 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
21960 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
21961 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
21962 amount of space used.
21963
21964 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
21965 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
21966 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
21967 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
21968 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
21969 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
21970
21971
21972
21973
21974 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
21975 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
21976 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
21977 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
21978 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
21979 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
21980
21981
21982 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
21983 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
21984 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
21985 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
21986 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
21987 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
21988 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
21989 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
21990 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
21991 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
21992 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
21993 backwards compatibility).
21994
21995 For one common implementation, you might set:
21996 .code
21997 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
21998 .endd
21999 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22000
22001 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22002 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22003 &[stat()]& each message file.
22004
22005
22006 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22007 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22008 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22009 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22010 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22011 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22012 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22013 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22014 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22015
22016 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22017 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22018 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22019 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22020 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22021 need to know the quota.
22022
22023 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22024 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22025
22026 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22027 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22028 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22029 details.
22030
22031
22032 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22033 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22034 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22035 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22036 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22037 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22038 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22039 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22040
22041 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22042 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22043 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22044 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22045 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22046 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22047
22048 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22049 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22050 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22051 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22052 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22053 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22054
22055 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22056 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22057 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22058 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22059
22060
22061 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22062 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22063 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22064 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22065 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22066 .code
22067 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22068 .endd
22069 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22070 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22071 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22072 .ecindex IIDapptra1
22073 .ecindex IIDapptra2
22074
22075
22076
22077
22078
22079
22080 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22081 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22082
22083 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22084 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22085 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22086 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22087 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22088 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22089 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22090 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22091
22092 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22093 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22094 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22095 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22096 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22097
22098
22099 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22100 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22101 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
22102 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
22103 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
22104
22105 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
22106 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
22107 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
22108 transport is run as a consequence of a
22109 &%mail%&
22110 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
22111 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
22112 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
22113 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
22114 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
22115 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
22116
22117 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
22118 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
22119 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
22120 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
22121
22122 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
22123 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
22124 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
22125 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
22126 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
22127 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
22128 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
22129
22130 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
22131 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
22132 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
22133 the transport defers.
22134 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
22135 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
22136
22137 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
22138 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
22139 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
22140 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
22141
22142 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22143 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
22144 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
22145 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
22146 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
22147 problems. They are just discarded.
22148
22149
22150
22151 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
22152 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
22153
22154 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
22155 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
22156 message when the message is specified by the transport.
22157
22158
22159 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
22160 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
22161 when the message is specified by the transport.
22162
22163
22164 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
22165 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
22166 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
22167 string comes first.
22168
22169
22170 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
22171 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
22172 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
22173
22174
22175 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
22176 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
22177 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
22178
22179
22180 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
22181 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
22182 specified by the transport.
22183
22184
22185 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
22186 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
22187 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
22188 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
22189
22190
22191 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
22192 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
22193 the message is specified by the transport.
22194
22195
22196 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
22197 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
22198 used.
22199
22200
22201 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
22202 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
22203 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
22204 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
22205 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
22206
22207
22208
22209 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
22210 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
22211 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
22212 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
22213
22214 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
22215 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
22216 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
22217 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
22218 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
22219 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
22220 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
22221 infinity.
22222
22223 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
22224 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
22225 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
22226 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
22227 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
22228
22229 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
22230 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
22231 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
22232 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
22233 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
22234 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
22235
22236
22237 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
22238 See &%once%& above.
22239
22240
22241 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
22242 See &%once%& above.
22243 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
22244
22245
22246 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
22247 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
22248 specified by the transport.
22249
22250
22251 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
22252 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
22253 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
22254 configuration option.
22255
22256
22257 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
22258 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
22259 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
22260 automatic responses. For example:
22261 .code
22262 subject = Re: $h_subject:
22263 .endd
22264 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
22265 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
22266 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
22267 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
22268 small.
22269
22270
22271
22272 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
22273 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
22274 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
22275 the text comes first.
22276
22277
22278 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
22279 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
22280 when the message is specified by the transport.
22281 .ecindex IIDauttra1
22282 .ecindex IIDauttra2
22283
22284
22285
22286
22287 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22288 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22289
22290 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
22291 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
22292 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
22293 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
22294 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
22295 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
22296 specified command
22297 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
22298 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
22299 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
22300 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
22301 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
22302 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
22303 .code
22304 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
22305 .endd
22306 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
22307 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
22308 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
22309 as follows:
22310
22311 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
22312 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22313
22314
22315 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
22316 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22317 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
22318 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
22319 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22320
22321
22322 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
22323 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
22324 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
22325 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
22326 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
22327 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
22328 LMTP protocol.
22329
22330 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
22331 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
22332 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
22333 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
22334 in its response to the LHLO command.
22335
22336 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
22337 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
22338 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
22339 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
22340
22341
22342 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
22343 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
22344 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
22345 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
22346 LMTP transport:
22347 .code
22348 lmtp:
22349 driver = lmtp
22350 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
22351 batch_max = 20
22352 user = exim
22353 .endd
22354 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
22355 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
22356
22357
22358
22359 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22360 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22361
22362 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
22363 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
22364 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
22365 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
22366 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
22367 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
22368 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
22369 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
22370 following ways:
22371
22372 .ilist
22373 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22374 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
22375 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
22376 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
22377 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
22378 .next
22379 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22380 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
22381 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
22382 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
22383 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
22384 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
22385 that are routed to the transport.
22386 .next
22387 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22388 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
22389 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
22390 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
22391 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
22392 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
22393 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
22394 .endlist
22395
22396
22397 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
22398 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
22399 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
22400
22401 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
22402 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
22403 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
22404 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
22405 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
22406 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
22407 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
22408
22409
22410 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
22411 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
22412 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
22413 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
22414 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
22415
22416
22417
22418
22419 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
22420 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
22421 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
22422 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
22423 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
22424 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
22425 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
22426 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
22427 &"local delivery failed"&.
22428
22429 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
22430 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
22431 will be sent as normal.
22432
22433 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
22434 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
22435 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
22436 apply in this case.
22437
22438 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
22439 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
22440 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
22441 a non-existent command may be the problem.
22442
22443 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
22444 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
22445 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
22446 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
22447 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
22448 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
22449 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
22450 &%temp_errors%&.
22451
22452
22453
22454 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
22455 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
22456 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
22457 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
22458 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
22459 run.
22460
22461 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
22462 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
22463 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
22464 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
22465
22466 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
22467 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
22468 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
22469 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
22470 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
22471 .code
22472 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
22473 .endd
22474 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
22475 arguments. You have to write
22476 .code
22477 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
22478 .endd
22479 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
22480 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
22481 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
22482 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
22483 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
22484 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
22485 example:
22486 .code
22487 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
22488 .endd
22489
22490 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22491 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22492 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22493 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
22494 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
22495 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
22496 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
22497 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
22498 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
22499 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
22500
22501 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
22502 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
22503 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
22504 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
22505 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
22506 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
22507 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
22508 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
22509
22510 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
22511 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
22512 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
22513 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
22514 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
22515 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
22516 control what is done with it.
22517
22518 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
22519 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
22520 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
22521 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
22522 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
22523 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
22524 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
22525 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
22526 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
22527 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
22528 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
22529
22530
22531
22532 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
22533 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22534 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
22535 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
22536 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
22537 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
22538 environment.
22539 .display
22540 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
22541 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
22542 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
22543 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
22544 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
22545 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
22546 &`LOGNAME `& see below
22547 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
22548 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
22549 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
22550 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
22551 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
22552 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
22553 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
22554 &`USER `& see below
22555 .endd
22556 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
22557 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
22558 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
22559 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
22560 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
22561 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
22562 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
22563
22564 .cindex "HOST"
22565 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
22566 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
22567 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
22568 the router.
22569
22570 .cindex "HOME"
22571 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
22572 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
22573 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
22574 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
22575
22576
22577 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
22578 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
22579
22580
22581
22582 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
22583 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
22584 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22585 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
22586 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
22587 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
22588 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
22589 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
22590 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
22591 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
22592 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
22593 example, if
22594 .code
22595 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
22596 .endd
22597 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
22598 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
22599 &%use_shell%& is set.
22600
22601
22602 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
22603 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22604
22605
22606 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
22607 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
22608 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22609
22610
22611 .option check_string pipe string unset
22612 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
22613 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
22614 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
22615 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
22616 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
22617 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
22618 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
22619 ignored.
22620
22621
22622 .option command pipe string&!! unset
22623 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
22624 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
22625 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
22626 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
22627 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
22628 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
22629
22630
22631 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
22632 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
22633 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
22634 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
22635 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
22636 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
22637 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
22638
22639
22640 .option escape_string pipe string unset
22641 See &%check_string%& above.
22642
22643
22644 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
22645 .cindex "exec failure"
22646 .cindex "failure of exec"
22647 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
22648 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
22649 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
22650 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
22651 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
22652
22653
22654 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
22655 .cindex "signal exit"
22656 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
22657 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
22658 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
22659 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
22660
22661
22662 .option force_command pipe boolean false
22663 .cindex "force command"
22664 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
22665 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
22666 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
22667 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
22668 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
22669 command. For example:
22670 .code
22671 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
22672 force_command
22673 .endd
22674
22675 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
22676 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
22677 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
22678
22679 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
22680 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
22681 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
22682 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
22683 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
22684 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
22685
22686 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
22687 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
22688
22689 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
22690 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
22691 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
22692 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
22693 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
22694
22695
22696 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
22697 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
22698 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
22699 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
22700 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
22701 Only one of them may be set.
22702
22703
22704
22705 .option log_output pipe boolean false
22706 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
22707 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
22708 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22709
22710
22711
22712 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
22713 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
22714 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
22715 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
22716 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
22717 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
22718 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
22719 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
22720
22721
22722 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
22723 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22724 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
22725 .code
22726 message_prefix = \
22727 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
22728 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
22729 .endd
22730 .cindex "Cyrus"
22731 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
22732 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22733 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
22734 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
22735 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
22736 setting
22737 .code
22738 message_prefix =
22739 .endd
22740 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22741 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22742
22743
22744 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
22745 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22746 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
22747 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
22748 .code
22749 message_suffix =
22750 .endd
22751 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22752 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22753
22754
22755 .option path pipe string "see below"
22756 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
22757 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
22758 .code
22759 /bin:/usr/bin
22760 .endd
22761 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
22762 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
22763 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
22764
22765
22766 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
22767 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
22768 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
22769 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
22770 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
22771 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
22772 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
22773 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
22774 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
22775
22776
22777 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
22778 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22779 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
22780 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
22781 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
22782 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
22783 accept the message is used.
22784
22785
22786 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
22787 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
22788 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
22789 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
22790 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
22791 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
22792
22793
22794 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
22795 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
22796 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
22797 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
22798 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
22799 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
22800 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
22801
22802
22803
22804 .option return_output pipe boolean false
22805 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
22806 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
22807 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
22808 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
22809 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
22810 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
22811 of them may be set.
22812
22813
22814
22815 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
22816 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
22817 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
22818 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
22819 and &%return_output%& is not set,
22820 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
22821 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
22822 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
22823 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
22824 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
22825 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
22826 and 73, respectively.
22827
22828
22829 .option timeout pipe time 1h
22830 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
22831 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
22832 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
22833 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
22834 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
22835 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
22836
22837 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
22838 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
22839 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
22840 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
22841 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
22842 delivery to be deferred.
22843
22844 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
22845 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
22846
22847
22848 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
22849 .cindex "envelope sender"
22850 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
22851 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
22852 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
22853 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
22854 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
22855
22856 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
22857 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
22858 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
22859 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
22860 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
22861 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
22862 class database.
22863
22864
22865 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
22866 .cindex "carriage return"
22867 .cindex "linefeed"
22868 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22869 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22870 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
22871 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22872
22873 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
22874 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
22875 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
22876 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
22877 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22878
22879
22880 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
22881 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22882 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
22883 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
22884 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
22885 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
22886 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
22887 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
22888 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
22889 its &%-c%& option.
22890
22891
22892
22893 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
22894 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
22895 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
22896 .cindex "external local delivery"
22897 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
22898 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
22899 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
22900 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
22901 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
22902 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
22903 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
22904 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
22905 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
22906 configuration for &%procmail%&:
22907 .code
22908 # transport
22909 procmail_pipe:
22910 driver = pipe
22911 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
22912 return_path_add
22913 delivery_date_add
22914 envelope_to_add
22915 check_string = "From "
22916 escape_string = ">From "
22917 umask = 077
22918 user = $local_part
22919 group = mail
22920
22921 # router
22922 procmail:
22923 driver = accept
22924 check_local_user
22925 transport = procmail_pipe
22926 .endd
22927 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
22928 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
22929 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
22930 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
22931 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
22932 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
22933
22934 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
22935 .code
22936 IFS=" "
22937 .endd
22938 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
22939 use a shell to run pipe commands.
22940
22941 .cindex "Cyrus"
22942 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
22943 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
22944 .code
22945 # transport
22946 local_delivery_cyrus:
22947 driver = pipe
22948 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
22949 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
22950 user = cyrus
22951 group = mail
22952 return_output
22953 log_output
22954 message_prefix =
22955 message_suffix =
22956
22957 # router
22958 local_user_cyrus:
22959 driver = accept
22960 check_local_user
22961 local_part_suffix = .*
22962 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
22963 .endd
22964 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
22965 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
22966 sender.
22967 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
22968 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
22969
22970
22971 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22972 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22973
22974 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
22975 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
22976 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
22977 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
22978 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
22979 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
22980 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
22981 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
22982
22983
22984 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
22985 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
22986 two ways:
22987
22988 .ilist
22989 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
22990 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
22991 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
22992 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
22993 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
22994 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
22995 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
22996 .next
22997 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
22998 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
22999 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23000 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23001 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23002 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23003 process.
23004 .endlist
23005
23006
23007 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23008 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23009 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23010
23011
23012
23013 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23014 .vindex "&$host$&"
23015 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23016 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23017 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23018 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23019 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23020 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23021 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23022 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23023
23024
23025 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23026 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23027 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23028 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23029 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23030 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23031 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23032 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23033 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23034 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23035 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23036 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23037 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23038 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23039
23040 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23041 and will be removed in a future release.
23042
23043
23044 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23045 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23046 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23047
23048
23049 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23050 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23051 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23052 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23053 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23054 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23055 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23056 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23057
23058 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23059 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
23060 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23061 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23062 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23063 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23064 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23065 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23066 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23067
23068
23069 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23070 .cindex "Cyrus"
23071 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23072 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23073 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23074 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23075 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23076 ignored.
23077
23078 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23079 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23080 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23081 particular connection.
23082
23083 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23084 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23085 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23086 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23087
23088 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23089 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23090 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23091 .code
23092 authenticated_sender = $local_part
23093 .endd
23094 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23095 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23096
23097 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
23098 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
23099 value.
23100
23101
23102 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
23103 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
23104 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
23105 authenticated as a client.
23106
23107
23108 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
23109 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
23110 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
23111 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
23112
23113
23114 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
23115 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
23116 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
23117 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
23118 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
23119 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
23120 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
23121
23122
23123 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
23124 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
23125 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
23126 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23127 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
23128 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
23129 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
23130 option.
23131
23132
23133 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
23134 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
23135 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
23136 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
23137
23138
23139 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
23140 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
23141 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
23142 cutoff times.
23143
23144 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
23145 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
23146 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
23147 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
23148 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
23149 unhappy at this prospect, so...
23150
23151 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
23152 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
23153 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
23154 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
23155 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
23156 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
23157 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
23158 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
23159 to them.
23160
23161
23162 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
23163 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
23164 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
23165 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
23166 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
23167
23168
23169 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
23170 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
23171 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
23172 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
23173 details.
23174
23175
23176 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23177 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23178 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23179 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23180 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23181 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23182 the dnssec request bit set.
23183 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23184
23185
23186
23187 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
23188 .cindex "MX record" "security"
23189 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
23190 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
23191 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
23192 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
23193 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
23194 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
23195 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
23196
23197
23198
23199 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
23200 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
23201 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
23202 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
23203 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
23204 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
23205 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
23206
23207 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
23208 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
23209 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
23210 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
23211 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
23212
23213
23214 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
23215 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23216 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
23217 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
23218 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
23219 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23220 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23221 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
23222
23223 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
23224 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
23225 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
23226 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
23227 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
23228 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
23229
23230 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
23231 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
23232 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
23233 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
23234 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
23235
23236 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
23237 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
23238 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
23239 copy of the message is sent.
23240
23241 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
23242 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
23243 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
23244 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
23245 fails"& facility.
23246
23247
23248 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
23249 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
23250 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
23251 zero.
23252
23253 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
23254 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
23255 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
23256 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
23257 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
23258 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
23259
23260 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
23261 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
23262 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
23263 implementations of TLS.
23264
23265 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
23266 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
23267 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
23268 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
23269 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
23270 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
23271 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
23272 option is:
23273 .code
23274 $primary_hostname
23275 .endd
23276 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
23277 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
23278 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
23279 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
23280 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
23281 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
23282 interface address, you could use this:
23283 .code
23284 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
23285 {$primary_hostname}}
23286 .endd
23287 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
23288 callouts.
23289
23290 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
23291 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
23292 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
23293 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
23294 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
23295 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
23296
23297 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
23298 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
23299 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
23300 &%hosts_override%& is set.
23301
23302 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
23303 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
23304 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
23305 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
23306 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
23307 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
23308 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
23309
23310 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
23311 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
23312 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
23313 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
23314 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
23315 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
23316 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
23317 address are used.
23318
23319 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
23320 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
23321
23322
23323 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23324 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
23325 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
23326 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
23327 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23328 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
23329 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
23330 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
23331 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
23332 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
23333
23334
23335 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
23336 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
23337 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
23338 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
23339
23340
23341 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23342 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23343 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23344 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23345
23346 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23347 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
23348 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
23349 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
23350 to any host that matches this list.
23351
23352
23353 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
23354 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23355 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
23356 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
23357 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
23358 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
23359 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
23360 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
23361
23362
23363 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
23364 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
23365 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
23366 why it exists.
23367
23368
23369
23370 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23371 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
23372 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
23373 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
23374 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
23375 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
23376 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
23377 explanation of when this might be needed.
23378
23379
23380 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
23381 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
23382 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
23383 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
23384 &%fallback_hosts%&.
23385
23386
23387 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
23388 .cindex "randomized host list"
23389 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
23390 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
23391 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
23392 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
23393 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
23394 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
23395 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
23396 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
23397
23398 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
23399 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
23400 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
23401 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
23402 .code
23403 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
23404 .endd
23405 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
23406 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
23407 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
23408
23409 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23410 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
23411 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
23412 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
23413 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
23414 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
23415 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
23416 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
23417 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23418
23419
23420 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
23421 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23422 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
23423 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23424 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23425
23426 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
23427 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23428 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
23429 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
23430 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
23431
23432 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
23433 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
23434 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
23435 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23436 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
23437 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
23438
23439 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
23440 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
23441 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23442 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
23443 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
23444 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
23445 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
23446
23447 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
23448 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
23449 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
23450 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
23451 for multi-recipient messages.
23452 The option can usually be left as default.
23453
23454 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
23455 .cindex "bind IP address"
23456 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
23457 .vindex "&$host$&"
23458 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23459 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
23460 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
23461 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
23462 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
23463 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
23464 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
23465 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
23466 unknown.
23467
23468 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
23469 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
23470 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
23471 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
23472 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
23473 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
23474 .code
23475 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
23476 .endd
23477 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
23478 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
23479 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
23480 interface to use if the host has more than one.
23481
23482
23483 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
23484 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
23485 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
23486 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
23487 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
23488 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
23489 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
23490 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
23491 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
23492 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
23493 unreachable hosts.
23494
23495
23496 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
23497 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23498 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
23499 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
23500 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
23501
23502 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
23503 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
23504 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
23505 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
23506 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
23507 permits this.
23508
23509
23510 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
23511 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23512 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
23513 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
23514 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
23515 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
23516 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
23517 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
23518
23519 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
23520 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
23521 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
23522
23523 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
23524 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
23525 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
23526 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
23527 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
23528 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
23529 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
23530 variable that contains an outgoing port.
23531
23532 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
23533 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
23534 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
23535 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
23536 is deferred.
23537
23538
23539
23540 .option protocol smtp string smtp
23541 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
23542 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
23543 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
23544 .vindex "&$port$&"
23545 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
23546 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
23547 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
23548 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
23549 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
23550
23551 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
23552 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
23553 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
23554 The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
23555
23556
23557 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
23558 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
23559 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
23560 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
23561 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
23562 addresses is not affected.
23563
23564 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
23565 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
23566 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
23567 Exim to use only the host name.
23568 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
23569
23570
23571 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23572 .cindex "serializing connections"
23573 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
23574 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
23575 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
23576 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
23577 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
23578 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
23579 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
23580
23581 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
23582 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
23583 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
23584 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
23585 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
23586 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
23587
23588 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
23589 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
23590 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
23591 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
23592 are used for ETRN serialization.
23593
23594
23595 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
23596 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
23597 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
23598 .cindex "size" "of message"
23599 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23600 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23601 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
23602 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
23603 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
23604 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
23605 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
23606 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
23607
23608 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
23609 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
23610
23611
23612 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
23613 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
23614 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
23615 .vindex "&$host$&"
23616 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23617 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23618 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
23619 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
23620 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
23621 details of TLS.
23622
23623 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
23624 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
23625 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
23626 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
23627 client.
23628
23629
23630 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
23631 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
23632 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
23633 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
23634 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
23635
23636
23637 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
23638 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
23639 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
23640 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
23641 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
23642 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
23643 will fail.
23644
23645 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
23646
23647
23648 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
23649 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
23650 .vindex "&$host$&"
23651 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23652 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
23653 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
23654 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
23655 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23656 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
23657 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
23658 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23659
23660
23661 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
23662 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
23663 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
23664 .vindex "&$host$&"
23665 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23666 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
23667 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
23668 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
23669 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23670 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
23671 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
23672 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
23673 ciphers is a preference order.
23674
23675
23676
23677 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
23678 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
23679 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
23680 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
23681 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
23682 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
23683 certificate and private key for the session.
23684
23685 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
23686
23687 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
23688 TLS extensions.
23689
23690
23691
23692
23693 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
23694 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
23695 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
23696 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
23697 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
23698 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
23699 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
23700 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
23701 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
23702 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
23703 in clear.
23704
23705
23706 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
23707 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23708 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23709 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
23710 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
23711 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23712 Note that unless the host is in this list
23713 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
23714 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
23715 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
23716 certificate verification succeeds.
23717
23718
23719 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
23720 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
23721 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23722 This option give a list of hosts for which,
23723 while verifying the server certificate,
23724 checks will be included on the host name
23725 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
23726 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
23727 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
23728
23729 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
23730
23731
23732 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
23733 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23734 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23735 .vindex "&$host$&"
23736 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23737 The value of this option must be either the
23738 word "system"
23739 or the absolute path to
23740 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
23741 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
23742
23743 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
23744 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
23745 is taken as empty and an explicit location
23746 must be specified.
23747
23748 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
23749 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
23750
23751 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
23752 explicitly
23753 either by file or directory
23754 are added to those given by the system default location.
23755
23756 The values of &$host$& and
23757 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
23758 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
23759
23760 For back-compatibility,
23761 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
23762 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
23763 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
23764
23765
23766 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
23767 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
23768 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
23769 This option gives a list of hosts for which. on encrypted connections,
23770 certificate verification must succeed.
23771 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
23772 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
23773 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
23774
23775
23776
23777
23778 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
23779 "SECTvalhosmax"
23780 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
23781 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
23782 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
23783 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
23784 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
23785
23786
23787 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
23788 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
23789 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
23790 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
23791 retrying.
23792
23793 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
23794 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
23795 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
23796
23797 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
23798 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
23799 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
23800 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
23801 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
23802
23803 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
23804 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
23805 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
23806 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
23807 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
23808 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
23809 see below for an exception).
23810
23811 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
23812 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
23813 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
23814 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
23815 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
23816
23817 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
23818 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
23819 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
23820 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
23821 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
23822 reached their retry times.
23823
23824 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
23825 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
23826 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
23827 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
23828 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
23829 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
23830 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
23831 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
23832 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
23833 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
23834 reached.
23835
23836 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
23837 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
23838 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
23839 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
23840 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
23841 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
23842
23843 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
23844 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
23845 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
23846 possible IP addresses have been tried.
23847 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
23848 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
23849
23850
23851
23852
23853
23854 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23855 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23856
23857 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
23858 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
23859 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
23860 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
23861 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
23862 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
23863
23864 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
23865 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
23866 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
23867 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
23868 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
23869 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
23870 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
23871
23872 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
23873 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
23874 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
23875 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
23876
23877
23878 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
23879 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
23880 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
23881 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
23882
23883 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
23884 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
23885 facility; you do not have to use it.
23886
23887 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
23888 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
23889 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
23890 address to which it applies.
23891
23892 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
23893 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
23894 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
23895 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
23896 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
23897 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
23898 rules.
23899
23900 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
23901 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
23902 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
23903 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
23904
23905
23906 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
23907 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
23908 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
23909 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
23910 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
23911 discouraged.
23912
23913 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
23914 illustrated by these examples:
23915
23916 .ilist
23917 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
23918 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
23919 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
23920 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
23921 .next
23922 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
23923 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
23924 .endlist
23925
23926
23927
23928 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
23929 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
23930 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
23931 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
23932 message's processing.
23933
23934 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23935 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
23936 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
23937 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
23938 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
23939 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
23940 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
23941 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
23942 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
23943
23944 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23945 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23946 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
23947 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
23948 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
23949 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
23950 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
23951 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
23952 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
23953 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
23954
23955 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
23956 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
23957 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
23958 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
23959 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
23960 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
23961
23962 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
23963 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
23964 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
23965
23966 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
23967 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
23968 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
23969 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
23970 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
23971 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
23972 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
23973 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
23974 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
23975
23976 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
23977 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
23978 transport time.
23979
23980
23981
23982
23983 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
23984 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
23985 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
23986 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
23987 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
23988 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
23989 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
23990 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
23991 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
23992 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
23993 .code
23994 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
23995 .endd
23996 might produce the output
23997 .code
23998 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
23999 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24000 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24001 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24002 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24003 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24004 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
24005 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
24006 .endd
24007 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
24008 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
24009 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
24010 set for a particular transport.
24011
24012
24013 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
24014 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
24015 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
24016 rules in the form
24017 .display
24018 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
24019 .endd
24020 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
24021 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
24022 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
24023 any colons must be doubled, of course).
24024
24025 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
24026 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
24027 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
24028 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
24029 ignored.
24030
24031 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
24032 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
24033 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
24034
24035 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
24036 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
24037 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
24038 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
24039 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
24040 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
24041 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
24042
24043 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24044 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24045 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
24046 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
24047 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
24048 .code
24049 *@* ${lookup ...
24050 .endd
24051 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
24052 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24053
24054
24055 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
24056 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
24057 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
24058 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
24059 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
24060 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
24061 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
24062 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
24063 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
24064
24065 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
24066 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
24067 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
24068
24069 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
24070 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
24071 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
24072 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
24073 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
24074 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
24075 of pattern they are set as follows:
24076
24077 .ilist
24078 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
24079 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
24080 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
24081 pattern
24082 .code
24083 *queen@*.fict.example
24084 .endd
24085 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
24086 .code
24087 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
24088 $1 = hearts-
24089 $2 = wonderland
24090 .endd
24091 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
24092 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
24093
24094 .next
24095 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
24096 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
24097 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
24098 rewriting rule of the form
24099 .display
24100 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
24101 .endd
24102 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
24103 .code
24104 $1 = foo
24105 $2 = bar
24106 $3 = baz.example
24107 .endd
24108 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
24109 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
24110 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
24111 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
24112 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
24113 .endlist
24114
24115
24116 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
24117 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
24118 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
24119 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
24120 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
24121 .code
24122 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
24123 .endd
24124 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
24125 &'From:'& headers.
24126
24127 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24128 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24129 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
24130 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
24131 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
24132 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
24133 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
24134 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
24135 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
24136 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
24137 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
24138 entry written to the panic log.
24139
24140
24141
24142 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
24143 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
24144
24145 .ilist
24146 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
24147 c, f, h, r, s, t.
24148 .next
24149 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
24150 .next
24151 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
24152 .endlist
24153
24154 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
24155 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
24156
24157
24158
24159 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
24160 "SECID154"
24161 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
24162 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
24163 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
24164 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
24165 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
24166 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
24167 .display
24168 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
24169 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
24170 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
24171 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
24172 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
24173 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
24174 &`h`& rewrite all headers
24175 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
24176 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
24177 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
24178 .endd
24179 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
24180 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
24181 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
24182
24183 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
24184 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
24185
24186
24187 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
24188 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
24189 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
24190 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
24191 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
24192 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
24193 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
24194 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
24195 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
24196
24197 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24198 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24199 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
24200 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
24201 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
24202 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
24203 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
24204 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
24205
24206
24207 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
24208 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
24209 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
24210 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
24211
24212 .ilist
24213 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
24214 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
24215 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
24216 .next
24217 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
24218 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
24219 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
24220 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
24221 .next
24222 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
24223 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
24224 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
24225 .next
24226 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
24227 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
24228 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
24229 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
24230 .code
24231 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
24232 .endd
24233 into
24234 .code
24235 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
24236 .endd
24237 .cindex "RFC 2047"
24238 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
24239 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
24240 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
24241 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
24242 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
24243 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
24244 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
24245 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
24246
24247 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
24248 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
24249 .endlist
24250
24251
24252 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
24253 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
24254 .code
24255 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
24256 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
24257 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
24258 .endd
24259 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
24260 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
24261 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
24262 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
24263 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
24264 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
24265 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
24266 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
24267
24268 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
24269 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
24270 .code
24271 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
24272 .endd
24273 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
24274 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
24275
24276 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
24277 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
24278 messages that originate outside the local host:
24279 .code
24280 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
24281 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
24282 .endd
24283 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
24284 space.
24285
24286 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
24287 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
24288 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
24289 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
24290 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
24291 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
24292 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
24293 components. For example, the rule
24294 .code
24295 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
24296 .endd
24297 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
24298 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
24299 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
24300 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
24301 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
24302 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
24303 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
24304 .ecindex IIDaddrew
24305
24306
24307
24308
24309
24310 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24311 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24312
24313 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
24314 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
24315 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
24316 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
24317 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
24318 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
24319 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
24320 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
24321 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
24322 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
24323 address, domain and error.
24324
24325 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
24326 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
24327 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
24328 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
24329 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
24330 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
24331 log selector is set, the message
24332 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
24333 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
24334 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
24335 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
24336
24337 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
24338 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
24339 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
24340 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
24341 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
24342 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
24343 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
24344 domain are maintained independently.
24345
24346 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
24347 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
24348 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
24349 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
24350 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
24351 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
24352 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
24353 the local address is reached.
24354
24355 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
24356 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
24357 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
24358 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
24359 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
24360
24361 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
24362 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
24363 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
24364 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
24365 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
24366 messages that it should now be retaining.
24367
24368
24369
24370 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
24371 .cindex "retry" "rules"
24372 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
24373 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
24374 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
24375 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
24376 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
24377 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
24378 message's sender, respectively.
24379
24380
24381 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
24382 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
24383 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
24384 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
24385 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
24386 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
24387 example,
24388 .code
24389 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24390 .endd
24391 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
24392 whereas
24393 .code
24394 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24395 .endd
24396 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
24397 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
24398 part.
24399
24400 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
24401 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
24402 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
24403 expressions work in address lists.
24404 .display
24405 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
24406 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
24407 .endd
24408
24409
24410 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
24411 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
24412 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
24413 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
24414 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
24415 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
24416 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
24417 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
24418 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
24419
24420 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
24421 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
24422 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
24423 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
24424 local transports).
24425
24426 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
24427 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
24428 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
24429 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
24430 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
24431 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
24432 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
24433 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
24434 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
24435 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
24436 commands.
24437
24438
24439
24440 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
24441 "SECID160"
24442 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
24443 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
24444 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
24445 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
24446 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
24447 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
24448 .code
24449 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
24450 MX 6 p.q.r.example
24451 MX 7 m.n.o.example
24452 .endd
24453 and the retry rules are
24454 .code
24455 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
24456 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
24457 .endd
24458 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
24459 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
24460 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
24461 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
24462 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
24463 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
24464
24465 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
24466 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
24467 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
24468 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
24469
24470 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
24471 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
24472 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
24473 .code
24474 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
24475 .endd
24476 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
24477 textual form of the IP address.
24478
24479 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
24480 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
24481 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
24482 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
24483
24484 .vlist
24485 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
24486 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
24487 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
24488
24489 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
24490 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
24491 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
24492
24493 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
24494 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
24495
24496 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
24497 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
24498 .endlist
24499
24500 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
24501 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
24502 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
24503 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
24504 retry rule of this form:
24505 .code
24506 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
24507 .endd
24508 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
24509 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
24510
24511 .vlist
24512 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
24513 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
24514 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
24515 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
24516
24517 .vitem &%lookup%&
24518 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
24519 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
24520 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
24521 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
24522 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
24523
24524 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
24525 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
24526
24527 .vitem &%refused_A%&
24528 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
24529
24530 .vitem &%refused%&
24531 A connection was refused.
24532
24533 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
24534 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
24535
24536 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
24537 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
24538
24539 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
24540 A connection attempt timed out.
24541
24542 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
24543 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
24544 obtained from an MX record.
24545
24546 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
24547 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
24548 obtained from an MX record.
24549
24550 .vitem &%timeout%&
24551 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
24552
24553 .vitem &%tls_required%&
24554 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
24555 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
24556 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
24557
24558 .vitem &%quota%&
24559 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24560 transport.
24561
24562 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
24563 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
24564 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
24565 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
24566 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
24567 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
24568 for four days.
24569 .endlist
24570
24571 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
24572 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
24573 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
24574 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
24575 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
24576 heuristic rules:
24577
24578 .ilist
24579 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
24580 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
24581 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
24582 .next
24583 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
24584 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
24585 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
24586 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
24587 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
24588 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
24589 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
24590 .next
24591 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
24592 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
24593 .endlist
24594
24595 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
24596 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
24597 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
24598 error).
24599
24600
24601
24602 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
24603 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
24604 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
24605 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
24606 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
24607 form:
24608 .display
24609 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
24610 .endd
24611 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
24612 .code
24613 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
24614 .endd
24615 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
24616 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
24617 For example:
24618 .code
24619 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
24620 .endd
24621 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
24622 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
24623 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
24624 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
24625 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
24626
24627 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
24628 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
24629 .code
24630 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
24631 .endd
24632 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
24633 list is never matched.
24634
24635
24636
24637
24638
24639 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
24640 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
24641 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
24642 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
24643 .display
24644 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
24645 .endd
24646 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
24647 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
24648 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
24649 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
24650 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
24651
24652 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
24653 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
24654 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
24655 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
24656 The available algorithms are:
24657
24658 .ilist
24659 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
24660 the interval.
24661 .next
24662 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
24663 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
24664 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
24665 .next
24666 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
24667 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
24668 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
24669 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
24670 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
24671 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
24672 queue processing times.
24673 .endlist
24674
24675 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
24676 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
24677 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
24678 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
24679 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
24680 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
24681 interval is found. The main configuration variable
24682 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
24683 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
24684 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
24685 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
24686 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
24687
24688 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
24689 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
24690 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
24691 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
24692 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
24693 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
24694 time.
24695
24696 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
24697 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
24698 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
24699 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
24700 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
24701 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
24702 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
24703 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
24704 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
24705 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
24706 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
24707 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
24708
24709 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
24710 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
24711 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
24712 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
24713 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
24714 deliveries that have been deferred.
24715
24716
24717 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
24718 Here are some example retry rules:
24719 .code
24720 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
24721 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
24722 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
24723 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
24724 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
24725 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
24726 .endd
24727 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
24728 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
24729 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
24730 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
24731 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
24732 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
24733 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
24734 days.
24735
24736 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
24737 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
24738 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
24739 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
24740 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
24741
24742 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
24743 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
24744 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
24745 were not obtained from an MX record.
24746
24747 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
24748 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
24749 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
24750 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
24751 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
24752
24753
24754
24755 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
24756 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
24757 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
24758 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
24759 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
24760 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
24761 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
24762 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
24763 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
24764 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
24765 failing for the first time.
24766
24767 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
24768 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
24769 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
24770 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
24771
24772 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
24773 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
24774 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
24775
24776
24777
24778
24779 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
24780 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
24781 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
24782 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
24783 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
24784 default retry rule:
24785 .code
24786 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
24787 .endd
24788 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
24789 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
24790 failure for the recipient address that counts.
24791
24792 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
24793 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
24794 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
24795 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
24796 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
24797
24798 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
24799 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
24800 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
24801
24802 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
24803 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
24804 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
24805 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
24806 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
24807 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
24808 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
24809 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
24810
24811 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
24812 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
24813 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
24814 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
24815 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
24816 notice.
24817
24818 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24819 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
24820 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24821 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
24822 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
24823 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
24824 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
24825 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
24826 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
24827 true.
24828
24829 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
24830 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
24831 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
24832 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
24833 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
24834 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
24835 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
24836 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
24837 reached.
24838
24839 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
24840 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
24841 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
24842 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
24843 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
24844 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
24845 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
24846 time out the address.
24847
24848 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
24849 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
24850 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
24851 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
24852 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
24853 considered immediately.
24854 .ecindex IIDretconf1
24855 .ecindex IIDregconf2
24856
24857
24858
24859
24860
24861
24862 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24863 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24864
24865 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
24866 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
24867 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
24868 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
24869 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
24870 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
24871 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
24872 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
24873 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
24874 other.
24875
24876 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
24877 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
24878
24879 .ilist
24880 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
24881 the client's EHLO command.
24882 .next
24883 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
24884 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
24885 .next
24886 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
24887 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
24888 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
24889 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
24890 with the AUTH command.
24891 .next
24892 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
24893 .next
24894 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
24895 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
24896 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
24897 connection.
24898 .next
24899 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
24900 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
24901 unauthenticated connection.
24902 .endlist
24903
24904 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
24905 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
24906 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
24907 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
24908 .display
24909 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
24910 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
24911 &`Connected to server.example.`&
24912 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
24913 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
24914 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
24915 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
24916 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
24917 &`250-PIPELINING`&
24918 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
24919 &`250 HELP`&
24920 .endd
24921 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
24922 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
24923 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
24924 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
24925 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
24926 included by setting
24927 .code
24928 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
24929 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
24930 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
24931 AUTH_GSASL=yes
24932 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
24933 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
24934 AUTH_SPA=yes
24935 AUTH_TLS=yes
24936 .endd
24937 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
24938 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
24939 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
24940 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
24941 work via a socket interface.
24942 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
24943 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
24944 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
24945 supporting setting a server keytab.
24946 The sixth can be configured to support
24947 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
24948 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
24949 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
24950 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
24951 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
24952
24953 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
24954 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
24955 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
24956 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
24957 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
24958 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
24959 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
24960
24961 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
24962 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
24963 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
24964 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
24965 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
24966 both sets of options, is required. For example:
24967 .code
24968 cram:
24969 driver = cram_md5
24970 public_name = CRAM-MD5
24971 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
24972 client_name = ph10
24973 client_secret = secret2
24974 .endd
24975 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
24976 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
24977
24978 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
24979 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
24980 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
24981 in Exim.
24982
24983 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
24984 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
24985 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
24986 authenticating data.
24987
24988 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
24989 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
24990 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
24991 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
24992 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
24993 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
24994 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
24995 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
24996 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
24997 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
24998 choose to honour.
24999
25000 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
25001 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
25002 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
25003 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
25004
25005
25006
25007 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
25008 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
25009 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
25010
25011 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25012 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
25013 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
25014 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
25015 encrypted by a setting such as:
25016 .code
25017 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
25018 .endd
25019
25020
25021 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25022 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
25023 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
25024 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
25025
25026
25027 .option driver authenticators string unset
25028 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
25029 authenticators is to be used.
25030
25031
25032 .option public_name authenticators string unset
25033 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
25034 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
25035 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
25036 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
25037 defaults to the driver's instance name.
25038
25039
25040 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25041 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
25042 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
25043 mechanism is not advertised.
25044 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
25045 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
25046 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
25047
25048
25049 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25050 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
25051 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
25052 for details.
25053
25054 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
25055 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
25056
25057 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
25058 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
25059 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
25060 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
25061 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
25062 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
25063 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25064 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
25065 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
25066 the error text.
25067
25068
25069 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
25070 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
25071 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
25072 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
25073 out the values of variables.
25074 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
25075 output, and Exim carries on processing.
25076
25077
25078 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
25079 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25080 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
25081 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
25082 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
25083 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
25084 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
25085 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
25086 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
25087
25088
25089 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25090 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
25091 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
25092 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
25093 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
25094 remembered for later use.
25095 How it is used is described in the following section.
25096
25097
25098
25099
25100
25101 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
25102 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
25103 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25104 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
25105 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
25106 message:
25107
25108 .ilist
25109 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
25110 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
25111 .next
25112 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
25113 .next
25114 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
25115 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
25116 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
25117 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
25118 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
25119 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
25120 given for the MAIL command.
25121 .next
25122 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
25123 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
25124 authenticated.
25125 .next
25126 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
25127 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
25128 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
25129 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
25130 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
25131 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
25132 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
25133 message.
25134 .endlist
25135
25136
25137 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
25138 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
25139 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
25140 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
25141
25142 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25143 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
25144 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
25145 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
25146 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
25147 ACL is run.
25148
25149
25150
25151 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
25152 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
25153 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
25154 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
25155 conditions:
25156
25157 .ilist
25158 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
25159 .next
25160 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
25161 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
25162 .endlist
25163
25164 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
25165 the mechanisms are advertised.
25166
25167 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
25168 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
25169 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
25170 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
25171 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
25172 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
25173 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
25174 .code
25175 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
25176 .endd
25177 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
25178
25179 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
25180 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
25181 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
25182 such as:
25183 .code
25184 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
25185 .endd
25186 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
25187 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
25188 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
25189
25190 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
25191 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
25192 command. This is the case if
25193
25194 .ilist
25195 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
25196 .next
25197 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
25198 .next
25199 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
25200 server authenticators.
25201 .endlist
25202
25203
25204 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
25205 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
25206 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
25207
25208 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
25209 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
25210 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
25211 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
25212 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
25213 rejected with a 504 error.
25214
25215 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
25216 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
25217 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
25218 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
25219 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
25220 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
25221 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
25222 no successful authentication.
25223
25224
25225
25226
25227 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
25228 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
25229 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
25230 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
25231 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
25232 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
25233 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
25234 script:
25235 .code
25236 use MIME::Base64;
25237 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
25238 .endd
25239 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
25240 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
25241 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
25242 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
25243 command line to run this script on such data might be
25244 .code
25245 encode '\0user\0password'
25246 .endd
25247 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
25248 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
25249 whose code value is zero.
25250
25251 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
25252 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
25253 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
25254 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
25255
25256 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
25257 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
25258 example, a command such as
25259 .code
25260 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
25261 .endd
25262 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
25263
25264 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
25265 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
25266 .code
25267 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
25268 .endd
25269 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
25270 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
25271 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
25272 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
25273
25274
25275
25276 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
25277 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
25278 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
25279 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
25280 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
25281 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
25282
25283 .ilist
25284 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
25285 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
25286 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
25287 of the authenticator.
25288 .next
25289 .vindex "&$host$&"
25290 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25291 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
25292 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
25293 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
25294 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
25295 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
25296 delivery to be deferred.
25297 .next
25298 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
25299 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
25300 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
25301 usual way.
25302 .next
25303 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
25304 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
25305 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
25306 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
25307 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
25308 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
25309 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
25310 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
25311 deliver the message unauthenticated.
25312 .endlist
25313
25314 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
25315 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
25316 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
25317 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
25318 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
25319 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
25320 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
25321 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
25322 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
25323 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
25324 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
25325 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
25326 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
25327
25328
25329
25330
25331
25332
25333 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25334 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25335
25336 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
25337 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
25338 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
25339 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
25340 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
25341 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
25342 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
25343 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
25344 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
25345 connections as you do for login accounts.
25346
25347 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
25348 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
25349 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
25350
25351 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
25352 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
25353 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
25354
25355 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
25356 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
25357 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
25358 given.
25359
25360 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
25361 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25362 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25363 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
25364 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25365 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25366 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25367
25368 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
25369 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
25370 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
25371 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
25372 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
25373 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
25374 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
25375
25376 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
25377 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
25378 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
25379 string expansions that also use them for other things.
25380
25381 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
25382 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
25383 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
25384
25385 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25386 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
25387 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
25388 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
25389 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
25390 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
25391 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
25392 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
25393 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
25394 string as the error text
25395
25396 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
25397 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
25398 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
25399
25400
25401
25402 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
25403 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
25404 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
25405 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
25406 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
25407 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
25408 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
25409 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
25410
25411 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
25412 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
25413 configured as follows:
25414 .code
25415 fixed_plain:
25416 driver = plaintext
25417 public_name = PLAIN
25418 server_prompts = :
25419 server_condition = \
25420 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
25421 server_set_id = $auth2
25422 .endd
25423 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
25424 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
25425 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
25426 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
25427
25428 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
25429 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
25430 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
25431 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
25432 .code
25433 250-AUTH PLAIN
25434 .endd
25435 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
25436 .code
25437 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
25438 .endd
25439 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
25440 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
25441 .code
25442 AUTH PLAIN
25443 .endd
25444 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
25445 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
25446
25447 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
25448 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
25449 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
25450 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
25451 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
25452
25453 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
25454 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
25455 authenticating clients it could make sense.
25456
25457 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
25458 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
25459 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
25460 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
25461 This is an incorrect example:
25462 .code
25463 server_condition = \
25464 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
25465 .endd
25466 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
25467 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
25468 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
25469 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
25470 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
25471 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
25472 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
25473 .code
25474 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
25475 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
25476 .endd
25477 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
25478 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
25479 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
25480 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
25481 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
25482
25483
25484 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
25485 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
25486 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
25487 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
25488 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
25489 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
25490 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
25491 .code
25492 fixed_login:
25493 driver = plaintext
25494 public_name = LOGIN
25495 server_prompts = User Name : Password
25496 server_condition = \
25497 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
25498 server_set_id = $auth1
25499 .endd
25500 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
25501 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
25502 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
25503 strings are used to obtain two data items.
25504
25505 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
25506 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
25507 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
25508 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
25509 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
25510 .code
25511 login:
25512 driver = plaintext
25513 public_name = LOGIN
25514 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
25515 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
25516 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
25517 ldapauth{\
25518 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
25519 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
25520 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
25521 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
25522 .endd
25523 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
25524 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
25525 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
25526 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
25527 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
25528 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
25529 uninterpreted string.
25530
25531
25532 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
25533 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
25534 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
25535 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
25536 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
25537 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
25538
25539
25540
25541
25542 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
25543 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
25544 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
25545
25546 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
25547 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
25548 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
25549 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
25550 usual.
25551
25552 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
25553 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
25554 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
25555 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
25556 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
25557 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
25558 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
25559 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
25560 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
25561 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
25562 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
25563 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
25564
25565 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
25566 splitting takes priority and happens first.
25567
25568 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
25569 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
25570 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
25571 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
25572 the string.
25573
25574 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
25575 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
25576 .code
25577 fixed_plain:
25578 driver = plaintext
25579 public_name = PLAIN
25580 client_send = ^username^mysecret
25581 .endd
25582 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
25583 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
25584 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
25585 .code
25586 fixed_login:
25587 driver = plaintext
25588 public_name = LOGIN
25589 client_send = : username : mysecret
25590 .endd
25591 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
25592 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
25593 prompts.
25594 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
25595 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
25596
25597
25598
25599
25600 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25601 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25602
25603 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
25604 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25605 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
25606 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
25607 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
25608 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
25609 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
25610 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
25611 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
25612 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
25613 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
25614 available in plain text at either end.
25615
25616
25617 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
25618 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
25619 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
25620 authenticator as a server:
25621
25622 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25623 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
25624 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
25625 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
25626 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
25627 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
25628 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
25629 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
25630 returned to the client.
25631
25632 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
25633 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
25634 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
25635 numeric variables for other things.
25636
25637 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
25638 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
25639 user name, authentication fails.
25640 .code
25641 fixed_cram:
25642 driver = cram_md5
25643 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25644 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
25645 server_set_id = $auth1
25646 .endd
25647 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
25648 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
25649 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
25650 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
25651 .code
25652 lookup_cram:
25653 driver = cram_md5
25654 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25655 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
25656 {$value}fail}
25657 server_set_id = $auth1
25658 .endd
25659 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
25660 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
25661
25662 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
25663 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
25664 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
25665 realm, with:
25666 .code
25667 cyrusless_crammd5:
25668 driver = cram_md5
25669 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25670 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
25671 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
25672 server_set_id = $auth1
25673 .endd
25674
25675 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
25676 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
25677 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
25678
25679
25680
25681 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
25682 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
25683 computing the response to the server's challenge.
25684
25685
25686 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
25687 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
25688 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
25689
25690
25691 .vindex "&$host$&"
25692 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25693 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
25694 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
25695 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
25696 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
25697 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
25698 send the message to the current server.
25699
25700 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
25701 strings, is:
25702 .code
25703 fixed_cram:
25704 driver = cram_md5
25705 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25706 client_name = ph10
25707 client_secret = secret
25708 .endd
25709 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
25710 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
25711
25712
25713
25714 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25715 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25716
25717 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
25718 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
25719 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
25720 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
25721 .cindex "Kerberos"
25722 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
25723 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
25724
25725 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
25726 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
25727 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
25728 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
25729 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
25730
25731 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
25732 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
25733 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
25734 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
25735
25736 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
25737 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
25738 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
25739 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
25740 depending on the driver you are using.
25741
25742 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
25743 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
25744 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
25745 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
25746 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
25747 implementation.
25748
25749 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
25750 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
25751 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
25752 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
25753 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
25754 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
25755 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
25756 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
25757
25758
25759 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
25760 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
25761 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
25762 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
25763 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
25764 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
25765 things.
25766
25767
25768 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
25769 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25770 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
25771 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
25772
25773
25774 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
25775 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25776 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25777 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25778 example:
25779 .code
25780 sasl:
25781 driver = cyrus_sasl
25782 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25783 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25784 server_set_id = $auth1
25785 .endd
25786
25787 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
25788 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25789
25790
25791 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
25792 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25793
25794
25795 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
25796 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
25797 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
25798 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
25799 .code
25800 sasl_cram_md5:
25801 driver = cyrus_sasl
25802 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25803 server_set_id = $auth1
25804
25805 sasl_plain:
25806 driver = cyrus_sasl
25807 public_name = PLAIN
25808 server_set_id = $auth2
25809 .endd
25810 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
25811 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
25812 but it is present in many binary distributions.
25813 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
25814 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
25815
25816
25817
25818
25819 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25820 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25821 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
25822 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
25823 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
25824 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
25825 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
25826 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
25827 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
25828 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
25829 authenticator only. There is only one option:
25830
25831 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
25832
25833 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
25834 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
25835 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
25836 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
25837 .code
25838 dovecot_plain:
25839 driver = dovecot
25840 public_name = PLAIN
25841 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25842 server_set_id = $auth1
25843
25844 dovecot_ntlm:
25845 driver = dovecot
25846 public_name = NTLM
25847 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
25848 server_set_id = $auth1
25849 .endd
25850 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
25851 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
25852 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
25853 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
25854 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
25855 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
25856 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
25857 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
25858
25859
25860 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25861 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25862 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
25863 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
25864 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
25865 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
25866 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
25867 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25868 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25869 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
25870 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
25871 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
25872 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
25873 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
25874 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
25875 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
25876 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
25877 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
25878 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
25879 without code changes in Exim.
25880
25881
25882 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
25883 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
25884 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
25885 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
25886 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
25887 context.
25888
25889 This means that certificate identity and verification becomes a non-issue,
25890 as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and server to
25891 see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
25892
25893 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
25894 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
25895 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
25896
25897 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
25898 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
25899 of Exim may switch the default to be true.
25900
25901
25902 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
25903 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
25904 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
25905 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25906
25907
25908 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
25909 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
25910 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
25911 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
25912 example:
25913 .code
25914 sasl:
25915 driver = gsasl
25916 public_name = X-ANYTHING
25917 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
25918 server_set_id = $auth1
25919 .endd
25920
25921
25922 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
25923 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
25924 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
25925 the password itself.
25926
25927 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
25928 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
25929 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
25930 if available, else the empty string.
25931 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
25932 else the empty string.
25933
25934 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
25935
25936 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
25937 option to be simply "true".
25938
25939
25940 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
25941 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
25942 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25943
25944
25945 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
25946 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25947 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25948 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25949
25950
25951 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
25952 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
25953 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
25954 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
25955
25956
25957 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
25958 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
25959 Some mechanisms will use this data.
25960
25961
25962 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
25963 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
25964 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
25965 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
25966
25967 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
25968 meanings for these variables:
25969
25970 .ilist
25971 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
25972 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
25973 .next
25974 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
25975 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
25976 .next
25977 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
25978 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
25979 .endlist
25980
25981 On a per-mechanism basis:
25982
25983 .ilist
25984 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
25985 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
25986 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25987 .next
25988 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
25989 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
25990 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25991 .next
25992 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
25993 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
25994 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
25995 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
25996 .endlist
25997
25998 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
25999 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
26000 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
26001
26002
26003 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
26004 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
26005 .code
26006 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
26007 driver = gsasl
26008 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26009 server_realm = imap.example.org
26010 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
26011 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26012 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
26013 server_condition = yes
26014 .endd
26015
26016
26017 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26018 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26019
26020 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
26021 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
26022 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
26023 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
26024 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
26025 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
26026 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
26027 reliably.
26028
26029 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
26030 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
26031 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
26032 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26033
26034 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
26035 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
26036 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
26037 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
26038
26039 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
26040 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
26041 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
26042 from the keytab.
26043
26044
26045 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
26046 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
26047 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
26048 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
26049
26050 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
26051 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
26052 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
26053 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
26054
26055 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26056 .ilist
26057 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
26058 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
26059 .next
26060 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
26061 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
26062 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
26063 GSS Display Name.
26064 .endlist
26065
26066
26067 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26068 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26069
26070 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
26071 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
26072 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
26073 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
26074 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
26075 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
26076 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
26077 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
26078 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
26079 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
26080 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
26081 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
26082 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
26083 follows:
26084
26085 .ilist
26086 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
26087 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
26088 .next
26089 The server sends back a challenge.
26090 .next
26091 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
26092 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
26093 .endlist
26094
26095 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
26096
26097
26098
26099 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
26100 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
26101 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
26102
26103 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
26104 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
26105 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
26106 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
26107 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
26108 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
26109 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
26110 for other things. For example:
26111 .code
26112 spa:
26113 driver = spa
26114 public_name = NTLM
26115 server_password = \
26116 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
26117 .endd
26118 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26119 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26120
26121
26122
26123
26124
26125 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
26126 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
26127 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
26128
26129
26130
26131 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
26132 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
26133
26134
26135 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
26136 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
26137
26138
26139 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
26140 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
26141 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
26142 &'msn.com'&:
26143 .code
26144 msn:
26145 driver = spa
26146 public_name = MSN
26147 client_username = msn/msn_username
26148 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
26149 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
26150 .endd
26151 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
26152 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
26153
26154
26155
26156
26157
26158 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26159 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26160
26161 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
26162 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
26163 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
26164 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
26165 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
26166 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
26167 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
26168 authentication based on client certificates.
26169
26170 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
26171 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
26172 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
26173 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
26174 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
26175 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
26176
26177 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
26178 for which it must have been requested via the
26179 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
26180 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26181
26182 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
26183 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
26184 and can authenticate the connection.
26185 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
26186
26187 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
26188
26189
26190 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
26191 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
26192
26193 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
26194 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
26195 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
26196 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
26197 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
26198 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
26199
26200 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
26201 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
26202 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
26203
26204 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
26205
26206
26207 Example:
26208 .code
26209 tls:
26210 driver = tls
26211 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
26212 {$tls_in_peercert}}
26213 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
26214 {!= {0} \
26215 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
26216 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
26217 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
26218 } } } }
26219 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
26220 .endd
26221 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
26222 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
26223
26224
26225 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
26226 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
26227 a connect- or helo-ACL.
26228
26229
26230
26231 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26232 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26233
26234 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
26235 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
26236 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
26237 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
26238 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
26239 .cindex "OpenSSL"
26240 .cindex "GnuTLS"
26241 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
26242 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
26243 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
26244 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
26245 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
26246 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
26247 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
26248 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
26249 certificates are used.
26250
26251 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
26252 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
26253 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
26254 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
26255 between them is encrypted.
26256
26257 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
26258 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
26259 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
26260 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
26261 encryption state.
26262
26263 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
26264 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
26265 in order to get TLS to work.
26266
26267
26268
26269 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
26270 "SECID284"
26271 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
26272 .cindex "smtps protocol"
26273 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
26274 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
26275 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
26276 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
26277 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
26278 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
26279 allocated for this purpose.
26280
26281 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
26282 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
26283 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
26284 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
26285 .code
26286 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
26287 .endd
26288 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
26289 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
26290 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
26291 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
26292 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
26293 defined elsewhere.
26294
26295 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
26296 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
26297
26298
26299
26300
26301
26302
26303 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
26304 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
26305 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
26306 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
26307 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
26308 .code
26309 USE_GNUTLS=yes
26310 .endd
26311 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
26312 .code
26313 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
26314 .endd
26315 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
26316 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
26317
26318 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
26319
26320 .ilist
26321 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
26322 cannot be the path of a directory
26323 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
26324 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
26325 .next
26326 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
26327 .next
26328 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26329 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
26330 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
26331 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
26332 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
26333 .next
26334 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
26335 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
26336 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
26337 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
26338 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
26339 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
26340 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
26341 option).
26342 .next
26343 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
26344 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
26345 .next
26346 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
26347 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
26348 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
26349 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
26350 .next
26351 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
26352 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
26353 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
26354 implementation, then patches are welcome.
26355 .endlist
26356
26357
26358 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
26359 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
26360 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
26361 but not the chosen filename.
26362 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
26363 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
26364
26365 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
26366 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
26367 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
26368 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
26369 of bits requested.
26370 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
26371 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
26372 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
26373 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
26374 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
26375 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
26376 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
26377
26378 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
26379 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
26380 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
26381 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
26382 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
26383
26384 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
26385 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
26386 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
26387 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
26388 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
26389 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
26390
26391 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
26392 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
26393 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
26394
26395 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
26396 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
26397 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
26398 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
26399 .code
26400 # ls
26401 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
26402 # rm -f new-params
26403 # touch new-params
26404 # chown exim:exim new-params
26405 # chmod 0600 new-params
26406 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
26407 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
26408 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
26409 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
26410 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
26411 # chmod 0400 new-params
26412 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
26413 .endd
26414 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
26415 stalling is removed.
26416
26417 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
26418 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
26419 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
26420 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
26421 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
26422 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
26423 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
26424 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
26425 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
26426 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
26427 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
26428
26429 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
26430 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
26431 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
26432 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
26433
26434 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
26435 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
26436 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
26437 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
26438 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
26439
26440
26441 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
26442 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
26443 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
26444 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
26445 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
26446 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
26447 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
26448 directly to this function call.
26449 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
26450 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
26451 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
26452 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
26453
26454 .ilist
26455 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
26456 .next
26457 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
26458 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
26459 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
26460 SSL v3 algorithms.
26461 .next
26462 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
26463 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
26464 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
26465 algorithms.
26466 .endlist
26467
26468 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
26469 &`-`& or &`+`&.
26470 .ilist
26471 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
26472 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
26473 stated.
26474 .next
26475 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
26476 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
26477 .next
26478 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
26479 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
26480 .endlist
26481
26482 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
26483 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
26484 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
26485 not be moved to the end of the list.
26486 .endlist
26487
26488 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
26489 string:
26490 .code
26491 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
26492 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
26493 .endd
26494
26495 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26496 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
26497 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
26498 choice of clients used:
26499 .code
26500 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
26501 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26502 {DEFAULT}\
26503 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
26504 .endd
26505
26506
26507
26508 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
26509 "SECTreqciphgnu"
26510 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
26511 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
26512 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
26513 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
26514 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
26515 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
26516 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
26517 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
26518 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
26519 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
26520
26521 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
26522 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
26523
26524 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
26525 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
26526 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
26527 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
26528 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
26529 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
26530
26531 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
26532 "Priority strings". This is online as
26533 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
26534 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
26535 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
26536 &url(http://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string, then the example code)
26537 on that site can be used to test a given string.
26538
26539 For example:
26540 .code
26541 # Disable older versions of protocols
26542 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
26543 .endd
26544
26545 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
26546 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
26547 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
26548
26549 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
26550 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
26551 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
26552 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
26553 used:
26554 .code
26555 # GnuTLS variant
26556 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
26557 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
26558 {SECURE128}}
26559 .endd
26560
26561
26562 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
26563 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
26564 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
26565 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
26566 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
26567 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
26568 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
26569 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
26570
26571 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
26572 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
26573 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
26574 with the error
26575 .code
26576 554 Security failure
26577 .endd
26578 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
26579 rejected with a 554 error code.
26580
26581 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
26582 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
26583 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
26584 without some further configuration at the server end.
26585
26586 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
26587 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
26588 .code
26589 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
26590 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
26591 .endd
26592 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
26593 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
26594 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
26595 that goes with it. These files need to be
26596 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
26597 always be given as full path names.
26598 The key must not be password-protected.
26599 They can be the same file if both the
26600 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
26601 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
26602 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
26603 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
26604 the server's certificate.
26605
26606 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
26607 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
26608 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
26609
26610 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
26611 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
26612 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
26613 transport.
26614
26615 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
26616 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
26617 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
26618 .code
26619 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
26620 .endd
26621 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
26622 with the parameters contained in the file.
26623 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
26624 available:
26625 .code
26626 tls_dhparam = none
26627 .endd
26628 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
26629 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
26630 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
26631 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
26632
26633 See the command
26634 .code
26635 openssl dhparam
26636 .endd
26637 for a way of generating file data.
26638
26639 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
26640 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
26641 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
26642 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
26643 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
26644
26645 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26646 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26647 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26648 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
26649 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
26650 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
26651 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
26652 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
26653 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
26654
26655 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
26656 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
26657 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
26658 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
26659 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
26660 documentation for more details.
26661
26662 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
26663 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
26664
26665
26666 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
26667 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26668 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26669 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
26670 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
26671 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
26672 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
26673 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
26674 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
26675 expected certificates.
26676 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26677 an explicit file or,
26678 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
26679 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
26680
26681 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
26682 directory is used
26683 (OpenSSL only),
26684 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
26685 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
26686 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
26687 .code
26688 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
26689 .endd
26690 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
26691
26692 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
26693 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
26694 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
26695 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
26696 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
26697 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
26698 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
26699 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
26700 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
26701 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
26702
26703 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
26704 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
26705 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
26706 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
26707
26708 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26709 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
26710 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
26711 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
26712 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
26713 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
26714
26715
26716 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
26717 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
26718 .cindex "revocation list"
26719 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
26720 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
26721 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
26722 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
26723 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
26724 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
26725 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
26726 CRL in PEM format.
26727 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
26728 file from every certificate authority they know of.
26729
26730 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
26731 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
26732 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
26733 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
26734 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
26735 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
26736
26737 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
26738 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
26739 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
26740 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
26741
26742 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
26743 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
26744 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
26745 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
26746 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
26747 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
26748 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
26749 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
26750
26751 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
26752 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.1.3,
26753 support for OCSP stapling is included.
26754
26755 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26756 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
26757 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
26758 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
26759 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
26760
26761 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
26762 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
26763 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
26764 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
26765 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
26766 next connection.
26767
26768 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
26769 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
26770 ignored.
26771
26772 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
26773 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
26774 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
26775 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
26776 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
26777 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
26778
26779 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
26780 not any of the chain from CA to it.
26781
26782 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
26783
26784 .code
26785 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
26786 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
26787 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
26788
26789 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
26790 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
26791 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
26792 .endd
26793
26794
26795
26796
26797 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
26798 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
26799 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
26800 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
26801 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
26802 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
26803 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
26804 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
26805 within the &(smtp)& transport.
26806
26807 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
26808 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
26809 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
26810 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
26811 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
26812
26813 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
26814 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
26815 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
26816 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
26817 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
26818 usual way.
26819
26820 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
26821 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
26822 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
26823 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
26824 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
26825 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
26826 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
26827 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
26828 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26829 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26830 unencrypted.
26831
26832 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
26833 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
26834 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
26835 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
26836
26837 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
26838 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
26839 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
26840 a file or,
26841 depending on library version, a directory,
26842 must name a file or,
26843 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory.
26844 The client verifies the server's certificate
26845 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
26846 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
26847 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
26848 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
26849
26850 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
26851 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
26852 or need not succeed respectively.
26853
26854 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
26855 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
26856 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
26857 value is empty.
26858 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
26859 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
26860 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
26861 otherwise.
26862
26863 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
26864 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
26865 for OCSP to be relevant.
26866
26867 If
26868 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
26869 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
26870 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
26871 alternative hosts, if any.
26872
26873 &*Note*&:
26874 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
26875 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
26876 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
26877 client.
26878
26879 .vindex "&$host$&"
26880 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26881 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
26882 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
26883 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
26884 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
26885
26886 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
26887 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
26888 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
26889 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
26890 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
26891 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
26892 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
26893 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
26894 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
26895 outgoing connection.
26896
26897
26898
26899 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
26900 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
26901 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
26902 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
26903 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
26904 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
26905 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
26906 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
26907 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
26908 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
26909 for this session.
26910
26911 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
26912 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
26913 address.
26914
26915 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
26916 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
26917 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
26918 be of limited use in that environment.
26919
26920 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
26921 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
26922 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
26923 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
26924 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
26925
26926 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
26927 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
26928 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
26929 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
26930 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
26931
26932 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
26933 received from a client.
26934 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
26935
26936 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
26937 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
26938 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
26939
26940 .ilist
26941 .vindex "&%tls_certificate%&"
26942 &%tls_certificate%&
26943 .next
26944 .vindex "&%tls_crl%&"
26945 &%tls_crl%&
26946 .next
26947 .vindex "&%tls_privatekey%&"
26948 &%tls_privatekey%&
26949 .next
26950 .vindex "&%tls_verify_certificates%&"
26951 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
26952 .next
26953 .vindex "&%tls_ocsp_file%&"
26954 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
26955 .endlist
26956
26957 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
26958 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
26959 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_sni$& is
26960 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
26961
26962 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
26963 are re-expanded.
26964
26965 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
26966 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
26967 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
26968 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
26969
26970 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
26971 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
26972 built, then you have SNI support).
26973
26974
26975
26976 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
26977 "SECTmulmessam"
26978 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
26979 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
26980 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
26981 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
26982 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
26983 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
26984 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
26985 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
26986 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
26987 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
26988 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
26989
26990 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
26991 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
26992 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
26993 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
26994 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
26995 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
26996 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
26997 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
26998 and delay other deliveries to that host.
26999
27000 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
27001 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
27002 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
27003 information is recorded.
27004
27005 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
27006 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
27007 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
27008
27009
27010
27011
27012 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
27013 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
27014 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
27015 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
27016 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
27017 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
27018 to Apache, currently at
27019 .display
27020 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
27021 .endd
27022 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
27023 links to further files.
27024 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
27025 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
27026 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
27027 .display
27028 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
27029 .endd
27030
27031
27032 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
27033 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
27034 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
27035 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
27036 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
27037 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
27038 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
27039 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
27040 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
27041 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
27042 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
27043 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
27044 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
27045
27046 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
27047 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
27048 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
27049 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
27050
27051
27052
27053 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
27054 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
27055 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
27056 with OpenSSL, like this:
27057 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
27058 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
27059 .code
27060 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
27061 -days 9999 -nodes
27062 .endd
27063 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
27064 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
27065 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
27066 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
27067 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
27068 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
27069 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
27070
27071 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
27072 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
27073 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
27074 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
27075 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
27076 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
27077 . ==== -pdp, 2012
27078 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
27079 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
27080 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
27081 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
27082 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
27083 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
27084 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
27085 be a sensible resolution).
27086
27087 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
27088 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
27089 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
27090
27091 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
27092 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
27093 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
27094 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
27095 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
27096 signed with that self-signed certificate.
27097
27098 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
27099 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
27100 Open-source PKI book, available online at
27101 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
27102 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
27103 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
27104
27105
27106
27107 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27108 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27109
27110 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
27111 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
27112 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
27113 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
27114 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
27115 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
27116 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
27117 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
27118 one very small ACL:
27119 .code
27120 begin acl
27121 small_acl:
27122 accept hosts = one.host.only
27123 .endd
27124 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
27125 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
27126
27127 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
27128 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
27129 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
27130 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
27131 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
27132 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
27133 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
27134 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27135
27136
27137 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
27138 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
27139 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27140 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
27141 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
27142
27143
27144
27145 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
27146 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
27147 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
27148 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
27149 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
27150 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27151 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
27152 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
27153 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27154 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27155 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
27156 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
27157 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27158 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
27159 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
27160 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
27161 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27162 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27163 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
27164 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27165
27166 .table2 140pt
27167 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
27168 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
27169 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
27170 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
27171 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
27172 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
27173 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
27174 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
27175 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
27176 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
27177 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
27178 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
27179 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
27180 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
27181 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
27182 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
27183 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
27184 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
27185 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
27186 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
27187 .endtable
27188
27189 For example, if you set
27190 .code
27191 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
27192 .endd
27193 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
27194 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
27195 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
27196 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
27197 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
27198 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
27199 testing as possible at RCPT time.
27200
27201
27202 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
27203 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
27204 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
27205 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
27206 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
27207 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
27208 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
27209 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
27210 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
27211 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
27212 in any of these ACLs.
27213
27214 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
27215 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
27216 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
27217 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
27218 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
27219 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
27220 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
27221 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
27222 .code
27223 control = suppress_local_fixups
27224 .endd
27225 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
27226 run, it is too late.
27227
27228 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27229 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27230
27231 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
27232 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
27233 temporary error for these kinds of message.
27234
27235
27236 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
27237 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
27238 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
27239 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
27240 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
27241 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
27242 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
27243 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
27244 &%smtp_banner%& option.
27245
27246
27247 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
27248 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
27249 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
27250 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
27251 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
27252 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
27253 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
27254 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
27255 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
27256
27257 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
27258 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
27259 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
27260 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
27261 an EHLO response.
27262
27263
27264 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
27265 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
27266 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
27267 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
27268 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
27269 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
27270 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
27271 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
27272 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
27273 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
27274
27275 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
27276 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
27277 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
27278 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
27279 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
27280 associated with the DATA command.
27281
27282 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
27283 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
27284 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
27285 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
27286 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
27287 your resources.
27288
27289 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
27290 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
27291 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
27292 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
27293
27294 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
27295 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
27296 enabled (which is the default).
27297
27298 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
27299 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
27300 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
27301
27302 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27303
27304 For details on the operation of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
27305
27306
27307 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
27308 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
27309 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
27310
27311 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27312
27313
27314 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
27315 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
27316 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
27317 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
27318 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
27319 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
27320 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
27321 has been accepted.
27322
27323 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
27324 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
27325 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
27326 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
27327 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
27328 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
27329 for some or all recipients.
27330
27331 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
27332 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
27333 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
27334 for this can be disabled when the MAIL-time $smtp_command included
27335 "PRDR". Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
27336 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
27337 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
27338
27339 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
27340 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
27341
27342 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
27343 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
27344 the feature was not requested by the client.
27345
27346 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
27347 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
27348 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
27349 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
27350 does not in fact control any access.
27351 For this reason, it may only accept
27352 or warn as its final result.
27353
27354 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
27355 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
27356 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
27357 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
27358
27359 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
27360 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
27361
27362 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
27363 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
27364 response to QUIT.
27365
27366 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
27367 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
27368 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
27369 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
27370 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
27371
27372
27373 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
27374 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
27375 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
27376 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
27377 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
27378 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
27379 situation even worse.
27380
27381 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
27382 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
27383 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
27384 and &%warn%&.
27385
27386 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
27387 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
27388 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
27389 connection. The possible values are:
27390 .table2
27391 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
27392 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
27393 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
27394 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
27395 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
27396 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
27397 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
27398 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
27399 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
27400 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
27401 .endtable
27402 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
27403 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
27404 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
27405 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
27406 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
27407 used.
27408
27409
27410 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
27411 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
27412 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
27413 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
27414 .code
27415 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
27416 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
27417 .endd
27418 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
27419 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
27420 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
27421 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
27422 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
27423
27424 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
27425 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
27426 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
27427
27428 .ilist
27429 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
27430 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
27431 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
27432 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
27433 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
27434 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
27435 .code
27436 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
27437 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
27438 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
27439 .endd
27440 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
27441 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
27442 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
27443 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
27444 .next
27445 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
27446 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
27447 matches the string.
27448 .next
27449 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
27450 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
27451 want to have something like
27452 .code
27453 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
27454 .endd
27455 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
27456 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
27457 .endlist
27458
27459
27460
27461
27462 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
27463 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
27464 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
27465 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
27466 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
27467 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
27468 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
27469 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
27470 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
27471
27472 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
27473 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
27474 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
27475
27476
27477 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
27478 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
27479 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
27480 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
27481
27482 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
27483 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
27484 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
27485 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
27486 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
27487 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
27488 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
27489
27490
27491 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
27492 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
27493 recipients; it may create new recipients.
27494
27495
27496
27497 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
27498 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
27499 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
27500 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
27501 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
27502 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
27503
27504 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
27505 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
27506 used to accept or reject anything.
27507
27508 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
27509 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
27510 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
27511 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
27512
27513 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
27514 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
27515 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
27516 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
27517 configuration file.
27518
27519
27520
27521
27522 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
27523 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
27524 .vindex &$domain$&
27525 .vindex &$local_part$&
27526 .vindex &$sender_address$&
27527 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
27528 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27529 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
27530 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
27531 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
27532 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
27533 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
27534 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27535
27536 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
27537 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
27538 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
27539 how it is used.
27540
27541 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
27542 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
27543 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
27544 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
27545 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
27546 received).
27547
27548 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
27549 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
27550 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
27551 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
27552 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
27553 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
27554 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
27555 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
27556
27557
27558
27559
27560
27561 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
27562 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
27563 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
27564 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
27565 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
27566 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
27567 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
27568 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
27569 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
27570 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
27571 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
27572 unencrypted connections.
27573 .code
27574 acl_check_auth:
27575 accept encrypted = *
27576 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
27577 {CRAM-MD5}}
27578 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
27579 .endd
27580 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
27581 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
27582 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
27583 option to do this.)
27584
27585
27586
27587 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
27588 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
27589 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
27590 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
27591 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
27592 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
27593 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
27594
27595 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
27596 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
27597 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
27598 example:
27599 .code
27600 deny dnslists = list1.example
27601 dnslists = list2.example
27602 .endd
27603 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
27604 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
27605 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
27606 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
27607 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
27608
27609
27610 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
27611 The ACL verbs are as follows:
27612
27613 .ilist
27614 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
27615 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
27616 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
27617 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
27618 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
27619 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
27620 check a RCPT command:
27621 .code
27622 accept domains = +local_domains
27623 endpass
27624 verify = recipient
27625 .endd
27626 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
27627 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
27628 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
27629 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
27630 &%endpass%&.
27631
27632 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
27633 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
27634 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
27635 configuration.
27636
27637 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
27638 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
27639 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
27640 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
27641 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
27642 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
27643 .display
27644 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
27645 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
27646 .endd
27647 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
27648 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
27649 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
27650
27651 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
27652 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
27653 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
27654 of &%endpass%&.
27655
27656
27657 .next
27658 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
27659 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
27660 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
27661 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
27662 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
27663 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
27664 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
27665
27666
27667 .next
27668 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
27669 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
27670 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
27671 example,
27672 .code
27673 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
27674 .endd
27675 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
27676
27677
27678 .next
27679 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
27680 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
27681 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
27682 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
27683 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
27684 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
27685 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
27686 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
27687 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
27688
27689 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
27690 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
27691 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
27692
27693
27694 .next
27695 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
27696 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
27697 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
27698 .code
27699 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
27700 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
27701 .endd
27702 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
27703 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
27704
27705 .next
27706 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
27707 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
27708 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
27709 example, when checking a RCPT command,
27710 .code
27711 require message = Sender did not verify
27712 verify = sender
27713 .endd
27714 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
27715 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
27716 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
27717 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
27718
27719 .next
27720 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
27721 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
27722 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
27723 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
27724 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
27725 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
27726 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
27727
27728 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
27729 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
27730 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
27731 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
27732 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27733
27734 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
27735 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
27736 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
27737 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
27738 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
27739 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
27740 onwards.
27741
27742
27743 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27744 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
27745 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
27746 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
27747 .code
27748 warn !verify = sender
27749 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
27750 .endd
27751 .endlist
27752
27753 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
27754
27755 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
27756 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
27757 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
27758 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
27759 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
27760
27761
27762
27763 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
27764 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
27765 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
27766 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
27767 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
27768 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
27769 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
27770 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
27771 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
27772 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
27773 .ilist
27774 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
27775 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
27776 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
27777 on the same SMTP connection.
27778 .next
27779 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
27780 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
27781 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
27782 .endlist
27783
27784 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
27785 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
27786 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
27787 .code
27788 accept hosts = whatever
27789 set acl_m4 = some value
27790 accept authenticated = *
27791 set acl_c_auth = yes
27792 .endd
27793 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
27794 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
27795 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
27796
27797 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
27798 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
27799 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
27800 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
27801 error is generated.
27802
27803 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
27804 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
27805
27806
27807 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
27808 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
27809 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
27810 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
27811 .code
27812 deny domains = *.dom.example
27813 !verify = recipient
27814 .endd
27815 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
27816 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
27817 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
27818 two statements are equivalent:
27819 .code
27820 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
27821 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
27822 .endd
27823 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
27824 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
27825
27826 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
27827 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
27828 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
27829 .code
27830 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27831 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
27832 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
27833 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
27834 .endd
27835 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
27836 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
27837 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
27838 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
27839 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
27840 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
27841 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
27842
27843 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
27844 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
27845 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
27846 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
27847 message is handled.
27848
27849 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
27850 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
27851 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
27852 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
27853 .code
27854 require message = Can't verify sender
27855 verify = sender
27856 message = Can't verify recipient
27857 verify = recipient
27858 message = This message cannot be used
27859 .endd
27860 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
27861 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
27862 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
27863 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
27864 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
27865 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
27866
27867 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
27868 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
27869 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
27870 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
27871 .code
27872 deny hosts = ...
27873 !senders = *@my.domain.example
27874 message = Invalid sender from client host
27875 .endd
27876 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
27877 by which time Exim has set up the message.
27878
27879
27880
27881 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
27882 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
27883 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
27884
27885 .vlist
27886 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27887 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
27888 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
27889 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
27890
27891 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27892 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
27893 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
27894 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
27895 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
27896 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
27897 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
27898 write rather ugly lines like this:
27899 .display
27900 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
27901 .endd
27902 Instead, all you need is
27903 .display
27904 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
27905 .endd
27906
27907 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
27908 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
27909 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
27910 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
27911 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
27912 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
27913 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
27914 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
27915
27916 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
27917 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
27918 in several different ways. For example:
27919
27920 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
27921 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
27922 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
27923 . ==== way.
27924
27925 .ilist
27926 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
27927 .code
27928 accept ...some conditions
27929 control = queue_only
27930 .endd
27931 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
27932 other words, when the conditions are all true.
27933
27934 .next
27935 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
27936 .code
27937 accept ...some conditions...
27938 control = queue_only
27939 ...some more conditions...
27940 .endd
27941 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
27942 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
27943 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
27944 to be relevant.
27945
27946 .next
27947 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
27948 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
27949 example:
27950 .code
27951 warn ...some conditions...
27952 control = freeze
27953 accept ...
27954 .endd
27955 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
27956 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
27957 log entry.
27958
27959 .next
27960 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
27961 &%require%& verb. For example:
27962 .code
27963 require control = no_multiline_responses
27964 .endd
27965 .endlist
27966
27967 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
27968 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
27969 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
27970 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
27971 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
27972 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
27973 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
27974 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
27975 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
27976
27977 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
27978 example:
27979 .code
27980 deny ...some conditions...
27981 delay = 30s
27982 .endd
27983 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
27984 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
27985 .code
27986 deny delay = 30s
27987 ...some conditions...
27988 .endd
27989 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
27990 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
27991 .code
27992 warn ...some conditions...
27993 delay = 2m
27994 control = freeze
27995 accept ...
27996 .endd
27997
27998 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
27999 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
28000 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
28001 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
28002 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
28003 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
28004 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
28005
28006
28007 .vitem &*endpass*&
28008 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
28009 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
28010 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
28011 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
28012 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
28013 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
28014 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
28015
28016
28017 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28018 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
28019 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
28020 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
28021 .code
28022 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
28023 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
28024 .endd
28025 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
28026 example:
28027 .display
28028 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
28029 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
28030 .endd
28031 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
28032 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
28033 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
28034 message.
28035
28036 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
28037 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
28038 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
28039 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
28040 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
28041 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
28042 ignored.
28043
28044 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28045 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
28046 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
28047 error message.
28048
28049 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
28050 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
28051 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
28052 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
28053 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
28054 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
28055
28056 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
28057 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
28058 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
28059 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
28060 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
28061 logging rejections.
28062
28063
28064 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
28065 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
28066 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
28067 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
28068 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
28069 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
28070 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
28071 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
28072 .display
28073 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
28074 &` log_reject_target =`&
28075 .endd
28076 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
28077 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
28078 current ACL.
28079
28080
28081 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28082 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
28083 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
28084 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
28085 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
28086 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
28087 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
28088 ACLs. For example:
28089 .display
28090 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
28091 &` control = freeze`&
28092 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
28093 .endd
28094 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
28095 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
28096 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
28097 example:
28098 .code
28099 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
28100 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
28101 .endd
28102
28103
28104 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28105 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
28106 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
28107 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
28108 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
28109 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
28110 &%accept%& for details.)
28111
28112 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
28113 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
28114 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
28115 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
28116 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
28117 .code
28118 require message = Host not recognized
28119 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
28120 .endd
28121 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
28122 processed.)
28123
28124 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
28125 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
28126 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
28127 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
28128 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
28129 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
28130 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
28131 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
28132 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
28133 EHLO options.
28134
28135 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
28136 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
28137 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
28138 .code
28139 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
28140 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
28141 .endd
28142 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
28143 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
28144 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
28145 2&'xx'&.
28146
28147 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
28148 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
28149
28150 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
28151 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
28152 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
28153 response.
28154
28155 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
28156 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
28157 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
28158
28159 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
28160 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
28161 However, the original message is available in the variable
28162 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
28163 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
28164 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
28165 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
28166
28167 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
28168 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
28169 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
28170 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
28171 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
28172 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
28173 effect.
28174
28175
28176 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
28177 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
28178 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
28179 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
28180
28181
28182 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
28183 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
28184 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
28185 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
28186
28187
28188 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
28189 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
28190 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
28191 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
28192 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
28193 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
28194 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
28195 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
28196 when:
28197 .code
28198 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
28199 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
28200 .endd
28201 .endlist
28202
28203
28204
28205
28206 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
28207 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
28208 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
28209
28210 .vlist
28211 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
28212 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
28213 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
28214 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
28215 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
28216 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
28217 not work without it. For example:
28218 .code
28219 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
28220 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
28221 .endd
28222 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
28223 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
28224 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
28225 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
28226 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
28227
28228
28229 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
28230 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
28231 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
28232 .cindex "case of local parts"
28233 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
28234 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
28235 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
28236 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
28237 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
28238 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
28239 is encountered.
28240
28241 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
28242 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
28243 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
28244 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
28245 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
28246
28247 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
28248 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
28249 spam score:
28250 .code
28251 warn control = caseful_local_part
28252 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
28253 $acl_m4 + \
28254 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
28255 }
28256 control = caselower_local_part
28257 .endd
28258 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
28259 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
28260
28261
28262 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery*&
28263 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
28264 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
28265 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
28266
28267 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
28268 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
28269 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
28270 is used for all recipients of the message,
28271 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
28272 and data is copied from one to the other.
28273
28274 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
28275 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
28276 If a recipient-verify callout connection is subsequently
28277 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
28278 any subsequent recipients and the data,
28279 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
28280
28281 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
28282 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
28283 Note also that headers cannot be
28284 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
28285 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
28286
28287 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
28288 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
28289 before the entire message has been received from the source.
28290 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR option in use.
28291
28292 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
28293 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
28294 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
28295 usual fashion. If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
28296 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
28297 before the acceptance "<=" line.
28298
28299 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
28300 (possibly faked)
28301 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
28302
28303
28304 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
28305 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
28306 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
28307 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
28308 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
28309 &'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
28310 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
28311 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
28312 option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
28313 contexts):
28314 .code
28315 control = debug
28316 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
28317 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
28318 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
28319 .endd
28320
28321
28322 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
28323 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
28324 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
28325 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
28326 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see chapter &<<CHAPdkim>>&.
28327
28328
28329 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
28330 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
28331 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
28332 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
28333 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
28334 strings or to numeric value.
28335 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
28336 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
28337 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
28338
28339 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
28340 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
28341 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
28342 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
28343 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
28344
28345
28346 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
28347 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
28348 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
28349 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
28350 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
28351 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
28352 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
28353 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
28354
28355 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
28356 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
28357 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
28358 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
28359 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
28360 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
28361 work with.
28362
28363
28364 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
28365 .cindex "fake defer"
28366 .cindex "defer, fake"
28367 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
28368 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
28369 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
28370 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
28371 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
28372
28373 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
28374 .cindex "fake rejection"
28375 .cindex "rejection, fake"
28376 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
28377 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
28378 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
28379 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
28380 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28381 the same SMTP connection.
28382
28383 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
28384 message is supplied, the following is used:
28385 .code
28386 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
28387 550-kept for evaluation.
28388 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
28389 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
28390 .endd
28391 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
28392
28393 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
28394 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
28395 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28396 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28397 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
28398 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
28399 SMTP connection.
28400
28401 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
28402 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
28403 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
28404 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
28405
28406 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
28407 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
28408 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
28409 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28410 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
28411 disables such output flushing.
28412
28413 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
28414 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
28415 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
28416 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
28417 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
28418 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
28419
28420 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
28421 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
28422 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
28423 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
28424 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
28425 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
28426 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
28427 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
28428 to be useful in production.
28429
28430 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
28431 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
28432 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
28433 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
28434 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
28435
28436 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
28437 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
28438 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
28439 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
28440 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
28441 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
28442
28443 .ilist
28444 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
28445 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
28446 verification failed"&) is sent.
28447 .next
28448 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
28449 line is output.
28450 .endlist
28451
28452 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
28453 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
28454
28455 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
28456 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
28457 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
28458 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
28459 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
28460 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
28461 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
28462
28463 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
28464 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
28465 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
28466 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
28467 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
28468 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
28469 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
28470 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
28471 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
28472 same SMTP connection.
28473
28474 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
28475 .cindex "message" "submission"
28476 .cindex "submission mode"
28477 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
28478 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
28479 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
28480 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
28481 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
28482 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
28483 late (the message has already been created).
28484
28485 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
28486 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
28487 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
28488 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
28489 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
28490
28491 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
28492 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
28493 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
28494 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
28495 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
28496
28497 .ilist
28498 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
28499 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
28500 .next
28501 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
28502 .next
28503 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
28504 .endlist ilist
28505
28506 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
28507 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
28508 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
28509 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
28510 data is read.
28511
28512 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
28513 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
28514 .endlist vlist
28515
28516
28517 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
28518 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
28519
28520 .ilist
28521 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
28522 .next
28523 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
28524 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
28525 .next
28526 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
28527 .next
28528 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
28529 .endlist
28530
28531
28532
28533 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
28534 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
28535 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
28536 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
28537 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
28538 to an incoming message, as in this example:
28539 .code
28540 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
28541 dialup.mail-abuse.org
28542 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
28543 .endd
28544 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28545 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28546 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28547 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
28548 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
28549 RCPT ACL).
28550
28551 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
28552 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28553
28554 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
28555 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
28556 contains one or more newlines that
28557 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
28558 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
28559 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
28560
28561 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28562 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28563 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
28564 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
28565 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
28566 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
28567 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
28568 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
28569 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
28570 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
28571 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
28572
28573 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
28574 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
28575 of message headers
28576 until they are added to the
28577 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
28578 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
28579 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
28580 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
28581 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
28582 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
28583 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28584
28585 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
28586
28587 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28588 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28589 .display
28590 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28591 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28592
28593 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28594 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
28595 .endd
28596 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
28597 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
28598 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
28599 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
28600 honoured.
28601
28602 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
28603 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
28604 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
28605 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
28606 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
28607 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
28608 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
28609 specifications.
28610
28611 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
28612 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
28613 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
28614 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
28615 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
28616
28617 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
28618 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
28619 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
28620 to be a header name first.) For example:
28621 .code
28622 warn add_header = \
28623 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
28624 .endd
28625 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
28626 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
28627 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
28628 up in reverse order.
28629
28630 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28631 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
28632 system filter or in a router or transport.
28633
28634
28635
28636 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
28637 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
28638 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
28639 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
28640 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
28641 from an incoming message, as in this example:
28642 .code
28643 warn message = Remove internal headers
28644 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28645 .endd
28646 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
28647 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
28648 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
28649 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
28650 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
28651 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
28652
28653 Headers will not be removed to the message if the modifier is used in
28654 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for messages delivered by cutthrough routing.
28655
28656 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
28657 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
28658 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
28659 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
28660 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
28661 .code
28662 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
28663 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
28664 warn message = Remove internal headers
28665 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
28666 .endd
28667 Removed header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
28668 They are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
28669 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor is removing
28670 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
28671 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
28672 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
28673 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
28674 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
28675 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
28676 would have been removed.
28677
28678 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
28679 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
28680 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
28681 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
28682 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
28683 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
28684 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
28685 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
28686 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
28687
28688 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
28689 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
28690 .display
28691 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
28692 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
28693
28694 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
28695 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
28696 .endd
28697 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
28698 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
28699 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
28700 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
28701 are honoured.
28702
28703 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
28704 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
28705 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
28706
28707
28708
28709
28710 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
28711 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
28712 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
28713 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
28714 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
28715 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28716
28717 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
28718 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
28719 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
28720 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
28721 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
28722 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
28723 The conditions are as follows:
28724
28725
28726 .vlist
28727 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
28728 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
28729 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
28730 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
28731 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
28732 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
28733 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
28734 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
28735 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
28736 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
28737 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
28738 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
28739
28740 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
28741 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
28742 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
28743 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
28744 The name and values are expanded separately.
28745 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
28746 will act as argument separators.
28747
28748 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
28749 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
28750 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
28751 conditions are tested.
28752
28753 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
28754 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
28755 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
28756 for different local users or different local domains.
28757
28758 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28759 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
28760 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
28761 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
28762 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
28763 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
28764 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
28765 .code
28766 authenticated = *
28767 .endd
28768
28769 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
28770 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
28771 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
28772 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
28773 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
28774 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
28775 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
28776 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
28777 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
28778 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
28779 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
28780 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
28781 negative.
28782
28783 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
28784 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
28785 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28786 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28787 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
28788 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
28789 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
28790 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28791
28792 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
28793 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
28794 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28795 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
28796 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
28797
28798 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
28799 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
28800 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
28801 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
28802 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
28803 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
28804 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
28805 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
28806 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
28807 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
28808
28809 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28810 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
28811 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
28812 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
28813 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
28814 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
28815 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
28816 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
28817 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
28818 &%domains%& test.
28819
28820 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
28821 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
28822
28823
28824 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
28825 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
28826 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
28827 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
28828 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
28829 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
28830 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
28831 .code
28832 encrypted = *
28833 .endd
28834
28835
28836 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
28837 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
28838 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
28839 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
28840 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
28841 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
28842 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
28843 .code
28844 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28845 .endd
28846 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
28847 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
28848 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
28849
28850 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
28851 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
28852 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
28853 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
28854 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
28855 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
28856
28857 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
28858 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
28859 .code
28860 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
28861 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
28862 .endd
28863 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
28864 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
28865 statement can then check the IP address.
28866
28867 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
28868 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
28869 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
28870 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
28871 .code
28872 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
28873 message = $host_data
28874 .endd
28875 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
28876
28877 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
28878 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
28879 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
28880 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
28881 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
28882 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
28883 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
28884 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
28885 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
28886 the next &%local_parts%& test.
28887
28888 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
28889 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
28890 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
28891 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
28892 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28893 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
28894 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28895
28896 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
28897 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
28898 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
28899 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28900 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
28901 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
28902 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
28903 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28904
28905 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
28906 .cindex "rate limiting"
28907 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
28908 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
28909
28910 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
28911 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
28912 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
28913 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
28914 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
28915 recipient address against a list of recipients.
28916
28917 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
28918 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
28919 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
28920 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28921 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
28922 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
28923 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28924
28925 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
28926 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
28927 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
28928 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
28929 .vindex "&$domain$&"
28930 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
28931 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
28932 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
28933 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
28934 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
28935 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
28936 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
28937 influence the sender checking.
28938
28939 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
28940 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
28941
28942 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
28943 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
28944 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
28945 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
28946 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
28947 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
28948 .code
28949 senders = :
28950 .endd
28951 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
28952 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
28953
28954 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
28955 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
28956 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
28957 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28958 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
28959 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28960
28961 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
28962 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28963 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28964 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28965 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
28966 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
28967 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
28968 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
28969 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
28970 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
28971
28972 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
28973 .cindex "CSA verification"
28974 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
28975 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
28976 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
28977
28978 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
28979 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28980 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
28981 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
28982 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
28983 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
28984 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
28985 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
28986 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
28987 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
28988
28989 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
28990 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
28991 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
28992
28993 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
28994 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
28995 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
28996 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
28997 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
28998 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
28999 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29000 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29001 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
29002 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
29003 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
29004 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
29005 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
29006 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
29007 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
29008
29009 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
29010 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
29011 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
29012 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
29013 .code
29014 deny senders = :
29015 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
29016 !verify = header_sender
29017 .endd
29018
29019 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
29020 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29021 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
29022 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
29023 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
29024 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
29025 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
29026 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
29027 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
29028 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
29029 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
29030 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
29031 appropriate.
29032
29033 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
29034 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
29035 .code
29036 To: @
29037 .endd
29038 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
29039 common as they used to be.
29040
29041 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
29042 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29043 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
29044 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
29045 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
29046 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
29047 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
29048 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
29049 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
29050 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
29051 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
29052 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
29053 independently of this condition.
29054
29055 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
29056 option), this condition is always true.
29057
29058
29059 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
29060 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
29061 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
29062 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
29063 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
29064 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
29065 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
29066 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
29067 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
29068
29069 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
29070 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
29071
29072
29073 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
29074 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29075 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
29076 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
29077 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
29078 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29079 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
29080 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
29081 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
29082 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
29083 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
29084 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
29085 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
29086 value for the child address.
29087
29088 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
29089 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29090 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
29091 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
29092 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
29093 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
29094 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
29095 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
29096 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
29097 original IP address.
29098
29099 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
29100 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
29101
29102 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
29103 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
29104
29105 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
29106 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29107 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
29108 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
29109 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
29110 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
29111 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
29112 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
29113 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
29114
29115 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
29116 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
29117 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
29118 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
29119 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
29120 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
29121 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
29122
29123 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
29124 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
29125 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
29126
29127 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
29128 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
29129 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
29130 verified as a sender.
29131 .endlist
29132
29133
29134
29135 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
29136 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
29137 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
29138 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
29139 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
29140 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
29141 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
29142 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
29143 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
29144 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
29145 .code
29146 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
29147 dialups.mail-abuse.org
29148 .endd
29149 the following records are looked up:
29150 .code
29151 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29152 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
29153 .endd
29154 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
29155 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
29156 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
29157 use two separate conditions:
29158 .code
29159 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29160 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29161 .endd
29162 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
29163 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
29164 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
29165 processed.
29166
29167 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
29168 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
29169 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
29170 following special items in the list:
29171 .display
29172 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
29173 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
29174 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
29175 .endd
29176 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
29177 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
29178 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
29179 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
29180 .code
29181 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
29182 .endd
29183 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
29184 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
29185 .code
29186 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29187 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
29188 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
29189 .endd
29190 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
29191 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
29192 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
29193 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
29194
29195
29196
29197 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
29198 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
29199 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
29200 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
29201 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
29202 .code
29203 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
29204 .endd
29205 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
29206 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
29207 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
29208 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
29209
29210
29211
29212
29213 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
29214 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
29215 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
29216 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
29217 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
29218 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
29219 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
29220 .code
29221 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
29222 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29223 .endd
29224 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
29225 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
29226 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
29227 up by this example is
29228 .code
29229 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
29230 .endd
29231 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
29232 addresses. For example:
29233 .code
29234 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29235 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
29236 .endd
29237 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
29238 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
29239
29240
29241
29242
29243 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
29244 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
29245 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
29246 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
29247 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
29248 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
29249 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
29250 either to double the separators like this:
29251 .code
29252 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
29253 .endd
29254 or to change the separator character, like this:
29255 .code
29256 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
29257 .endd
29258 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
29259 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
29260 occurs. Consider this condition:
29261 .code
29262 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
29263 .endd
29264 The DNS lookups that occur are:
29265 .code
29266 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
29267 a.domain.black.list.tld
29268 .endd
29269 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
29270 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
29271 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
29272 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
29273 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
29274 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
29275 error for a previous item.
29276
29277 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
29278 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
29279 .code
29280 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
29281 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
29282 .endd
29283 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
29284 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
29285 .code
29286 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
29287 $sender_address_domain \
29288 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
29289 see $dnslist_text.
29290 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
29291 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
29292 $sender_address_domain} }} }
29293 .endd
29294 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
29295 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
29296 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
29297 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
29298 .code
29299 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
29300 .endd
29301 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
29302 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
29303
29304 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
29305 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
29306
29307
29308
29309
29310 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
29311 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
29312 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
29313 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
29314 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
29315 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
29316 .display
29317 127.1.0.1 RBL
29318 127.1.0.2 DUL
29319 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
29320 127.1.0.4 RSS
29321 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
29322 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
29323 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
29324 .endd
29325 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
29326 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
29327 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
29328
29329
29330 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
29331 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
29332 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
29333 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
29334 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
29335 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
29336 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
29337 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
29338 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
29339 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
29340 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
29341 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
29342 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
29343 cases, for example:
29344 .code
29345 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
29346 .endd
29347 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
29348 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
29349 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
29350 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
29351 .code
29352 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
29353 .endd
29354 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
29355 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
29356
29357 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
29358 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
29359 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
29360 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
29361 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
29362 information.
29363
29364 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
29365 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
29366 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
29367 .code
29368 deny hosts = !+local_networks
29369 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
29370 at $dnslist_domain
29371 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
29372 .endd
29373
29374
29375
29376 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
29377 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
29378 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
29379 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
29380 For example,
29381 .code
29382 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
29383 .endd
29384 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
29385 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
29386 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
29387 describes how multiple records are handled.
29388
29389 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
29390 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
29391 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
29392 .code
29393 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29394 .endd
29395 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
29396 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
29397 first. For example:
29398 .code
29399 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
29400 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
29401 .endd
29402
29403 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
29404 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
29405 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
29406 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
29407 tested. For example:
29408 .code
29409 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
29410 .endd
29411 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
29412 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
29413 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
29414 .code
29415 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29416 .endd
29417 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
29418 an odd number.
29419
29420
29421
29422 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
29423 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
29424 condition. Whereas
29425 .code
29426 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29427 .endd
29428 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29429 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
29430 .code
29431 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29432 .endd
29433 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
29434 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
29435 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
29436 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
29437
29438 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
29439 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
29440
29441 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
29442 previous example is precisely equivalent to
29443 .code
29444 deny dnslists = a.b.c
29445 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
29446 .endd
29447 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
29448 Consider this example:
29449 .code
29450 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29451 list.dsbl.org : \
29452 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
29453 relays.ordb.org
29454 .endd
29455 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
29456 .code
29457 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29458 list.dsbl.org
29459 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
29460 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
29461 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
29462 .endd
29463 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
29464
29465
29466
29467
29468 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
29469 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
29470 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
29471 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
29472 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
29473 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
29474 .code
29475 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
29476 .endd
29477 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
29478 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
29479 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
29480 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
29481 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
29482 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
29483
29484 .ilist
29485 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
29486 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
29487 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29488 .next
29489 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
29490 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
29491 changed to:
29492 .code
29493 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
29494 .endd
29495 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29496 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
29497 .code
29498 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
29499 .endd
29500 for the condition to be true.
29501 .endlist
29502
29503 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
29504 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
29505 .ilist
29506 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
29507 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
29508 .code
29509 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
29510 .endd
29511 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29512 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
29513 .next
29514 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
29515 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
29516 .code
29517 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
29518 .endd
29519 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
29520 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
29521 .code
29522 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
29523 .endd
29524 for the condition to be false.
29525 .endlist
29526 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
29527 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
29528
29529
29530
29531
29532 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
29533 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
29534 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
29535 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
29536 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
29537 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
29538 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
29539 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
29540 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
29541 lists.
29542
29543 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
29544 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
29545 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
29546 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
29547 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
29548 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
29549 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
29550 .code
29551 reject message = \
29552 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
29553 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
29554 dnslists = \
29555 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
29556 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29557 .endd
29558 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
29559 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
29560 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
29561 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
29562 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
29563 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
29564
29565 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
29566 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
29567 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
29568 .code
29569 reject dnslists = \
29570 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
29571 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
29572 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
29573 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
29574 .endd
29575 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
29576 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
29577 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
29578
29579
29580
29581 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
29582 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
29583 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
29584 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
29585 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
29586 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
29587 .code
29588 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
29589 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29590 .endd
29591 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
29592 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
29593 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
29594 .code
29595 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
29596 .endd
29597 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
29598 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
29599
29600 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
29601 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
29602 .code
29603 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
29604 dnslists = some.list.example
29605 .endd
29606
29607 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
29608 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
29609 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
29610 .code
29611 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
29612 .endd
29613
29614 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
29615 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
29616 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
29617 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
29618 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
29619 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
29620 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
29621 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
29622 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
29623 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
29624 .display
29625 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
29626 .endd
29627 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
29628 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
29629
29630 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
29631 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
29632 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
29633 of &'p'&.
29634
29635 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
29636 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
29637 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
29638 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
29639 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
29640 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
29641 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
29642 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
29643 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
29644
29645 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
29646 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
29647 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
29648 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
29649
29650 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
29651 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
29652 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
29653 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
29654 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
29655 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
29656 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
29657 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
29658 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
29659 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
29660
29661 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
29662 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
29663 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
29664 ACL.
29665
29666 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
29667 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
29668 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
29669 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
29670 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
29671 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
29672
29673 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
29674 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
29675 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
29676 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
29677 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
29678 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
29679 the &%count=%& option.
29680
29681
29682 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
29683 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
29684 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
29685 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
29686 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
29687
29688 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
29689 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
29690 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
29691 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
29692
29693 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
29694 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
29695 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
29696 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
29697 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
29698 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
29699 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
29700
29701 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
29702 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29703 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
29704 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
29705 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
29706 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
29707 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
29708
29709 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
29710 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
29711 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
29712 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
29713 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
29714
29715 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
29716 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
29717 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
29718 multiple different commands.
29719
29720 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
29721 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
29722 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
29723 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
29724 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
29725
29726 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
29727
29728
29729 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
29730 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
29731 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
29732 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
29733 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
29734
29735 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
29736 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
29737
29738 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
29739 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
29740 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
29741 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
29742 new rate.
29743 .code
29744 acl_check_connect:
29745 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
29746 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29747 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29748 # ...
29749 acl_check_mail:
29750 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
29751 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
29752 (max $sender_rate_limit)
29753 .endd
29754
29755 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
29756 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
29757 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
29758 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
29759 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
29760 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
29761 checks.
29762
29763 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
29764 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
29765 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
29766 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
29767 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
29768
29769
29770 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
29771 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
29772 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
29773 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
29774 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
29775 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
29776 rest of the ACL.
29777
29778 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
29779 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
29780 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
29781 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
29782 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
29783 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
29784 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
29785 For example, it does not prevent a sender with an over-aggressive retry rate
29786 from getting any email through.
29787
29788 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
29789 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
29790 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
29791 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
29792 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
29793 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
29794 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
29795 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
29796 .code
29797 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
29798 .endd
29799
29800
29801 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
29802 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
29803 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
29804 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
29805 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
29806 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
29807 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
29808 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
29809 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
29810
29811 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
29812 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
29813 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
29814 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
29815 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
29816 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
29817
29818 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
29819 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
29820 rate.
29821
29822 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
29823 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
29824 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
29825 required increases with larger limits.
29826
29827 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
29828 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
29829 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
29830 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
29831 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
29832 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
29833 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
29834 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
29835 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
29836 as intended.
29837
29838
29839 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
29840 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
29841 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
29842 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
29843 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
29844 message. For example:
29845 .code
29846 # Log all senders' rates
29847 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
29848 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
29849
29850 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
29851 # at the decimal point.
29852 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
29853 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
29854 $sender_rate_limit }s
29855
29856 # Keep authenticated users under control
29857 deny authenticated = *
29858 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
29859
29860 # System-wide rate limit
29861 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
29862 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
29863
29864 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
29865 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
29866 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
29867 messages per $sender_rate_period
29868 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
29869 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
29870 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
29871 .endd
29872 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
29873 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
29874 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
29875 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
29876 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
29877 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
29878 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
29879
29880
29881
29882 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
29883 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
29884 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
29885 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
29886 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
29887 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
29888 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
29889 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
29890 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
29891 .code
29892 verify = sender/callout
29893 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
29894 .endd
29895 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
29896 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
29897 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
29898 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
29899 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
29900 The available options are as follows:
29901
29902 .ilist
29903 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
29904 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
29905 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
29906 .next
29907 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
29908 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
29909 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
29910 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
29911 .next
29912 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
29913 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
29914 .next
29915 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
29916 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
29917 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
29918 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
29919 .endlist
29920
29921 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
29922 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
29923 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
29924 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29925 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
29926 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
29927 coding like this:
29928 .code
29929 warn !verify = sender
29930 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
29931 .endd
29932 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
29933 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
29934 verification failure.
29935
29936 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
29937 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
29938
29939 .ilist
29940 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
29941 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
29942 .next
29943 &%route%&: Routing failed.
29944 .next
29945 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
29946 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
29947 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
29948 .next
29949 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
29950 .next
29951 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
29952 .endlist
29953
29954 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
29955 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
29956
29957
29958
29959
29960 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
29961 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
29962 .cindex "callout" "verification"
29963 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
29964 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
29965 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
29966 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
29967 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
29968 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
29969 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
29970 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
29971 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
29972 sender's domain.
29973
29974 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
29975 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
29976 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
29977 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
29978 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
29979 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
29980
29981 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
29982 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
29983 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
29984 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
29985 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
29986
29987 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
29988 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
29989 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
29990 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
29991 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
29992 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
29993 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
29994 supplies a host list.
29995 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
29996
29997 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
29998 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
29999 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
30000 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
30001 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
30002 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
30003 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
30004
30005 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
30006 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
30007 following SMTP commands are sent:
30008 .display
30009 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
30010 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
30011 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
30012 &`QUIT`&
30013 .endd
30014 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
30015 set to &"lmtp"&.
30016
30017 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
30018 settings.
30019
30020 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
30021 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
30022 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
30023 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
30024 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
30025 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
30026
30027 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
30028 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
30029 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
30030 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
30031 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
30032
30033 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30034 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
30035 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
30036 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
30037 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
30038
30039
30040
30041
30042 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
30043 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
30044 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
30045 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
30046 .code
30047 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
30048 .endd
30049 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
30050 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
30051 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
30052
30053
30054 .vlist
30055 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
30056 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
30057 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
30058 For example:
30059 .code
30060 verify = sender/callout=5s
30061 .endd
30062 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
30063 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
30064 the &%connect%& parameter.
30065
30066
30067 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30068 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
30069 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
30070 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
30071 .code
30072 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
30073 .endd
30074 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
30075
30076 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
30077 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
30078 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
30079 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
30080 updated in this circumstance.
30081
30082 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
30083 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
30084 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
30085 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
30086 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
30087 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
30088
30089
30090 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30091 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
30092 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
30093 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
30094 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
30095 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
30096 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
30097 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
30098 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
30099 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
30100 .code
30101 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
30102 .endd
30103 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
30104
30105
30106 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
30107 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
30108 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
30109 For example:
30110 .code
30111 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
30112 .endd
30113 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
30114 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
30115 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
30116 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
30117 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
30118
30119
30120 .vitem &*no_cache*&
30121 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
30122 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
30123 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
30124
30125 .vitem &*postmaster*&
30126 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
30127 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
30128 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
30129 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
30130 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
30131 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
30132 made, until the cache record expires.
30133
30134 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
30135 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
30136 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
30137 For example:
30138 .code
30139 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
30140 .endd
30141 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
30142 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
30143 .code
30144 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
30145 .endd
30146 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
30147 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
30148 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
30149 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
30150
30151
30152 .vitem &*random*&
30153 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
30154 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
30155 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
30156 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
30157 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
30158 .code
30159 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
30160 .endd
30161 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
30162 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
30163 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
30164 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
30165 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
30166
30167 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
30168 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
30169 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30170 .code
30171 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
30172 .endd
30173 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30174 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
30175 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
30176 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
30177 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
30178
30179 .vitem &*use_sender*&
30180 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
30181 .code
30182 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
30183 .endd
30184 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
30185 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
30186 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
30187 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
30188 usefulness of callout caching.
30189 .endlist
30190
30191 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
30192 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
30193 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
30194 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
30195 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
30196 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
30197 these circumstances.
30198
30199 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
30200 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
30201 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
30202 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
30203 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
30204 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
30205 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
30206
30207 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
30208 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
30209 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
30210 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
30211
30212
30213
30214
30215 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
30216 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
30217 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
30218 .cindex "caching" "callout"
30219 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
30220 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
30221 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
30222 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
30223 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
30224 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
30225
30226 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
30227 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
30228 is not available.
30229
30230 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
30231 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
30232 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
30233
30234 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
30235 commands up to and including
30236 .code
30237 MAIL FROM:<>
30238 .endd
30239 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
30240 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
30241 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
30242 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
30243 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
30244 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
30245 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
30246
30247 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
30248 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
30249 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
30250 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
30251 will eventually be noticed.
30252
30253 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
30254 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
30255 behaviour will be the same.
30256
30257
30258
30259 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
30260 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
30261 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
30262 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
30263 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
30264 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
30265 you might see:
30266 .code
30267 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
30268 250 OK
30269 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
30270 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
30271 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
30272 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
30273 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
30274 550 Sender verification failed
30275 .endd
30276 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
30277 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
30278 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
30279 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
30280 example:
30281 .code
30282 verify = sender/no_details
30283 .endd
30284
30285 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
30286 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
30287 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
30288 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
30289 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
30290 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
30291 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
30292
30293 .ilist
30294 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
30295 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
30296 verification also fails.
30297 .next
30298 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
30299 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
30300 .endlist
30301
30302 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
30303 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
30304 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
30305 .code
30306 A.Wol: aw123
30307 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
30308 .endd
30309 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
30310 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
30311 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
30312 verification to succeed.
30313
30314 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
30315 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
30316 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
30317 option. For example:
30318 .code
30319 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
30320 .endd
30321 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
30322 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
30323
30324 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
30325 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
30326 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
30327 address and a report is output for each of them.
30328
30329
30330
30331 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
30332 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
30333 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
30334 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
30335 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
30336 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
30337 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
30338 .code
30339 verify = csa
30340 .endd
30341 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
30342 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
30343 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
30344 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
30345 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
30346 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
30347
30348 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
30349 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
30350 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
30351 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
30352
30353 .ilist
30354 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
30355 .next
30356 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
30357 .next
30358 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
30359 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
30360 .next
30361 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
30362 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
30363 .endlist
30364
30365 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
30366 use for the DNS query. The default is:
30367 .code
30368 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
30369 .endd
30370 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
30371 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
30372 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
30373 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
30374 meaningful to say:
30375 .code
30376 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
30377 .endd
30378 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
30379 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
30380 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
30381
30382 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
30383 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
30384 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
30385 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
30386 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
30387 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
30388 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
30389 of legitimate HELO domains.
30390
30391 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
30392 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
30393 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
30394 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
30395 lookup such as:
30396 .code
30397 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
30398 .endd
30399 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
30400 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
30401 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
30402
30403
30404
30405
30406 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
30407 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
30408 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
30409 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
30410 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
30411 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
30412 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
30413 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
30414
30415 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
30416 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
30417 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
30418 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
30419 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
30420 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
30421 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
30422
30423 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
30424 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
30425 like this:
30426 .code
30427 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
30428 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
30429 }{$value}}
30430 .endd
30431 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
30432 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
30433 use this:
30434 .code
30435 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
30436 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
30437 senders = :
30438 recipients = +batv_senders
30439
30440 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
30441 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
30442 senders = :
30443 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
30444 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
30445 !condition = $prvscheck_result
30446 .endd
30447 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
30448 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
30449 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
30450 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
30451 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
30452
30453 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
30454 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
30455 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
30456 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
30457 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
30458 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
30459 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
30460
30461 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
30462 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
30463 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
30464 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
30465 .code
30466 batv_redirect:
30467 driver = redirect
30468 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
30469 .endd
30470 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
30471 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
30472 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
30473 local addresses.
30474
30475 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
30476 can be used:
30477 .code
30478 external_smtp_batv:
30479 driver = smtp
30480 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
30481 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
30482 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
30483 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
30484 {$value}fail}}}
30485 .endd
30486 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
30487
30488
30489
30490 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
30491 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
30492 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
30493 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
30494 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
30495 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
30496 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
30497 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
30498 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
30499 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
30500
30501 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
30502 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
30503 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
30504 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
30505 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
30506 same host is fulfilling both functions,
30507 . ///
30508 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
30509 . ///
30510 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
30511 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
30512 system to arbitrary domains.
30513
30514
30515 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
30516 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
30517 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
30518 example, suppose you want to do the following:
30519
30520 .ilist
30521 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
30522 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
30523 &'my.dom2.example'&.
30524 .next
30525 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
30526 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
30527 .next
30528 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
30529 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
30530 .endlist
30531
30532
30533 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
30534 .code
30535 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
30536 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
30537 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
30538 .endd
30539 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
30540 command:
30541 .code
30542 acl_check_rcpt:
30543 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
30544 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
30545 .endd
30546 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
30547 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
30548 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
30549 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
30550 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
30551 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
30552 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30553
30554
30555
30556 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
30557 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
30558 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
30559 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
30560 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30561
30562 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
30563 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
30564 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
30565 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
30566 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
30567 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
30568 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
30569 .ecindex IIDacl
30570
30571
30572
30573 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30574 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30575
30576 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
30577 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
30578 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
30579 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
30580 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
30581 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
30582 specification.
30583
30584 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
30585 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
30586 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
30587 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
30588 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
30589
30590 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
30591 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
30592 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
30593
30594 .ilist
30595 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
30596 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
30597 .next
30598 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
30599 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
30600 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
30601 .next
30602 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
30603 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
30604 .next
30605 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
30606 conditions.
30607 .next
30608 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
30609 .endlist
30610
30611 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
30612 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
30613 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
30614
30615 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
30616 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
30617 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
30618 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
30619 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
30620 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
30621
30622 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
30623 temporarily created in a file called:
30624 .display
30625 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
30626 .endd
30627 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
30628 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
30629 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
30630 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
30631 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
30632 .code
30633 control = no_mbox_unspool
30634 .endd
30635 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
30636 same directory by default.
30637
30638
30639
30640 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
30641 .cindex "virus scanning"
30642 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
30643 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
30644 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
30645 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
30646 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
30647 in memory and thus are much faster.
30648
30649 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
30650 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
30651
30652 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
30653 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
30654 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
30655 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
30656 .display
30657 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
30658 .endd
30659 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
30660 .code
30661 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
30662 .endd
30663 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
30664 before use.
30665 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
30666 The following scanner types are supported in this release:
30667
30668 .vlist
30669 .vitem &%avast%&
30670 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
30671 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
30672 Security (currently at version 1.1.7).
30673 You can get a trial version at &url(http://www.avast.com) or for Linux
30674 at &url(http://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
30675 This scanner type takes one option,
30676 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30677 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30678 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30679 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30680 Any further options are given, on separate lines,
30681 to the daemon as options before the main scan command.
30682 For example:
30683 .code
30684 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
30685 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
30686 .endd
30687 If you omit the argument, the default path
30688 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
30689 is used.
30690 If you use a remote host,
30691 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
30692 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
30693 For information about available commands and their options you may use
30694 .code
30695 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
30696 FLAGS
30697 SENSITIVITY
30698 PACK
30699 .endd
30700
30701
30702 .vitem &%aveserver%&
30703 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30704 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
30705 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
30706 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
30707 example:
30708 .code
30709 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
30710 .endd
30711
30712
30713 .vitem &%clamd%&
30714 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
30715 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
30716 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
30717 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
30718 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
30719
30720 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
30721 a UNIX socket specification,
30722 a TCP socket specification,
30723 or a (global) option.
30724
30725 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
30726 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
30727 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
30728 and the second a port number,
30729 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
30730 These per-server options are supported:
30731 .code
30732 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
30733 .endd
30734
30735 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
30736 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
30737
30738 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
30739
30740 Examples:
30741 .code
30742 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
30743 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
30744 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
30745 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
30746 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
30747 .endd
30748 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
30749 &`local`&
30750 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
30751 to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
30752 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
30753 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
30754 There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
30755 you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
30756
30757 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
30758 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
30759 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
30760 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
30761 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
30762 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
30763 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
30764 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
30765 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
30766 .code
30767 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
30768 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
30769 (Connection refused)
30770 .endd
30771
30772 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
30773 contributing the code for this scanner.
30774
30775 .vitem &%cmdline%&
30776 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
30777 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
30778 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
30779 type takes 3 mandatory options:
30780
30781 .olist
30782 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
30783 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
30784
30785 .next
30786 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
30787 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
30788 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
30789 the &"trigger"& expression.
30790
30791 .next
30792 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
30793 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
30794 &"name"& expression.
30795 .endlist olist
30796
30797 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
30798 .code
30799 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
30800 .endd
30801 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
30802 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
30803 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
30804 configuration setting:
30805 .code
30806 av_scanner = cmdline:\
30807 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
30808 found in file:'(.+)'
30809 .endd
30810 .vitem &%drweb%&
30811 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
30812 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface
30813 takes one option,
30814 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
30815 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
30816 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
30817 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
30818 For example:
30819 .code
30820 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
30821 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
30822 .endd
30823 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
30824 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
30825
30826 .vitem &%f-protd%&
30827 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
30828 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
30829 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
30830 (or port-range).
30831 For example:
30832 .code
30833 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
30834 .endd
30835 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
30836
30837 .vitem &%fsecure%&
30838 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
30839 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
30840 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
30841 .code
30842 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
30843 .endd
30844 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
30845 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
30846
30847 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
30848 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
30849 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
30850 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
30851 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
30852 For example:
30853 .code
30854 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
30855 .endd
30856 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
30857
30858 .vitem &%mksd%&
30859 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
30860 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
30861 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
30862 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
30863 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
30864 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
30865 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
30866 .code
30867 av_scanner = mksd:2
30868 .endd
30869 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
30870
30871 .vitem &%sock%&
30872 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
30873 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
30874 running on the local machine.
30875 There are four options:
30876 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
30877 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
30878 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
30879 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
30880 an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
30881 For example:
30882 .code
30883 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)\$
30884 .endd
30885 Default for the socket specifier is &_/tmp/malware.sock_&.
30886 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_&.
30887 Both regular-expressions are required.
30888
30889 .vitem &%sophie%&
30890 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
30891 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
30892 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
30893 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
30894 client communication. For example:
30895 .code
30896 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
30897 .endd
30898 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
30899 the option.
30900 .endlist
30901
30902 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
30903 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
30904 ACL.
30905
30906 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
30907 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
30908 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
30909 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
30910 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
30911 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
30912 message.
30913
30914 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
30915 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
30916 The first element can then be one of
30917
30918 .ilist
30919 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
30920 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
30921 recommended usage.
30922 .next
30923 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
30924 the condition fails immediately.
30925 .next
30926 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
30927 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
30928 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
30929 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
30930 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
30931 .endlist
30932
30933 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
30934 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
30935 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
30936
30937 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
30938 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
30939 For example:
30940 .code
30941 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
30942 .endd
30943 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
30944
30945 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
30946 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
30947 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
30948 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
30949 logging data.
30950
30951 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
30952 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
30953 &%malware%& condition.
30954
30955 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
30956 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
30957
30958 Here is a very simple scanning example:
30959 .code
30960 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30961 demime = *
30962 malware = *
30963 .endd
30964 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
30965 .code
30966 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30967 demime = *
30968 malware = */defer_ok
30969 .endd
30970 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
30971 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
30972 .code
30973 av_scanner = $acl_m0
30974 .endd
30975 in the main Exim configuration.
30976 .code
30977 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30978 set acl_m0 = sophie
30979 malware = *
30980
30981 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
30982 set acl_m0 = aveserver
30983 malware = *
30984 .endd
30985
30986
30987 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
30988 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
30989 .cindex "spam scanning"
30990 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
30991 .cindex "Rspamd"
30992 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
30993 score and a report for the message.
30994 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
30995
30996 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
30997 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
30998 &url(http://spamassassin.apache.org) and &url(http://www.rspamd.com)
30999
31000 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
31001 .code
31002 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
31003 .endd
31004 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
31005 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
31006 nicely, however.
31007
31008 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
31009 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
31010 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
31011 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
31012 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
31013 configuration as follows (example):
31014 .code
31015 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
31016 .endd
31017
31018 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
31019 on TCP port 11333)
31020 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
31021 .code
31022 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
31023 .endd
31024
31025 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
31026 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
31027 file name instead of an address/port pair:
31028 .code
31029 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
31030 .endd
31031 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
31032 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
31033 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
31034 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
31035 .code
31036 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
31037 192.168.2.11 783 : \
31038 192.168.2.12 783
31039 .endd
31040 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
31041 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
31042 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
31043 condition defers.
31044
31045 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
31046 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
31047 and changeable in the usual way.
31048
31049 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
31050 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
31051 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
31052 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
31053
31054 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
31055 are options.
31056 The supported option are:
31057 .code
31058 pri=<priority> Selection priority
31059 weight=<value> Selection bias
31060 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
31061 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
31062 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
31063 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
31064 .endd
31065
31066 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
31067 higher values being tried first.
31068 The default priority is 1.
31069
31070 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
31071 Within a priority set
31072 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
31073 The default value for selection bias is 1.
31074
31075 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
31076 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
31077 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
31078 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
31079
31080 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
31081 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
31082
31083 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
31084 The default value is two minutes.
31085
31086 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
31087 a failed connect is made.
31088 The default is to not retry.
31089
31090 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
31091 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
31092 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
31093 expansion.
31094
31095 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
31096 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
31097 .code
31098 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31099 spam = joe
31100 .endd
31101 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
31102 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
31103 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
31104 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
31105 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
31106 right-hand side.
31107
31108 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
31109 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
31110 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
31111 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
31112 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
31113 are not set.
31114 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
31115 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
31116 after the first),
31117 or the use of PRDR,
31118 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
31119 are needed to use this feature.
31120
31121 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
31122 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
31123 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
31124
31125
31126 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
31127 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
31128 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
31129 example:
31130 .code
31131 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31132 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
31133 spam = nobody
31134 .endd
31135
31136 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
31137 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
31138 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
31139 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
31140
31141 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
31142 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
31143 variables.
31144 Except for &$spam_report$&,
31145 these variables are saved with the received message so are
31146 available for use at delivery time.
31147
31148 .vlist
31149 .vitem &$spam_score$&
31150 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
31151 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
31152
31153 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
31154 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
31155 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
31156 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
31157 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
31158
31159 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
31160 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
31161 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
31162 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
31163 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
31164
31165 .vitem &$spam_report$&
31166 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
31167 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
31168 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
31169
31170 .vitem &$spam_action$&
31171 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
31172 spam score versus threshold.
31173 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
31174
31175 .endlist
31176
31177 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
31178 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
31179 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
31180
31181 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
31182 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
31183 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
31184 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
31185 spam condition, like this:
31186 .code
31187 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
31188 spam = joe/defer_ok
31189 .endd
31190 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
31191
31192 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
31193 condition:
31194 .code
31195 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
31196 warn spam = nobody:true
31197 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
31198 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
31199
31200 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
31201 # is over threshold
31202 warn spam = nobody
31203 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
31204
31205 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
31206 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
31207 spam = nobody:true
31208 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
31209 .endd
31210
31211
31212
31213 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
31214 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
31215 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31216 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
31217 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
31218 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
31219 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
31220 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
31221 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
31222 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
31223 cases.
31224
31225 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
31226 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
31227 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
31228 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
31229 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
31230 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
31231 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
31232
31233 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
31234 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
31235 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
31236 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
31237 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
31238
31239 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
31240 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
31241 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
31242 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
31243 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
31244 syntax is:
31245 .display
31246 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
31247 .endd
31248 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
31249 the value can be:
31250
31251 .olist
31252 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
31253 .next
31254 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
31255 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
31256 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
31257 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
31258 .next
31259 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
31260 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
31261 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
31262 the full path and file name.
31263 .next
31264 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
31265 filename, and the default path is then used.
31266 .endlist
31267 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
31268 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
31269 a file with its original, proposed filename using
31270 .code
31271 decode = $mime_filename
31272 .endd
31273 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
31274 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
31275 automatically unlinked.
31276
31277 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
31278 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
31279 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
31280 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
31281 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
31282
31283 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
31284 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
31285 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
31286
31287 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
31288 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
31289 available in the MIME ACL:
31290
31291 .vlist
31292 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
31293 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
31294 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
31295 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
31296 contains the empty string.
31297
31298 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
31299 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
31300 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
31301 .code
31302 us-ascii
31303 gb2312 (Chinese)
31304 iso-8859-1
31305 .endd
31306 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
31307 case-insensitively.
31308
31309 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
31310 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
31311 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
31312 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
31313 only used for display purposes.
31314
31315 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
31316 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
31317 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
31318
31319 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
31320 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
31321 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
31322
31323 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
31324 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31325 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
31326 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
31327 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
31328
31329 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
31330 This variable contains the normalized content of the
31331 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
31332 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
31333
31334 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
31335 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
31336 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
31337 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
31338 .code
31339 text/plain
31340 text/html
31341 application/octet-stream
31342 image/jpeg
31343 audio/midi
31344 .endd
31345 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
31346 empty string.
31347
31348 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
31349 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
31350 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
31351 containing the decoded data.
31352 .endlist
31353
31354 .cindex "RFC 2047"
31355 .vlist
31356 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
31357 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
31358 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
31359 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
31360 RFC2047
31361 or RFC2231
31362 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
31363 If no filename was
31364 found, this variable contains the empty string.
31365
31366 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
31367 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
31368 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
31369 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
31370
31371 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
31372 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
31373 follows:
31374
31375 .olist
31376 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
31377
31378 .next
31379 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
31380 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
31381
31382 .next
31383 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
31384 and the rest are attachments.
31385
31386 .next
31387 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
31388 .endlist olist
31389
31390 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
31391 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
31392 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
31393 .code
31394 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
31395 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
31396 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
31397 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
31398 .endd
31399 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
31400 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
31401 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
31402 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
31403 want to carry out specific actions on them.
31404
31405 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
31406 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
31407 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
31408 decoding is fully recursive.
31409
31410 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
31411 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
31412 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
31413 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
31414 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
31415 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
31416 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
31417 .endlist
31418
31419
31420
31421 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
31422 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
31423 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
31424 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
31425 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
31426
31427 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
31428 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
31429 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
31430 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
31431 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
31432
31433 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
31434 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
31435 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
31436 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
31437 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
31438 32K characters are checked.
31439
31440 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
31441 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
31442 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
31443 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
31444 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
31445 .code
31446 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
31447 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
31448 .endd
31449 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
31450 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
31451 matching regular expression.
31452
31453 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
31454 CPU-intensive.
31455
31456
31457
31458
31459 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
31460 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
31461 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
31462 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
31463 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
31464 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
31465 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
31466 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
31467 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
31468 use the &%demime%& condition.
31469
31470 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
31471 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
31472 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
31473 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
31474 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
31475 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
31476
31477 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
31478 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
31479 example:
31480 .code
31481 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
31482 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
31483 .endd
31484 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
31485 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
31486 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
31487 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
31488
31489 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
31490 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
31491 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
31492
31493 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
31494
31495 .vlist
31496 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
31497 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
31498 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
31499 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
31500 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
31501 zero, no error occurred.
31502
31503 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
31504 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
31505 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
31506 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
31507 .endlist
31508
31509 .vlist
31510 .vitem &$found_extension$&
31511 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
31512 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
31513 extension it found.
31514 .endlist
31515
31516 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
31517 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
31518
31519 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
31520 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
31521 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
31522 facility:
31523 .code
31524 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
31525 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
31526 demime = *
31527 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
31528
31529 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
31530 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
31531 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
31532 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
31533
31534 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
31535 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
31536 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
31537 demime = exe:doc
31538 control = freeze
31539 .endd
31540 .ecindex IIDcosca
31541
31542
31543
31544
31545 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31546 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31547
31548 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
31549 "Local scan function"
31550 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
31551 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
31552 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
31553 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
31554 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
31555
31556 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
31557 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
31558 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
31559 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
31560 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
31561
31562 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
31563 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
31564 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
31565 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
31566
31567 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
31568 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
31569 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
31570 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
31571
31572 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
31573 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
31574 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
31575 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
31576 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
31577 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
31578 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
31579 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
31580 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
31581
31582
31583
31584 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
31585 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
31586 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
31587 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
31588 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
31589 directory, so you might set
31590 .code
31591 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
31592 .endd
31593 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
31594 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
31595 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
31596 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
31597 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
31598 _src/local_scan.c_.
31599
31600 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
31601 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
31602 .code
31603 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31604 .endd
31605 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
31606
31607
31608
31609
31610 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
31611 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
31612 You must include this line near the start of your code:
31613 .code
31614 #include "local_scan.h"
31615 .endd
31616 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
31617 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
31618 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
31619 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
31620 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
31621 strings and pointers to character strings:
31622 .code
31623 #define CS (char *)
31624 #define CCS (const char *)
31625 #define CSS (char **)
31626 #define US (unsigned char *)
31627 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
31628 #define USS (unsigned char **)
31629 .endd
31630 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
31631 .code
31632 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
31633 .endd
31634 The arguments are as follows:
31635
31636 .ilist
31637 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
31638 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
31639 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
31640
31641 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
31642 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
31643 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
31644 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
31645 case this changes in some future version.
31646 .next
31647 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
31648 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
31649 .endlist
31650
31651 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
31652
31653 .vlist
31654 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
31655 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
31656 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
31657 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
31658 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
31659 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
31660
31661 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
31662 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31663 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
31664
31665 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
31666 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
31667 queued without immediate delivery.
31668
31669 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
31670 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
31671 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
31672 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
31673 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
31674 used.
31675
31676 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
31677 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
31678 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
31679 problem"& is used.
31680
31681 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31682 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
31683 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
31684 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
31685 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
31686 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
31687 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31688
31689 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
31690 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
31691 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
31692 .endlist
31693
31694 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
31695 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
31696 &%-oe%& command line options.
31697
31698
31699
31700 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
31701 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
31702 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
31703 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
31704 want to do this, you must have the line
31705 .code
31706 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
31707 .endd
31708 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
31709 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
31710 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
31711 to define them.
31712
31713 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
31714 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
31715 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
31716 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
31717 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
31718 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
31719 .code
31720 static int my_integer_option = 42;
31721 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
31722
31723 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
31724 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
31725 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
31726 };
31727
31728 int local_scan_options_count =
31729 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
31730 .endd
31731 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
31732 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
31733 .code
31734 begin local_scan
31735 my_integer = 99
31736 my_string = some string of text...
31737 .endd
31738 The available types of option data are as follows:
31739
31740 .vlist
31741 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
31742 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
31743 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
31744 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
31745 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
31746 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
31747 values.)
31748
31749 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
31750 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
31751 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
31752 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
31753
31754 .vitem &*opt_int*&
31755 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
31756 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
31757 Exim.
31758
31759 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
31760 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
31761 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
31762 printed with the suffix K or M.
31763
31764 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
31765 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
31766 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
31767 always output in octal.
31768
31769 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
31770 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
31771 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
31772
31773 .vitem &*opt_time*&
31774 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
31775 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
31776 .endlist
31777
31778 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
31779 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
31780
31781
31782
31783 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
31784 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
31785 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
31786 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
31787 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
31788 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
31789 C variables are as follows:
31790
31791 .vlist
31792 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
31793 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
31794
31795 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
31796 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
31797
31798 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
31799 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
31800 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
31801 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
31802
31803 .ilist
31804 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
31805 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
31806 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
31807
31808 .next
31809 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
31810 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
31811 of debugging bits.
31812 .endlist ilist
31813
31814 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
31815 selected, you should use code like this:
31816 .code
31817 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
31818 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
31819 .endd
31820 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
31821 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
31822 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
31823
31824 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
31825 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
31826 discussed below.
31827
31828 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
31829 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
31830
31831 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
31832 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
31833
31834 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
31835 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
31836 &%-bh%& command line option.
31837
31838 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
31839 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
31840 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
31841
31842 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
31843 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
31844 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
31845 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
31846
31847 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
31848 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
31849 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
31850
31851 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
31852 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
31853
31854 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
31855 The number of accepted recipients.
31856
31857 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
31858 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
31859 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
31860 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
31861 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
31862 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
31863 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
31864 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
31865 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
31866 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
31867 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
31868 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
31869
31870 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
31871 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
31872
31873 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
31874 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
31875 locally-submitted messages.
31876
31877 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
31878 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
31879 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
31880
31881 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
31882 The name of the sending host, if known.
31883
31884 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
31885 The port on the sending host.
31886
31887 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
31888 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
31889
31890 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
31891 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
31892
31893 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
31894 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
31895 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
31896 .endlist
31897
31898
31899 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
31900 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
31901 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
31902 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
31903 their type to *.
31904
31905
31906 .vlist
31907 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
31908 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
31909
31910 .vitem &*int&~type*&
31911 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
31912 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
31913 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
31914 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
31915 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
31916 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
31917
31918 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
31919 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
31920 internal newlines.
31921
31922 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
31923 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
31924 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
31925 .endlist
31926
31927
31928
31929 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
31930 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
31931
31932 .vlist
31933 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
31934 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
31935
31936 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
31937 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
31938 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
31939 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
31940
31941 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
31942 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
31943 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
31944 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
31945 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
31946 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
31947 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
31948 is NULL for all recipients.
31949 .endlist
31950
31951
31952
31953 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
31954 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
31955 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
31956 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
31957 release:
31958
31959 .vlist
31960 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
31961 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
31962
31963 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
31964 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
31965 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
31966 for the process in &%newumask%&.
31967
31968 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
31969 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
31970 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
31971 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
31972 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
31973
31974 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
31975
31976 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
31977 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
31978 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
31979 return value is as follows:
31980
31981 .ilist
31982 >= 0
31983
31984 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
31985 ending status.
31986
31987 .next
31988 < 0 and > &--256
31989
31990 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
31991 signal number.
31992
31993 .next
31994 &--256
31995
31996 The process timed out.
31997 .next
31998 &--257
31999
32000 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
32001 .endlist
32002
32003 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
32004 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
32005 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
32006 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
32007 forks a subprocess that is running
32008 .code
32009 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
32010 .endd
32011 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
32012 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
32013 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
32014 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
32015
32016 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
32017 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
32018 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
32019 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
32020
32021
32022 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
32023 *sender_authentication)*&
32024 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
32025 that it runs is:
32026 .display
32027 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
32028 .endd
32029 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
32030
32031
32032 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32033 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
32034 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
32035 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
32036 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
32037 .code
32038 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
32039 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
32040 .endd
32041
32042 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
32043 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
32044 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
32045 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
32046 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
32047 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
32048 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
32049 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
32050
32051 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
32052 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
32053 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
32054 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
32055 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
32056 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
32057
32058 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32059 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
32060 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
32061 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
32062
32063 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
32064 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
32065 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
32066 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
32067 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
32068 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
32069 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
32070 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
32071 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
32072 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
32073 .code
32074 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
32075 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
32076 .endd
32077 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
32078 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
32079
32080
32081 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
32082 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
32083 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
32084 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
32085 match the specification, the function does nothing.
32086
32087
32088 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
32089 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
32090 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
32091 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
32092 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
32093 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
32094 .code
32095 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
32096 .endd
32097 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
32098 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
32099 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
32100 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
32101 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
32102 zero-terminated.
32103
32104 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
32105 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
32106 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
32107 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
32108 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
32109 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
32110 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
32111 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
32112
32113 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
32114 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
32115 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
32116 .display
32117 &`OK `& match succeeded
32118 &`FAIL `& match failed
32119 &`DEFER `& match deferred
32120 .endd
32121 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
32122 inability to contact a database.
32123
32124 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32125 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32126 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
32127 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
32128 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32129
32130 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
32131 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
32132 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
32133 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
32134 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
32135
32136 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
32137 uschar&~*list)*&"
32138 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
32139 expected to be
32140 .code
32141 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
32142 .endd
32143 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
32144 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
32145 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
32146 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
32147 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
32148 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
32149 failed.
32150
32151 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
32152 *format,&~...)*&"
32153 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
32154 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
32155 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
32156 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
32157 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
32158 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
32159
32160
32161 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
32162 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
32163 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
32164 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
32165
32166 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
32167 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
32168 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
32169 value afterwards. For example:
32170 .code
32171 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
32172 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
32173 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
32174 .endd
32175
32176 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
32177 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
32178 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
32179 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
32180 address.
32181 .endlist
32182
32183
32184 .cindex "RFC 2047"
32185 .vlist
32186 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
32187 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
32188 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
32189 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
32190 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
32191 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
32192 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
32193 binary string is returned with an error message.
32194
32195 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
32196 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
32197 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
32198
32199 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
32200 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
32201 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
32202 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
32203 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
32204
32205 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
32206 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
32207 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
32208
32209 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
32210 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
32211 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
32212 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
32213 with translation.
32214
32215
32216 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
32217 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
32218 below.
32219
32220 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
32221 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
32222 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
32223 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
32224 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
32225 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
32226 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
32227 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
32228 is involved.
32229
32230 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
32231 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
32232
32233 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
32234 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
32235 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
32236 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
32237 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
32238 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
32239 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
32240 .code
32241 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
32242 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
32243 .endd
32244 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
32245 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
32246 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
32247 multiple output lines.
32248
32249 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
32250 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
32251 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
32252 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
32253 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
32254 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
32255 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
32256 is an error.
32257
32258 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
32259 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
32260 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
32261 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32262
32263 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
32264 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
32265 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
32266
32267 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
32268 See below.
32269
32270 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
32271 See below.
32272
32273 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
32274 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
32275 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
32276 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
32277 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
32278 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
32279 more discussion.
32280 .endlist
32281
32282
32283
32284 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
32285 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
32286 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
32287 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
32288 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
32289 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
32290 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
32291 terminates.
32292
32293 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
32294 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
32295 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
32296 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
32297
32298 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
32299 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
32300 .code
32301 store_pool = POOL_PERM
32302 .endd
32303 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
32304 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
32305 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
32306 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
32307
32308 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
32309 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
32310 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
32311 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
32312 &%store_pool%&.
32313 .ecindex IIDlosca
32314
32315
32316
32317
32318 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32319 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32320
32321 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
32322 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
32323 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
32324 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
32325 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
32326 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
32327 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
32328 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
32329
32330 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
32331 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
32332 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
32333 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
32334 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
32335
32336 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
32337 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
32338 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
32339 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
32340 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
32341 prevent it happening on retries.
32342
32343 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32344 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32345 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
32346 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
32347 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
32348 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
32349 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
32350 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
32351
32352
32353 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
32354 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
32355 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
32356 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
32357 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
32358 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
32359 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
32360 .code
32361 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
32362 system_filter_user = exim
32363 .endd
32364 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
32365 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
32366 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
32367 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
32368 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
32369 by the &%reply%& command.
32370
32371
32372 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
32373 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
32374 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
32375 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
32376
32377 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
32378 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
32379
32380
32381
32382 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
32383 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
32384 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
32385 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
32386 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
32387 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
32388 they cause errors.
32389
32390 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
32391 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
32392 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
32393 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
32394 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
32395 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
32396 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
32397
32398 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
32399 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
32400 succeed, it will not be tried again.
32401 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
32402 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
32403
32404 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
32405 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
32406 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
32407 to which users' filter files can refer.
32408
32409
32410
32411 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
32412 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
32413 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
32414 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
32415 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
32416
32417
32418
32419 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
32420 .cindex "freezing messages"
32421 .cindex "message" "freezing"
32422 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
32423 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
32424 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
32425 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
32426 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
32427 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
32428 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
32429 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
32430 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
32431 .code
32432 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
32433 .endd
32434 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
32435
32436 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
32437 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
32438 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
32439 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
32440 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
32441 run.
32442
32443 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
32444 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
32445 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
32446 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
32447
32448 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
32449 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
32450 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
32451 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
32452 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
32453 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
32454 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
32455 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
32456 message. For example:
32457 .code
32458 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
32459 because it contains attachments that we are \
32460 not prepared to receive."
32461 .endd
32462
32463 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
32464 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
32465 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
32466 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
32467 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
32468 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
32469 use, for example
32470 .code
32471 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
32472 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
32473 .endd
32474 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
32475 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
32476 generated by the filter.
32477
32478 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
32479 &%defer%&,
32480 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
32481 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
32482 as
32483 .code
32484 mail ...
32485 freeze
32486 .endd
32487 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
32488 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
32489 take place.
32490
32491
32492
32493 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
32494 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
32495 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
32496 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
32497 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
32498 .code
32499 headers add <string>
32500 headers remove <string>
32501 .endd
32502 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
32503 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
32504 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
32505 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
32506 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
32507
32508 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
32509 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
32510 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
32511 example:
32512 .code
32513 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
32514 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
32515 X-header-2: ...."
32516 .endd
32517 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
32518 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
32519 space after input continuations is ignored.
32520
32521 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
32522 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
32523 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
32524 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
32525 header with the same name, they are all removed.
32526
32527 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
32528 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
32529 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
32530 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
32531 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
32532 used for all recipients of the message.
32533
32534 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
32535 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
32536 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
32537 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
32538 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
32539 until the message is actually being written (see section
32540 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
32541
32542 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
32543 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
32544 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
32545 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
32546 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
32547 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
32548 modified more than once.
32549
32550 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
32551 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
32552 For example:
32553 .code
32554 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
32555 headers remove "Subject"
32556 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
32557 headers remove "Old-Subject"
32558 .endd
32559
32560
32561
32562 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
32563 .cindex "envelope sender"
32564 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
32565 .code
32566 errors_to <some address>
32567 .endd
32568 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
32569 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
32570 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
32571 might use
32572 .code
32573 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
32574 .endd
32575 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
32576 address if its delivery failed.
32577
32578
32579
32580 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
32581 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32582 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32583 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
32584 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
32585 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
32586 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
32587 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
32588 which implements such a filter:
32589 .code
32590 central_filter:
32591 check_local_user
32592 driver = redirect
32593 domains = +local_domains
32594 file = /central/filters/$local_part
32595 no_verify
32596 allow_filter
32597 allow_freeze
32598 .endd
32599 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
32600 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
32601 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
32602 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
32603
32604 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
32605 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
32606 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
32607 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
32608 normal way.
32609 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
32610 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
32611 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
32612
32613
32614
32615
32616
32617
32618 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32620
32621 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
32622 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
32623 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
32624 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
32625 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
32626 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
32627 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
32628 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
32629
32630 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
32631 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
32632 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
32633 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
32634 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
32635
32636 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
32637 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
32638 loopback interface specially in any way.
32639
32640 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
32641 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
32642
32643
32644
32645
32646 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
32647 .cindex "message" "submission"
32648 .cindex "submission mode"
32649 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
32650 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
32651 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
32652 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
32653 .code
32654 control = submission
32655 .endd
32656 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
32657 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
32658 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
32659 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
32660 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
32661 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
32662 .code
32663 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
32664 control = submission
32665 .endd
32666 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
32667 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
32668 is used to separate options. For example:
32669 .code
32670 control = submission/sender_retain
32671 .endd
32672 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
32673 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
32674 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
32675 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
32676 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
32677 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
32678 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
32679
32680 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
32681 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
32682 example:
32683 .code
32684 control = submission/domain=some.domain
32685 .endd
32686 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
32687 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
32688 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
32689 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
32690 .code
32691 accept authenticated = *
32692 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
32693 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
32694 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
32695 .endd
32696 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
32697 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
32698 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
32699 .code
32700 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
32701 .endd
32702 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
32703 line would be:
32704 .code
32705 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
32706 .endd
32707 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
32708 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
32709 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
32710 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
32711
32712 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
32713 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
32714 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
32715 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
32716 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
32717 spoof another's address.
32718
32719 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
32720 .cindex "line endings"
32721 .cindex "carriage return"
32722 .cindex "linefeed"
32723 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
32724 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
32725 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
32726 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
32727 use CRLF or just CR.
32728
32729 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
32730 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
32731 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
32732 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
32733 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
32734 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
32735 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
32736 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
32737 follows:
32738
32739 .ilist
32740 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
32741 .next
32742 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
32743 is ignored.
32744 .next
32745 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
32746 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
32747 terminator.
32748 .next
32749 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
32750 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
32751 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
32752 people trying to play silly games.
32753 .next
32754 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
32755 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
32756 line.
32757 .endlist
32758
32759
32760
32761
32762
32763 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
32764 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
32765 .cindex "address" "qualification"
32766 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
32767 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
32768 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
32769 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
32770 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
32771
32772 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
32773 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
32774 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
32775 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
32776 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
32777
32778 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
32779 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
32780 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
32781 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
32782 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
32783 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
32784 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
32785 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
32786
32787
32788
32789
32790 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
32791 .cindex "&""From""& line"
32792 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
32793 .cindex "sender" "address"
32794 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
32795 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
32796 .cindex "envelope sender"
32797 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32798 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
32799 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
32800 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
32801 .code
32802 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
32803 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
32804 .endd
32805 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
32806 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
32807 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
32808 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
32809 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
32810 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
32811 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
32812 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
32813 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
32814
32815 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
32816 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
32817 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
32818 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
32819 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
32820 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
32821 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
32822
32823 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
32824 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
32825 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
32826
32827 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
32828 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
32829 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
32830 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
32831
32832
32833
32834 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
32835 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
32836 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
32837 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
32838 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
32839 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
32840 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
32841
32842 .blockquote
32843 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
32844 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
32845 .endblockquote
32846
32847 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
32848 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
32849 follows:
32850
32851 .ilist
32852 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
32853 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
32854 .next
32855 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
32856 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
32857 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
32858 .next
32859 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
32860 also removed.
32861 .next
32862 For a locally-submitted message,
32863 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
32864 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
32865 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
32866 included in log lines in this case.
32867 .next
32868 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
32869 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
32870 .endlist
32871
32872
32873
32874
32875 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
32876 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
32877 includes the header line:
32878 .code
32879 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
32880 .endd
32881
32882 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
32883 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
32884 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
32885 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
32886 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
32887 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
32888
32889
32890 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
32891 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
32892 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
32893 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
32894 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
32895
32896 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
32897 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
32898 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
32899 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
32900 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
32901 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
32902 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
32903 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
32904 messages.
32905
32906
32907 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
32908 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
32909 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
32910 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
32911 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
32912 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
32913 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
32914 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
32915 messages.
32916
32917
32918 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
32919 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
32920 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
32921 .cindex "message" "submission"
32922 .cindex "submission mode"
32923 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
32924 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
32925
32926 .ilist
32927 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
32928 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
32929 .next
32930 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
32931 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
32932 .olist
32933 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32934 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
32935 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
32936 .next
32937 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
32938 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
32939 .next
32940 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
32941 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
32942 .endlist
32943 .endlist
32944
32945 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
32946
32947 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
32948 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
32949 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
32950 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
32951 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
32952 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
32953 &%qualify_domain%&.
32954
32955 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
32956 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
32957 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
32958 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
32959
32960
32961 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
32962 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
32963 .cindex "message" "submission"
32964 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
32965 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
32966 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
32967 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
32968 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
32969 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
32970 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
32971 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
32972 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
32973 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
32974
32975
32976 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
32977 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
32978 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
32979 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
32980 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
32981
32982 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
32983 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
32984 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
32985 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
32986
32987 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
32988 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
32989 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
32990
32991
32992 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
32993 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
32994 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
32995 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
32996 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
32997 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
32998 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
32999 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
33000 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
33001 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
33002 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
33003
33004
33005
33006 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
33007 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
33008 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
33009 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
33010 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
33011 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
33012 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
33013 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
33014
33015
33016
33017 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
33018 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
33019 .cindex "message" "submission"
33020 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
33021 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
33022 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
33023 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33024 control setting.
33025
33026 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
33027 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
33028 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
33029 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
33030 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
33031 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
33032 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
33033 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
33034 line is added to the message.
33035
33036 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
33037 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
33038 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
33039 options true at the same time.
33040
33041 .cindex "submission mode"
33042 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
33043 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
33044 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
33045 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
33046
33047 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
33048 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
33049 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
33050 created as follows:
33051
33052 .ilist
33053 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
33054 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
33055 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
33056 .next
33057 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
33058 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
33059 .next
33060 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
33061 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
33062 .endlist
33063
33064 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
33065 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
33066 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
33067 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
33068
33069 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
33070 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
33071 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
33072 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
33073
33074
33075
33076 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
33077 "SECTheadersaddrem"
33078 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
33079 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
33080 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
33081 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
33082 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
33083 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
33084 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
33085
33086 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
33087 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
33088 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
33089 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
33090 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
33091 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
33092
33093 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
33094 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
33095 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
33096
33097 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
33098 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
33099 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
33100 .code
33101 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
33102 X-added-second: another added header line
33103 .endd
33104 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
33105
33106 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
33107 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
33108 Each header-line is separately expanded.
33109
33110 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
33111 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
33112 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
33113 not part of the names. For example:
33114 .code
33115 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
33116 .endd
33117
33118 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
33119 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
33120 Each item is separately expanded.
33121 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
33122 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
33123 will act as list separators.
33124
33125 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
33126 items are expanded at routing time,
33127 and then associated with all addresses that are
33128 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
33129 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
33130 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
33131
33132 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
33133 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
33134 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
33135 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
33136
33137 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
33138 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
33139 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
33140 requirements.
33141
33142 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
33143 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
33144 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
33145 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
33146 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
33147 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
33148 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
33149
33150 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
33151 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
33152 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
33153 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
33154
33155 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
33156 the following consequences:
33157
33158 .ilist
33159 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
33160 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
33161 to it, at all times.
33162 .next
33163 Header lines that are added by a router's
33164 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
33165 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
33166 .next
33167 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
33168 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
33169 .next
33170 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
33171 a later router or by a transport.
33172 .next
33173 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
33174 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
33175 .code
33176 headers_remove = subject
33177 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
33178 .endd
33179 .endlist
33180
33181 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
33182 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
33183
33184
33185
33186
33187
33188 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
33189 .cindex "address" "constructed"
33190 .cindex "constructed address"
33191 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
33192 the form
33193 .display
33194 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
33195 .endd
33196 For example:
33197 .code
33198 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
33199 .endd
33200 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
33201 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
33202 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
33203 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
33204 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
33205 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
33206 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
33207 there is no password file entry.
33208
33209 .cindex "RFC 2047"
33210 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
33211 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
33212 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
33213 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
33214 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
33215 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
33216 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
33217 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
33218
33219
33220
33221 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
33222 .cindex "case of local parts"
33223 .cindex "local part" "case of"
33224 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
33225 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
33226 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
33227 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
33228 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
33229 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
33230 router option.
33231
33232 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
33233 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
33234 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
33235 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
33236 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
33237 .code
33238 correct_case:
33239 driver = redirect
33240 domains = +local_domains
33241 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
33242 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
33243 @$domain
33244 .endd
33245 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
33246 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
33247 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
33248 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
33249 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
33250
33251
33252
33253 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
33254 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
33255 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
33256 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
33257 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
33258 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
33259 empty components for compatibility.
33260
33261
33262
33263 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
33264 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
33265 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
33266 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
33267 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
33268 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
33269
33270 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
33271 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
33272 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
33273 example, a header such as
33274 .code
33275 To: hare@teaparty
33276 .endd
33277 might get rewritten as
33278 .code
33279 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
33280 .endd
33281 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
33282 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
33283 been routed.
33284
33285 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
33286 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
33287 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
33288 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
33289 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
33290 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
33291 .ecindex IIDmesproc
33292
33293
33294
33295 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33296 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33297
33298 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
33299 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
33300 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
33301 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
33302 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
33303 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
33304 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
33305
33306 .ilist
33307 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
33308 .next
33309 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
33310 .next
33311 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
33312 .endlist
33313
33314 For mail delivery, the following are available:
33315
33316 .ilist
33317 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
33318 .next
33319 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
33320 &"lmtp"&);
33321 .next
33322 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
33323 transport);
33324 .next
33325 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
33326 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
33327 .endlist
33328
33329 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
33330 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
33331 used to contain the envelope information.
33332
33333
33334
33335 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
33336 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
33337 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
33338 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
33339 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
33340 .cindex "EHLO"
33341 .cindex "HELO"
33342 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33343 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
33344 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
33345 processing is the same in both cases.
33346
33347 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
33348 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
33349 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
33350 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
33351 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
33352 .cindex "transport" "filter"
33353 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
33354 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
33355 suppressed.
33356
33357 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
33358 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
33359 required for the transaction.
33360
33361 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
33362 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
33363 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
33364 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
33365 is called for verification.
33366
33367 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
33368 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
33369 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
33370
33371 .cindex "carriage return"
33372 .cindex "linefeed"
33373 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33374 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
33375 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33376 line terminator.
33377
33378 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
33379 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
33380 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
33381 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
33382 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
33383 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
33384 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
33385 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
33386 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
33387
33388 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
33389 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
33390 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
33391 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
33392
33393 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
33394 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
33395 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
33396 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
33397
33398 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
33399 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
33400 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
33401 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
33402 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
33403 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
33404 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
33405 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
33406 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
33407 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
33408
33409 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
33410 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
33411
33412 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
33413 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
33414 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
33415 square bracket of the IP address.
33416
33417
33418
33419
33420 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
33421 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
33422 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
33423 .cindex "host" "error"
33424 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
33425 message errors, and recipient errors.
33426
33427 .vlist
33428 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
33429 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
33430 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
33431
33432 .ilist
33433 Connection refused or timed out,
33434 .next
33435 Any error response code on connection,
33436 .next
33437 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
33438 .next
33439 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
33440 .next
33441 I/O errors at any time,
33442 .next
33443 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
33444 the &"."& at the end of the data.
33445 .endlist ilist
33446
33447 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
33448 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
33449 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
33450 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
33451 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
33452 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
33453 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
33454 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
33455
33456 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
33457 .cindex "message" "error"
33458 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
33459 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
33460 message errors are:
33461
33462 .ilist
33463 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
33464 the data,
33465 .next
33466 Timeout after MAIL,
33467 .next
33468 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
33469 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
33470 connection at any other time.
33471 .endlist ilist
33472
33473 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
33474 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
33475 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
33476 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
33477 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
33478 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
33479 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
33480 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
33481 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
33482 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
33483
33484 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
33485 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
33486 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
33487 response to MAIL.
33488
33489 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
33490 .cindex "recipient" "error"
33491 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
33492 recipient errors are:
33493
33494 .ilist
33495 Any error response to RCPT,
33496 .next
33497 Timeout after RCPT.
33498 .endlist
33499
33500 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
33501 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
33502 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
33503 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
33504 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
33505 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
33506 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
33507 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
33508 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
33509 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
33510 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
33511 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
33512 the retry clock is reset.
33513
33514 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
33515 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
33516 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
33517 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
33518 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
33519 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
33520 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
33521 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
33522 recipient's retry time.
33523 .endlist
33524
33525 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
33526 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
33527 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
33528 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
33529 until the next delivery attempt.
33530
33531 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
33532 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
33533 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
33534 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
33535 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
33536 is created.
33537
33538 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
33539 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
33540 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
33541 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
33542 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
33543 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
33544 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
33545
33546 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
33547 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
33548 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
33549 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
33550 then to be treated as a host error.
33551
33552 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
33553 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
33554 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
33555 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
33556 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
33557
33558
33559
33560
33561 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
33562 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
33563 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
33564 .cindex "inetd"
33565 .cindex "daemon"
33566 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
33567 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
33568 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
33569 .code
33570 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
33571 .endd
33572 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
33573 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
33574 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
33575 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
33576 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
33577 stream and exits with an error code.
33578
33579 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
33580 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
33581 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
33582 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
33583
33584 .cindex "carriage return"
33585 .cindex "linefeed"
33586 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
33587 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
33588 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
33589 line terminator.
33590 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
33591 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
33592 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
33593
33594 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
33595 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
33596 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
33597 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
33598 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
33599 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
33600 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
33601 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
33602
33603 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
33604 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
33605 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
33606 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
33607 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
33608 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
33609 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
33610 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
33611 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
33612
33613 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
33614 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
33615 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
33616
33617 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
33618 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
33619 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
33620 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
33621 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
33622
33623 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
33624 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
33625 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
33626 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
33627 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
33628 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
33629 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
33630
33631 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
33632 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
33633 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
33634 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
33635 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
33636
33637 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
33638 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
33639 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
33640 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
33641 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
33642 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
33643 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
33644 a delivery process.
33645
33646 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
33647 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
33648 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
33649 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
33650 however, available with &'inetd'&.
33651
33652 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
33653 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
33654 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
33655 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
33656
33657 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
33658 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
33659 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
33660
33661
33662
33663 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
33664 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
33665 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
33666 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
33667 the error response to the last command. The default value for
33668 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
33669 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
33670 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
33671
33672
33673 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
33674 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
33675 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
33676 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
33677 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
33678 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
33679 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
33680 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
33681 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
33682 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
33683 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
33684
33685
33686
33687 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
33688 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
33689 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
33690 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
33691 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
33692 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
33693 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
33694 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
33695
33696 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
33697 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
33698 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
33699 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
33700 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
33701 counted.
33702
33703 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
33704 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
33705 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
33706
33707 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
33708 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
33709 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
33710 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
33711 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
33712
33713
33714
33715
33716 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
33717 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
33718 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
33719 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
33720 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33721
33722 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
33723 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
33724 called with the &%-bv%& option.
33725
33726 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
33727 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
33728 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
33729 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
33730 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
33731 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
33732 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
33733 RCPT failures.
33734
33735
33736
33737 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
33738 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
33739 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
33740 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
33741 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
33742 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
33743 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
33744
33745 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
33746 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
33747 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
33748 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
33749 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
33750 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
33751 argument. For example,
33752 .code
33753 ETRN #brigadoon
33754 .endd
33755 runs the command
33756 .code
33757 exim -R brigadoon
33758 .endd
33759 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
33760 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
33761 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
33762 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
33763 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
33764
33765 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
33766 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
33767 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
33768 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
33769 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
33770 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
33771 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
33772 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
33773
33774 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
33775 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
33776 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
33777 whatever the form of its argument. For
33778 example:
33779 .code
33780 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
33781 $sender_host_address
33782 .endd
33783 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33784 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
33785 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
33786 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
33787 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
33788 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
33789 for it to change them before running the command.
33790
33791
33792
33793 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
33794 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
33795 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
33796 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
33797 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
33798 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
33799 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
33800 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
33801 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
33802 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
33803 runs for RCPT commands:
33804 .code
33805 accept hosts = :
33806 .endd
33807 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
33808
33809
33810
33811 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
33812 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
33813 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
33814 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
33815 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
33816 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
33817 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
33818 envelope along with the message.
33819
33820 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
33821 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
33822 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
33823 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
33824 can be used to specify it.
33825
33826 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
33827 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
33828 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
33829 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
33830 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
33831
33832 .vindex "&$host$&"
33833 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
33834 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
33835 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
33836 router:
33837 .code
33838 begin routers
33839 route_append:
33840 driver = manualroute
33841 transport = smtp_appendfile
33842 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
33843
33844 begin transports
33845 smtp_appendfile:
33846 driver = appendfile
33847 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
33848 batch_max = 1000
33849 use_bsmtp
33850 user = exim
33851 .endd
33852 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
33853 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
33854 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
33855
33856
33857
33858 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
33859 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
33860 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
33861 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
33862 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
33863 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
33864 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
33865 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
33866 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
33867 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
33868
33869 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
33870 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
33871
33872 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
33873 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
33874 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
33875 make some use of automatically, for example:
33876 .code
33877 554 Unexpected end of file
33878 Transaction started in line 10
33879 Error detected in line 14
33880 .endd
33881 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
33882 file, for example:
33883 .code
33884 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
33885 The error message was:
33886
33887 501 '>' missing at end of address
33888
33889 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
33890 The error was detected in line 12.
33891 The SMTP command at fault was:
33892
33893 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
33894
33895 1 previous message was successfully processed.
33896 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
33897 .endd
33898 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
33899 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
33900 accepted.
33901 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
33902 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
33903
33904
33905
33906 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33907 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33908
33909 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
33910 "Customizing messages"
33911 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
33912 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
33913 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
33914 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
33915 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
33916
33917 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
33918 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
33919 option. Exim also adds the line
33920 .code
33921 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
33922 .endd
33923 to all warning and bounce messages,
33924
33925
33926 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
33927 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
33928 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
33929 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
33930 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
33931 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
33932 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
33933
33934 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
33935 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
33936 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
33937 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
33938 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
33939 item.
33940
33941 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
33942 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
33943 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
33944 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
33945 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
33946 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
33947 option, rounded to a whole number.
33948
33949 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
33950
33951 .ilist
33952 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
33953 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
33954 .next
33955 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
33956 failing addresses with their error messages.
33957 .next
33958 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
33959 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
33960 .next
33961 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
33962 The fields exist for back-compatibility
33963 .endlist
33964
33965 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
33966 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
33967 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
33968 .code
33969 Subject: Mail delivery failed
33970 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
33971 {: returning message to sender}}
33972 ****
33973 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
33974
33975 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
33976 {that you sent }{sent by
33977
33978 <$sender_address>
33979
33980 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
33981 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
33982 ****
33983 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
33984 ****
33985 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
33986 ------
33987 ****
33988 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
33989 only the first
33990 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
33991 ****
33992 .endd
33993 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
33994 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
33995 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
33996 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
33997 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
33998 text sections:
33999
34000 .ilist
34001 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
34002 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
34003 .next
34004 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
34005 the delayed addresses.
34006 .next
34007 The third item then ends the message.
34008 .endlist
34009
34010 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
34011 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
34012 .code
34013 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
34014 $warn_message_delay
34015 ****
34016 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
34017
34018 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
34019 {that you sent }{sent by
34020
34021 <$sender_address>
34022
34023 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
34024 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
34025
34026 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
34027 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
34028 The date of the message is: $h_date
34029
34030 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
34031 ****
34032 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
34033 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
34034 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
34035 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
34036 the message will be returned to you.
34037 .endd
34038 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
34039 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
34040 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
34041 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
34042 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
34043 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
34044 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
34045 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
34046 handled them.
34047
34048
34049
34050
34051 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34052 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34053
34054 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
34055 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
34056 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
34057
34058
34059
34060 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
34061 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
34062 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
34063 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
34064 routing explicitly:
34065 .code
34066 send_to_smart_host:
34067 driver = manualroute
34068 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
34069 transport = remote_smtp
34070 .endd
34071 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
34072 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
34073 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
34074 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
34075 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
34076
34077
34078
34079
34080 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
34081 .cindex "mailing lists"
34082 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
34083 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
34084 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
34085
34086 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
34087 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
34088 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
34089 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
34090 .code
34091 lists:
34092 driver = redirect
34093 domains = lists.example
34094 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34095 forbid_pipe
34096 forbid_file
34097 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34098 no_more
34099 .endd
34100 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
34101 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
34102 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
34103 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
34104
34105 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
34106 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
34107 a mailing list.
34108
34109 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
34110 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
34111 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
34112 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
34113 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
34114
34115 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
34116 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
34117 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
34118 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
34119 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
34120 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
34121 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
34122 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
34123 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
34124
34125
34126
34127 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
34128 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
34129 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
34130 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
34131 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
34132 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
34133 addresses are not rigorously checked.
34134
34135 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
34136 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
34137 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
34138 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
34139 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
34140
34141
34142
34143 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
34144 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
34145 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
34146 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
34147 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
34148 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
34149 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
34150 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
34151 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
34152 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
34153
34154 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
34155 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
34156 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
34157 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
34158 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
34159 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
34160 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
34161 pre-existing messages.
34162
34163 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
34164 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
34165 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
34166 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
34167 one level of expansion anyway.
34168
34169
34170
34171 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
34172 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
34173 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
34174 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
34175 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
34176 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
34177
34178 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
34179 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
34180 .code
34181 lists_request:
34182 driver = redirect
34183 domains = lists.example
34184 local_part_suffix = -request
34185 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
34186 no_more
34187
34188 lists_post:
34189 driver = redirect
34190 domains = lists.example
34191 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
34192 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
34193 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
34194 forbid_pipe
34195 forbid_file
34196 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
34197 no_more
34198
34199 lists_closed:
34200 driver = redirect
34201 domains = lists.example
34202 allow_fail
34203 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
34204 .endd
34205 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
34206 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
34207 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
34208 mailing list.
34209
34210 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
34211 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
34212 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
34213 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
34214 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
34215 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
34216 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
34217 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
34218 &"unrouteable address"& error.
34219
34220 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
34221 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
34222 the address, giving a suitable error message.
34223
34224
34225
34226
34227 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
34228 .cindex "VERP"
34229 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
34230 .cindex "envelope sender"
34231 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
34232 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
34233 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
34234 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
34235 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
34236 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
34237
34238 .oindex &%errors_to%&
34239 .oindex &%return_path%&
34240 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
34241 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
34242 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
34243 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
34244 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
34245 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
34246 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
34247 .code
34248 verp_smtp:
34249 driver = smtp
34250 max_rcpt = 1
34251 return_path = \
34252 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34253 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34254 .endd
34255 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
34256 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
34257 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
34258 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
34259 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
34260 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
34261 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
34262 rewritten as
34263 .code
34264 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
34265 .endd
34266 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34267 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
34268 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
34269 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
34270 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
34271 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
34272
34273 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
34274 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
34275 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
34276 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
34277 .code
34278 dnslookup:
34279 driver = dnslookup
34280 domains = ! +local_domains
34281 transport = \
34282 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
34283 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
34284 no_more
34285 .endd
34286 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
34287 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
34288 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
34289 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
34290 address.
34291
34292 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
34293 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
34294 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
34295 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
34296 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
34297 .code
34298 verp_dnslookup:
34299 driver = dnslookup
34300 domains = ! +local_domains
34301 transport = remote_smtp
34302 errors_to = \
34303 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
34304 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
34305 no_more
34306 .endd
34307 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
34308 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
34309 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
34310 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
34311 them.
34312
34313 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
34314 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
34315 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
34316 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
34317 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
34318 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
34319 used).
34320
34321
34322
34323
34324
34325
34326 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
34327 .cindex "virtual domains"
34328 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
34329 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
34330 meanings:
34331
34332 .ilist
34333 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
34334 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
34335 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
34336 .next
34337 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
34338 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
34339 have login accounts on that host.
34340 .endlist
34341
34342 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
34343 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
34344 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
34345 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
34346 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
34347 to a router of this form:
34348 .code
34349 virtual:
34350 driver = redirect
34351 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
34352 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
34353 no_more
34354 .endd
34355 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
34356 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
34357 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
34358 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
34359 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
34360 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
34361
34362 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
34363 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
34364 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
34365 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
34366
34367 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
34368 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
34369 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
34370 .code
34371 my_domains:
34372 driver = accept
34373 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
34374 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
34375 transport = my_mailboxes
34376 .endd
34377 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
34378 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
34379 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
34380 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
34381 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
34382 follows:
34383 .code
34384 my_mailboxes:
34385 driver = appendfile
34386 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
34387 user = mail
34388 .endd
34389 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
34390 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
34391
34392 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
34393 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
34394 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
34395 information about the domains.
34396
34397
34398
34399 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
34400 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
34401 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
34402 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
34403 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
34404 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
34405 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
34406 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
34407 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
34408 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
34409 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
34410 example, consider this router:
34411 .code
34412 userforward:
34413 driver = redirect
34414 check_local_user
34415 file = $home/.forward
34416 local_part_suffix = -*
34417 local_part_suffix_optional
34418 allow_filter
34419 .endd
34420 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
34421 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
34422 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
34423 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
34424 .code
34425 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
34426 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
34427 endif
34428 .endd
34429 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
34430 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
34431 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
34432 control over which suffixes are valid.
34433
34434 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
34435 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
34436 another MTA:
34437 .code
34438 userforward:
34439 driver = redirect
34440 check_local_user
34441 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
34442 local_part_suffix = -*
34443 local_part_suffix_optional
34444 allow_filter
34445 .endd
34446 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
34447 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
34448 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
34449 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
34450 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
34451
34452
34453
34454 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
34455 .cindex "vacation processing"
34456 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
34457 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
34458 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
34459 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
34460 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
34461
34462 .ilist
34463 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
34464 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
34465 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
34466 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
34467 .code
34468 spqr, vacation-spqr
34469 .endd
34470 .next
34471 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
34472 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
34473 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
34474 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
34475 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
34476 message.
34477 .endlist
34478
34479 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
34480 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
34481
34482
34483
34484 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
34485 .cindex "message" "copying every"
34486 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
34487 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
34488 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
34489 each day's messages.
34490
34491 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
34492 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
34493 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
34494 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
34495
34496
34497
34498 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
34499 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
34500 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
34501 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
34502 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
34503 permanently connected.
34504
34505 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
34506 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
34507 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
34508
34509
34510 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
34511 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
34512 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
34513 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
34514 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
34515 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
34516 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
34517 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
34518
34519 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
34520 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
34521 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
34522 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
34523 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
34524 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
34525 if required.
34526
34527 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
34528 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
34529 intermittent host. For example:
34530 .code
34531 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
34532 .endd
34533 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
34534 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
34535 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
34536 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
34537 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
34538 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
34539 immediately.
34540
34541 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
34542 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
34543 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
34544 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
34545 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
34546 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
34547 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
34548
34549
34550
34551 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
34552 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
34553 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
34554 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
34555 delivered immediately.
34556
34557 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34558 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
34559 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
34560 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
34561 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
34562 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
34563 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
34564 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
34565 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
34566 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
34567 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
34568 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
34569 single SMTP connection.
34570
34571
34572
34573 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34574 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34575
34576 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
34577 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
34578 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
34579 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
34580 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
34581 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
34582 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
34583 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
34584 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
34585 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
34586 messages this way.
34587
34588 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
34589 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
34590 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
34591 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
34592 email is not desirable.
34593
34594 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
34595 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
34596 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
34597 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
34598 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
34599 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
34600 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
34601
34602 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
34603 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
34604 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
34605 before sending a message to the smart host.
34606
34607 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
34608 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
34609 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
34610
34611 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
34612 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
34613 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
34614 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
34615 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
34616 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
34617 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
34618
34619 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
34620 following ways:
34621
34622 .ilist
34623 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
34624 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
34625 .next
34626 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
34627 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
34628 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
34629 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
34630 successful, a zero return code is given.
34631 .next
34632 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
34633 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
34634 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
34635 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
34636 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
34637 are.
34638 .next
34639 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
34640 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
34641 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
34642 .next
34643 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
34644 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
34645 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
34646 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
34647 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
34648 .next
34649 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
34650 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
34651 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
34652 .next
34653 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
34654 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
34655 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
34656 are ever generated.
34657 .next
34658 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
34659 .next
34660 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
34661 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
34662 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
34663 .endlist
34664
34665 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
34666 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
34667 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
34668 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
34669 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
34670 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
34671
34672
34673
34674
34675 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34676 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34677
34678 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
34679 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
34680 .cindex "log" "types of"
34681 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
34682 and the panic log:
34683
34684 .ilist
34685 .cindex "main log"
34686 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
34687 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
34688 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
34689 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
34690 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
34691 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
34692 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
34693 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
34694 .next
34695 .cindex "reject log"
34696 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
34697 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
34698 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
34699 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
34700 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
34701 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
34702 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
34703 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
34704 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
34705 false.
34706 .next
34707 .cindex "panic log"
34708 .cindex "system log"
34709 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
34710 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
34711 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
34712 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
34713 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
34714 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
34715 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
34716 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
34717 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
34718 .endlist
34719
34720 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
34721 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
34722 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
34723 .code
34724 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
34725 by QUIT
34726 .endd
34727 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
34728 ways of changing this:
34729
34730 .ilist
34731 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
34732 you set
34733 .code
34734 timezone = UTC
34735 .endd
34736 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
34737 .next
34738 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
34739 example:
34740 .code
34741 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
34742 .endd
34743 .endlist
34744
34745 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
34746 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
34747 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
34748 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
34749 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
34750 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
34751
34752
34753
34754
34755 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
34756 .cindex "log" "destination"
34757 .cindex "log" "to file"
34758 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
34759 .cindex "syslog"
34760 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
34761 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
34762 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
34763 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
34764 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
34765 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
34766 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
34767
34768 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
34769 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
34770 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
34771 references to the host name:
34772 .code
34773 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
34774 .endd
34775 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
34776 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
34777 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
34778 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
34779 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
34780 log at all.
34781
34782 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
34783 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
34784 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
34785 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
34786 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
34787 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
34788 implying the use of a default path.
34789
34790 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
34791 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
34792 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
34793 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
34794 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
34795 equivalent to the setting:
34796 .code
34797 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
34798 .endd
34799 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
34800 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
34801 that is where the logs are written.
34802
34803 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
34804 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
34805
34806 Here are some examples of possible settings:
34807 .display
34808 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
34809 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
34810 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
34811 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
34812 .endd
34813 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
34814 error is logged.
34815
34816
34817
34818 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
34819 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
34820 .cindex "cycling logs"
34821 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
34822 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
34823 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
34824 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
34825 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
34826 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
34827 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
34828
34829 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
34830 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
34831 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
34832 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
34833 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
34834 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
34835 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
34836 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
34837 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
34838 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
34839 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
34840 renamed.
34841
34842
34843
34844 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
34845 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
34846 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
34847 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
34848 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
34849 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
34850 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
34851 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
34852 .code
34853 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
34854 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
34855 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
34856 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
34857 .endd
34858 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
34859 examples of names generated by the above examples:
34860 .code
34861 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
34862 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
34863 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
34864 /var/log/exim/main.200212
34865 .endd
34866 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
34867 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
34868 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
34869 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
34870
34871 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
34872 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
34873 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
34874 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
34875 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
34876 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
34877 log names:
34878 .code
34879 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
34880 /var/log/exim-panic.log
34881 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
34882 /var/log/exim/panic
34883 .endd
34884
34885
34886 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
34887 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
34888 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
34889 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
34890 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
34891 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
34892 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
34893 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
34894 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
34895 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
34896 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
34897 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
34898 the time and host name to each line.
34899 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
34900
34901 .ilist
34902 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
34903 .next
34904 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
34905 .next
34906 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
34907 .endlist
34908
34909 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
34910 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
34911 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
34912 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
34913
34914 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
34915 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
34916 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
34917 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
34918 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
34919 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
34920 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
34921 RFC 3164, you should set
34922 .code
34923 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
34924 .endd
34925 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
34926 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
34927
34928 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
34929 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
34930 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
34931 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
34932 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
34933 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
34934 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
34935 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
34936 name, and pid as added by syslog:
34937 .code
34938 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
34939 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
34940 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
34941 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
34942 [5/5] mple>)
34943 .endd
34944 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
34945 (LOG_NOTICE):
34946 .code
34947 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
34948 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
34949 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
34950 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
34951 [5\18] .example>)
34952 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
34953 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
34954 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
34955 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
34956 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
34957 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
34958 [12\18] F From: <>
34959 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
34960 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
34961 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
34962 [16\18] le>
34963 [17\18] B Bcc:
34964 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
34965 .endd
34966 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
34967 without modification.
34968
34969 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
34970 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
34971 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
34972 where it is.
34973
34974
34975
34976 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
34977 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
34978 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
34979 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
34980 timestamp. The flags are:
34981 .display
34982 &`<=`& message arrival
34983 &`=>`& normal message delivery
34984 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
34985 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
34986 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
34987 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
34988 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
34989 .endd
34990
34991
34992 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
34993 .cindex "log" "reception line"
34994 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
34995 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
34996 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
34997 .code
34998 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
34999 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
35000 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
35001 .endd
35002 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
35003 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
35004 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
35005 .code
35006 R=<message id>
35007 .endd
35008 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
35009
35010 .cindex "HELO"
35011 .cindex "EHLO"
35012 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
35013 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
35014 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
35015 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
35016 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
35017 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
35018 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
35019 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
35020 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
35021 name in parentheses.
35022
35023 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
35024 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
35025 the log containing text like these examples:
35026 .code
35027 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
35028 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
35029 .endd
35030 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
35031 on.
35032
35033 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
35034 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
35035 of Exim.
35036
35037 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
35038 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
35039 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
35040 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
35041 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
35042 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
35043 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
35044 suite that was used.
35045
35046 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
35047 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
35048 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
35049 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
35050 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
35051 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
35052 authenticator name.
35053
35054 .cindex "size" "of message"
35055 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
35056 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
35057 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
35058 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
35059 other).
35060
35061 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35062 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35063
35064
35065
35066 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
35067 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
35068 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
35069 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
35070 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
35071 to fit it on the page:
35072 .code
35073 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
35074 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
35075 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
35076 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
35077 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
35078 .endd
35079 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
35080 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
35081 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
35082 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
35083 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
35084
35085 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
35086 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
35087 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
35088 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
35089
35090 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
35091 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
35092 .display
35093 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
35094 .endd
35095 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
35096 parentheses afterwards.
35097
35098 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35099 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
35100 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
35101 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
35102 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
35103 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
35104
35105 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
35106 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
35107 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
35108 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
35109 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
35110
35111 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
35112 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
35113
35114 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
35115 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
35116
35117
35118 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
35119 .cindex "discarded messages"
35120 .cindex "message" "discarded"
35121 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
35122 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
35123 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
35124 .code
35125 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
35126 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
35127 .endd
35128 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
35129 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
35130 .code
35131 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
35132 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
35133 .endd
35134
35135
35136 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
35137 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
35138 .code
35139 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
35140 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
35141 .endd
35142 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
35143 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
35144 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
35145 .code
35146 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
35147 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
35148 .endd
35149 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
35150 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
35151 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
35152
35153
35154
35155 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
35156 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
35157 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
35158 following form is logged:
35159 .code
35160 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
35161 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
35162 .endd
35163 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
35164 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
35165 .code
35166 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
35167 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
35168 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
35169 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
35170 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
35171 .endd
35172 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
35173 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
35174 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
35175 flagged with &`**`&.
35176
35177
35178
35179 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
35180 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
35181 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
35182 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
35183 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
35184
35185
35186
35187 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
35188 A line of the form
35189 .code
35190 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
35191 .endd
35192 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
35193 at the end of its processing.
35194
35195
35196
35197
35198 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
35199 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
35200 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
35201 the following table:
35202 .display
35203 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
35204 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
35205 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35206 &`CV `& certificate verification status
35207 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
35208 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
35209 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
35210 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
35211 &`H `& host name and IP address
35212 &`I `& local interface used
35213 &`id `& message id for incoming message
35214 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
35215 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
35216 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
35217 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
35218 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
35219 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
35220 &`S `& size of message
35221 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
35222 &`ST `& shadow transport name
35223 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
35224 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
35225 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
35226 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
35227 .endd
35228
35229
35230 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
35231 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
35232 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
35233
35234 .ilist
35235 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
35236 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
35237 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
35238 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
35239 during the first delivery attempt.
35240 .next
35241 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
35242 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
35243 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
35244 .next
35245 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
35246 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
35247 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
35248 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
35249 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
35250 doing.
35251 .next
35252 .cindex "error" "ignored"
35253 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
35254 message:
35255 .olist
35256 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
35257 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
35258 .next
35259 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
35260 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35261 .next
35262 A delivery set up by a router configured with
35263 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
35264 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
35265 .code
35266 errors_to = <>
35267 .endd
35268 failed. The delivery was discarded.
35269 .endlist olist
35270 .endlist ilist
35271
35272
35273
35274
35275
35276 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
35277 .cindex "log" "selectors"
35278 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
35279 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
35280 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
35281 example:
35282 .code
35283 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
35284 .endd
35285 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
35286 selection marked by asterisks:
35287 .display
35288 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
35289 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
35290 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
35291 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
35292 &` arguments `& command line arguments
35293 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
35294 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
35295 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
35296 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
35297 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
35298 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
35299 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
35300 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
35301 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
35302 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
35303 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
35304 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
35305 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
35306 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
35307 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
35308 &` pid `& Exim process id
35309 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
35310 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
35311 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
35312 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
35313 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
35314 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
35315 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
35316 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
35317 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
35318 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
35319 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
35320 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
35321 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
35322 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
35323 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
35324 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
35325 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
35326 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
35327 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
35328 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
35329 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
35330 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
35331
35332 &` all `& all of the above
35333 .endd
35334 More details on each of these items follows:
35335
35336 .ilist
35337 .cindex "8BITMIME"
35338 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
35339 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
35340 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
35341 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
35342 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
35343 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
35344 .next
35345 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
35346 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
35347 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
35348 this log selector is set.
35349 .next
35350 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
35351 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
35352 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
35353 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
35354 such users cannot access the log).
35355 .next
35356 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
35357 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
35358 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
35359 parentheses between them.
35360 .next
35361 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
35362 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
35363 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
35364 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
35365 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
35366 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
35367 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
35368 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
35369 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
35370 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
35371 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
35372 between the caller and Exim.
35373 .next
35374 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
35375 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
35376 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
35377 .next
35378 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
35379 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
35380 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
35381 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
35382 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
35383 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
35384 .next
35385 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
35386 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
35387 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
35388 .next
35389 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
35390 .cindex "size" "of message"
35391 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
35392 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
35393 .next
35394 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
35395 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
35396 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
35397 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
35398 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
35399 .next
35400 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
35401 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
35402 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
35403 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
35404 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
35405 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
35406 .next
35407 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
35408 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
35409 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
35410 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
35411 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
35412 .next
35413 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
35414 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
35415 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
35416 client's ident port times out.
35417 .next
35418 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
35419 .cindex "log" "local interface"
35420 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
35421 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
35422 .cindex "interface" "logging"
35423 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
35424 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
35425 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
35426 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"& and to
35427 rejection lines
35428 and (despite the name) the local interface is added to &"=>"& lines..
35429 .next
35430 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
35431 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
35432 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
35433 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
35434 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
35435 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
35436 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
35437 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
35438 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
35439 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
35440 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
35441 .next
35442 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
35443 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
35444 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
35445 .next
35446 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
35447 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
35448 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
35449 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
35450 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
35451 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
35452 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
35453 .next
35454 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
35455 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
35456 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
35457 immediately after the time and date.
35458 .next
35459 .cindex "log" "queue run"
35460 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
35461 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
35462 .next
35463 .cindex "log" "queue time"
35464 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
35465 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
35466 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
35467 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
35468 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
35469 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
35470 message has been successfully received.
35471 .next
35472 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
35473 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
35474 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
35475 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
35476 .next
35477 .cindex "log" "recipients"
35478 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
35479 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
35480 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
35481 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
35482 has taken place.
35483 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
35484 in the list.
35485 .next
35486 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
35487 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
35488 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
35489 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
35490 .next
35491 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
35492 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
35493 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
35494 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
35495 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
35496 .next
35497 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
35498 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
35499 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
35500 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
35501 attempt.
35502 .next
35503 .cindex "log" "return path"
35504 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
35505 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
35506 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
35507 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
35508 .next
35509 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
35510 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
35511 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
35512 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
35513 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
35514 .next
35515 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
35516 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
35517 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
35518 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
35519 detail is lost.
35520 .next
35521 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
35522 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
35523 it is too big.
35524 .next
35525 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
35526 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
35527 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
35528 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
35529 it.
35530 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
35531 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
35532 .next
35533 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
35534 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
35535 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
35536 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
35537 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
35538 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
35539 response.
35540 .next
35541 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
35542 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
35543 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
35544 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
35545 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
35546 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
35547 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
35548 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
35549 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
35550 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
35551
35552 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
35553 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
35554 reset if the daemon is restarted.
35555 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
35556 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
35557 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
35558 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
35559 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
35560 .next
35561 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
35562 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
35563 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
35564 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
35565 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
35566 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
35567 .next
35568 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
35569 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
35570 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
35571 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
35572 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
35573 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
35574 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
35575 already have their own log lines.
35576
35577 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
35578 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
35579 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
35580 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
35581 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
35582 the same logging options.
35583
35584 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
35585 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
35586 .code
35587 C=EHLO,QUIT
35588 .endd
35589 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
35590 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
35591 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
35592 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
35593 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
35594 .next
35595 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
35596 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
35597 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
35598 was accepted or used.
35599 .next
35600 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
35601 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
35602 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
35603 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
35604 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
35605 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
35606 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
35607 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
35608 .next
35609 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
35610 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
35611 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
35612 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
35613 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
35614 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
35615 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
35616 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
35617 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
35618 .next
35619 .cindex "log" "subject"
35620 .cindex "subject, logging"
35621 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
35622 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
35623 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
35624 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
35625 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
35626 .next
35627 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
35628 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
35629 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
35630 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
35631 .next
35632 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
35633 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
35634 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35635 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
35636 .next
35637 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
35638 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
35639 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
35640 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
35641 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
35642 .next
35643 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
35644 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
35645 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
35646 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
35647 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
35648 .next
35649 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
35650 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
35651 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
35652 .endlist
35653
35654
35655 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
35656 .cindex "message" "log file for"
35657 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
35658 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
35659 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
35660 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
35661 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
35662 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
35663 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
35664 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
35665 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
35666 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
35667 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
35668
35669 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
35670 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
35671 &%message_logs%& option false.
35672 .ecindex IIDloggen
35673
35674
35675
35676
35677 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35678 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35679
35680 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
35681 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
35682 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
35683 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
35684 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
35685
35686 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
35687 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
35688 "list what Exim processes are doing"
35689 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
35690 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
35691 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
35692 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
35693 various criteria"
35694 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
35695 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
35696 "extract statistics from the log"
35697 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
35698 "check address acceptance from given IP"
35699 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
35700 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
35701 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
35702 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
35703 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
35704 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
35705 .endtable
35706
35707 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
35708 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
35709 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
35710
35711
35712
35713
35714 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
35715 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
35716 .cindex "process, querying"
35717 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
35718 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
35719 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
35720 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
35721 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
35722 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
35723 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
35724 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
35725 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
35726
35727 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
35728 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
35729 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
35730
35731
35732 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
35733 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
35734 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
35735 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
35736 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
35737 options:
35738 .display
35739 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
35740 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
35741 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
35742 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
35743 .endd
35744 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
35745 .code
35746 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
35747 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
35748 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
35749 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
35750 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
35751 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
35752 .endd
35753 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
35754 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
35755
35756
35757
35758 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
35759 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
35760 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
35761 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
35762 .code
35763 exim -bpu
35764 .endd
35765 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
35766 .code
35767 exim -bp
35768 .endd
35769 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
35770 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
35771
35772 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
35773 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
35774
35775 .vlist
35776 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
35777 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35778 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
35779 .code
35780 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
35781 .endd
35782 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
35783 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
35784 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
35785
35786 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
35787 Match against the size field.
35788
35789 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35790 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
35791
35792 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
35793 Match messages that are older than the given time.
35794
35795 .vitem &*-z*&
35796 Match only frozen messages.
35797
35798 .vitem &*-x*&
35799 Match only non-frozen messages.
35800 .endlist
35801
35802 The following options control the format of the output:
35803
35804 .vlist
35805 .vitem &*-c*&
35806 Display only the count of matching messages.
35807
35808 .vitem &*-l*&
35809 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
35810 the default.
35811
35812 .vitem &*-i*&
35813 Display message ids only.
35814
35815 .vitem &*-b*&
35816 Brief format &-- one line per message.
35817
35818 .vitem &*-R*&
35819 Display messages in reverse order.
35820
35821 .vitem &*-a*&
35822 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
35823 .endlist
35824
35825 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
35826
35827
35828
35829 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
35830 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
35831 .cindex "queue" "summary"
35832 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
35833 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
35834 running a command such as
35835 .code
35836 exim -bp | exiqsumm
35837 .endd
35838 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
35839 it, as in the following example:
35840 .code
35841 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
35842 .endd
35843 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
35844 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
35845 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
35846 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
35847
35848 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
35849 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
35850 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
35851 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
35852 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
35853 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
35854 sender.
35855
35856 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
35857 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
35858 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
35859 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
35860 level"& addresses).
35861
35862
35863
35864
35865 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
35866 "SECTextspeinf"
35867 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
35868 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
35869 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
35870 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
35871 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
35872 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
35873 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
35874 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
35875 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
35876 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
35877 .display
35878 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
35879 .endd
35880 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
35881
35882 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
35883 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
35884 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
35885
35886 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
35887 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
35888 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
35889 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
35890 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
35891
35892 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
35893 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
35894 regular expression.
35895
35896 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
35897 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
35898
35899 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
35900 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
35901 normally.
35902
35903 Example of &%-M%&:
35904 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
35905 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
35906 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
35907 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
35908 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
35909 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
35910 search term.
35911
35912 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
35913 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
35914 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
35915 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
35916 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
35917
35918
35919 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
35920 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
35921 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
35922 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
35923 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
35924 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
35925 the &%--help%& option.
35926
35927
35928 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
35929 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
35930 .cindex "cycling logs"
35931 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
35932 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
35933 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
35934 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
35935 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
35936 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
35937 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
35938 .ilist
35939 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
35940 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
35941 .next
35942 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
35943 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
35944 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
35945 configuration.
35946 .endlist
35947
35948 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
35949 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
35950 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
35951 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
35952 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
35953 logs are handled similarly.
35954
35955 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
35956 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
35957 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
35958 any existing log files.
35959
35960 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
35961 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
35962 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
35963 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
35964 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
35965 .code
35966 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
35967 .endd
35968 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
35969 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
35970
35971
35972
35973 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
35974 .cindex "statistics"
35975 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
35976 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
35977 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
35978 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
35979 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
35980
35981 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
35982 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
35983 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
35984 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
35985 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
35986 .code
35987 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
35988 .endd
35989 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
35990 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
35991 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
35992 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
35993 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
35994 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
35995 also produced per user.
35996
35997 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
35998 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
35999 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
36000 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
36001 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
36002
36003 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
36004 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
36005 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
36006 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
36007 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
36008 an entirely separate message.
36009
36010 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
36011 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
36012 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
36013 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
36014 least one address that failed.
36015
36016 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
36017 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
36018 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
36019 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
36020 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
36021 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
36022 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
36023
36024 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
36025 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
36026 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
36027
36028 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
36029 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
36030 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
36031 .code
36032 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
36033 .endd
36034
36035 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
36036 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
36037 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
36038 .cindex "checking access"
36039 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
36040 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
36041 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
36042 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
36043 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
36044 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
36045
36046 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
36047 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
36048 .code
36049 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
36050 .endd
36051 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
36052 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
36053 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
36054 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
36055 .code
36056 Rejected:
36057 550 Relay not permitted
36058 .endd
36059 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
36060 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
36061 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
36062 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
36063 you can use:
36064 .code
36065 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
36066 -f himself@there.example
36067 .endd
36068 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
36069 mandatory arguments.
36070
36071 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
36072 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
36073 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
36074
36075
36076
36077 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
36078 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
36079 .cindex "building DBM files"
36080 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
36081 .cindex "lower casing"
36082 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
36083 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
36084 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
36085 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
36086 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
36087 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
36088
36089 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
36090 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
36091 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
36092 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
36093 files.
36094
36095 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
36096 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
36097 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
36098 well.
36099
36100 .cindex "USE_DB"
36101 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
36102 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
36103 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
36104 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
36105 .code
36106 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
36107 .endd
36108 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
36109 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
36110
36111 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
36112 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
36113 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
36114 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
36115 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
36116 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
36117
36118 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
36119 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
36120 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
36121 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
36122 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
36123 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
36124 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
36125 return code is 2.
36126
36127
36128
36129
36130 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
36131 .cindex "retry" "times"
36132 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
36133 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
36134 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
36135 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
36136 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
36137 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
36138 output. For example:
36139 .code
36140 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
36141 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
36142 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36143 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
36144 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
36145 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
36146 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
36147 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
36148 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
36149 past final cutoff time
36150 .endd
36151 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
36152 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
36153 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
36154 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
36155 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
36156 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
36157 run very often.
36158
36159 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
36160 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
36161 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
36162 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
36163 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
36164 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
36165
36166
36167
36168 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
36169 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
36170 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
36171 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
36172 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
36173 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
36174 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
36175
36176 .ilist
36177 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
36178 .next
36179 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
36180 for remote hosts
36181 .next
36182 &'callout'&: the callout cache
36183 .next
36184 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
36185 .next
36186 &'misc'&: other hints data
36187 .endlist
36188
36189 The &'misc'& database is used for
36190
36191 .ilist
36192 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
36193 .next
36194 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
36195 &(smtp)& transport)
36196 .endlist
36197
36198
36199
36200 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
36201 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
36202 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
36203 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
36204 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
36205 .code
36206 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
36207 .endd
36208 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
36209 .code
36210 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
36211 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
36212 .endd
36213 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
36214 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
36215 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
36216 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
36217 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
36218 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
36219 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
36220 and a textual description of the error.
36221
36222 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
36223 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
36224 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
36225 exceeded.
36226
36227 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
36228 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
36229 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
36230 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
36231 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
36232 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
36233 cross-references.
36234
36235
36236
36237 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
36238 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
36239 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
36240 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
36241 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
36242 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
36243 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
36244 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
36245 updated sufficiently often.
36246
36247 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
36248 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
36249 the retry database:
36250 .code
36251 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
36252 .endd
36253 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
36254 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
36255 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
36256 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
36257 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
36258 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
36259 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
36260 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
36261 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
36262 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
36263 whenever it removes information from the database.
36264
36265 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
36266 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
36267 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
36268 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
36269 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
36270
36271 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
36272 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
36273 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
36274 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
36275 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
36276 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
36277 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
36278 tidied.
36279
36280 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
36281 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
36282
36283
36284
36285
36286 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
36287 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
36288 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
36289 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
36290 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
36291 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
36292 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
36293 displayed.
36294
36295 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
36296 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
36297 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
36298 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
36299 by new data, for example:
36300 .code
36301 > 4 951102:1000
36302 .endd
36303 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
36304 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
36305 used as optional separators.
36306
36307
36308
36309
36310 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
36311 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
36312 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
36313 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
36314 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
36315 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
36316 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
36317 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
36318 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
36319 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
36320 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
36321 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
36322 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
36323
36324 .vlist
36325 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
36326 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
36327
36328 .vitem &%-flock%&
36329 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
36330 supports it.
36331
36332 .vitem &%-interval%&
36333 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
36334 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
36335
36336 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
36337 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
36338
36339 .vitem &%-mbx%&
36340 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
36341
36342 .vitem &%-q%&
36343 Suppress verification output.
36344
36345 .vitem &%-retries%&
36346 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
36347 the lock (default 10).
36348
36349 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
36350 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
36351 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
36352 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
36353 subsequently sees.
36354
36355 .vitem &%-timeout%&
36356 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
36357 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
36358 default), a non-blocking call is used.
36359
36360 .vitem &%-v%&
36361 Generate verbose output.
36362 .endlist
36363
36364 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
36365 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
36366 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
36367 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
36368 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
36369 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
36370 more than 30 minutes old.
36371
36372 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
36373 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
36374 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
36375 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
36376 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
36377 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
36378
36379 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
36380 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
36381 suppresses all output except error messages.
36382
36383 A command such as
36384 .code
36385 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
36386 .endd
36387 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
36388 .display
36389 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
36390 <&'some commands'&>
36391 &`End`&
36392 .endd
36393 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
36394 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
36395 such as
36396 .code
36397 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
36398 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
36399 .endd
36400 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
36401 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
36402 .ecindex IIDutils
36403
36404
36405 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36406 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36407
36408 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
36409 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
36410 .cindex "X-windows"
36411 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
36412 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
36413 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
36414 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
36415 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
36416 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
36417 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
36418 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
36419
36420
36421
36422 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
36423 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
36424 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
36425 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
36426 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
36427 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
36428 parameters are for.
36429
36430 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
36431 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
36432 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
36433 .code
36434 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
36435 .endd
36436 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
36437 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
36438 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
36439 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
36440 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
36441
36442 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
36443 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
36444 .code
36445 Eximon*background: gray94
36446 .endd
36447 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
36448 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
36449 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
36450 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
36451 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
36452 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
36453 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
36454 .code
36455 xrdb -merge <<End
36456 Eximon*highlight: gray
36457 End
36458 .endd
36459 .cindex "admin user"
36460 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
36461 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
36462
36463 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
36464 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
36465 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
36466 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
36467 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
36468
36469 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
36470 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
36471 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
36472 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
36473 different parts of the display.
36474
36475
36476
36477
36478 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
36479 .cindex "stripchart"
36480 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
36481 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36482 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
36483 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
36484 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
36485 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
36486 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
36487 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
36488 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36489
36490 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
36491 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
36492 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
36493 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
36494
36495 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
36496 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
36497 to a single partition.
36498
36499 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
36500 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
36501 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
36502 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
36503 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
36504 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
36505 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
36506
36507
36508
36509
36510 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
36511 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
36512 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
36513 .cindex "window size"
36514 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
36515 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
36516 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
36517 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
36518 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
36519 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
36520
36521 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
36522 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
36523 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
36524 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
36525
36526 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
36527 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
36528 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
36529 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
36530 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
36531 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36532
36533 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
36534 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
36535 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36536
36537
36538
36539 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
36540 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
36541 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
36542 the main log is maintained.
36543 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
36544 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
36545 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
36546 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
36547 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
36548
36549 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
36550 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
36551 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
36552 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
36553 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
36554 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
36555 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
36556 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
36557 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
36558 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
36559 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
36560
36561 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
36562 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
36563 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
36564 It cannot go further back up the log.
36565
36566 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
36567 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
36568 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
36569 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
36570 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
36571 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
36572
36573 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
36574 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
36575 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
36576 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
36577 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
36578 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
36579
36580 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
36581 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
36582 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
36583 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
36584 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
36585 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
36586 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
36587 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
36588 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
36589 window.
36590
36591
36592
36593 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
36594 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
36595 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
36596 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
36597 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
36598 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
36599 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
36600 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
36601 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
36602 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
36603
36604 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
36605 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
36606 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
36607 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
36608 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
36609 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
36610 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
36611
36612 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
36613 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
36614 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
36615 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
36616 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
36617 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
36618 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
36619
36620 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
36621 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
36622 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
36623 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
36624
36625 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
36626 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
36627 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
36628 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
36629 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
36630 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
36631 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
36632 not shown.
36633
36634 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
36635 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
36636
36637 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
36638 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
36639 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
36640 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
36641 display is updated.
36642
36643
36644
36645 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
36646 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
36647 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
36648 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
36649 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
36650 any selected text.
36651
36652 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
36653 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
36654 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
36655 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
36656 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
36657 .code
36658 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
36659 .endd
36660 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
36661 follows:
36662
36663 .ilist
36664 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
36665 in a new text window.
36666 .next
36667 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
36668 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
36669 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
36670 .next
36671 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
36672 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
36673 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
36674 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
36675 .next
36676 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
36677 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
36678 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
36679 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
36680 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
36681 .next
36682 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
36683 that the message be frozen.
36684 .next
36685 .cindex "thawing messages"
36686 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
36687 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
36688 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
36689 that the message be thawed.
36690 .next
36691 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
36692 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
36693 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
36694 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
36695 .next
36696 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
36697 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
36698 message.
36699 .next
36700 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
36701 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36702 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36703 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36704 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
36705 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
36706 which case no action is taken.
36707 .next
36708 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
36709 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
36710 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
36711 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
36712 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
36713 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
36714 case no action is taken.
36715 .next
36716 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
36717 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
36718 .next
36719 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
36720 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
36721 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
36722 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
36723 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
36724 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
36725 the address is qualified with that domain.
36726 .endlist
36727
36728 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
36729 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
36730 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
36731 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
36732 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
36733 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
36734 if no output is generated.
36735
36736 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
36737 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
36738 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
36739 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
36740
36741 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
36742 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
36743 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
36744 .ecindex IIDeximon
36745
36746
36747
36748
36749
36750 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36751 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36752
36753 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
36754 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
36755 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
36756 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
36757
36758 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
36759 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
36760 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
36761 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
36762 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
36763 its security as compared with other MTAs.
36764
36765 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
36766 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
36767 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
36768 as soon as possible.
36769
36770
36771 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
36772 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
36773 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
36774 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
36775 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
36776 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
36777
36778 .ilist
36779 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
36780 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
36781 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
36782 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
36783 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
36784 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
36785
36786 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
36787 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
36788 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
36789 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
36790 .next
36791
36792 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
36793 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
36794 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
36795 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
36796 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
36797 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
36798 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
36799 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
36800 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
36801 separate commands.
36802
36803 .next
36804 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
36805 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
36806 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
36807 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
36808 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
36809 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
36810 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
36811 .next
36812 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
36813 is disabled.
36814 .next
36815 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
36816 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
36817 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
36818 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
36819 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
36820 .endlist
36821
36822
36823
36824 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
36825 .cindex "setuid"
36826 .cindex "root privilege"
36827 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
36828 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
36829 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
36830 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
36831 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
36832 is required for two things:
36833
36834 .ilist
36835 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
36836 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
36837 not required.
36838 .next
36839 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
36840 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
36841 configuration.
36842 .endlist
36843
36844 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
36845 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
36846 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
36847 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
36848 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
36849 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
36850 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
36851 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
36852
36853 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
36854 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
36855 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
36856
36857 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
36858 uid and gid in the following cases:
36859
36860 .ilist
36861 .oindex "&%-C%&"
36862 .oindex "&%-D%&"
36863 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
36864 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
36865 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
36866 the calling process.
36867 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
36868 option may not be used at all.
36869 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
36870 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
36871 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
36872 .next
36873 .oindex "&%-be%&"
36874 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
36875 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
36876 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
36877 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
36878 calling process.
36879 .next
36880 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
36881 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
36882 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
36883 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
36884 testing address verification
36885 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
36886 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
36887 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
36888 option).
36889 .next
36890 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
36891 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
36892 .endlist
36893
36894 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
36895
36896 .ilist
36897 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
36898 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
36899 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
36900 will be used during message reception.
36901 .next
36902 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
36903 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
36904 .next
36905 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
36906 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
36907 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
36908 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
36909 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
36910 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
36911 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
36912 generating bounce and warning messages.
36913
36914 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
36915 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
36916 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
36917 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
36918 .next
36919 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
36920 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
36921 .endlist
36922
36923
36924
36925
36926 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
36927 .cindex "privilege, running without"
36928 .cindex "unprivileged running"
36929 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
36930 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
36931 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
36932 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
36933 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
36934 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
36935 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
36936 to any other uid.
36937
36938 .cindex SIGHUP
36939 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
36940 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
36941 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
36942 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
36943
36944 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
36945 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
36946 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
36947 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
36948 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
36949
36950 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
36951 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
36952 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
36953 effect.
36954
36955 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
36956 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
36957 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
36958
36959 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
36960 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
36961 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
36962 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
36963 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
36964 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
36965 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
36966 address this problem at this time.
36967
36968 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
36969 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
36970 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
36971 be used in the most straightforward way.
36972
36973 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
36974 number of restrictions on what you can do:
36975
36976 .ilist
36977 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
36978 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
36979 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
36980 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
36981 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
36982 .next
36983 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
36984 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
36985 .next
36986 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
36987 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
36988 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
36989 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
36990 .next
36991 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
36992 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
36993
36994 .olist
36995 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
36996 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
36997 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
36998 .next
36999 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
37000 owned by the Exim user.
37001 .next
37002 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
37003 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
37004 mailboxes need to be created manually.
37005 .endlist olist
37006 .endlist ilist
37007
37008
37009 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
37010 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
37011 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
37012 gives more security at essentially no cost.
37013
37014 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
37015 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
37016
37017
37018
37019
37020 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
37021 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
37022 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
37023
37024
37025
37026 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
37027 .cindex "security" "local commands"
37028 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
37029 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
37030 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
37031 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
37032 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
37033
37034 .ilist
37035 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
37036 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
37037 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
37038 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
37039 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
37040 .next
37041 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
37042 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
37043 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
37044 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
37045 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
37046 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
37047 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
37048 .next
37049 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
37050 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
37051 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
37052 .next
37053 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
37054 taint checking might apply to their usage.
37055 .next
37056 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
37057 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
37058 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
37059 .next
37060 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
37061 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
37062 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
37063 of opaque strings.
37064 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
37065 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
37066 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
37067 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
37068 .endlist
37069
37070
37071
37072
37073 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
37074 .cindex "security" "data sources"
37075 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
37076 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
37077 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
37078 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
37079 are some issues to be aware of:
37080
37081 .ilist
37082 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
37083 .next
37084 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
37085 .next
37086 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
37087 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
37088 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
37089 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
37090 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
37091 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
37092 data.
37093 .next
37094 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
37095 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
37096 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
37097 .next
37098 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
37099 expected to yield one result.
37100 .endlist
37101
37102
37103
37104
37105 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
37106 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
37107 .cindex "IP source routing"
37108 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
37109 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
37110 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
37111 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
37112
37113
37114
37115 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
37116 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
37117 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
37118
37119
37120
37121
37122 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
37123 .cindex "trusted users"
37124 .cindex "admin user"
37125 .cindex "privileged user"
37126 .cindex "user" "trusted"
37127 .cindex "user" "admin"
37128 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
37129 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
37130 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
37131 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
37132 permit a remote host to be specified.
37133
37134 .oindex "&%-f%&"
37135 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
37136 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
37137 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
37138 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
37139 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
37140 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
37141
37142 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
37143 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
37144 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
37145 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
37146 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
37147
37148 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
37149 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
37150 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
37151 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
37152 includes the contents of files on the spool.
37153
37154 .oindex "&%-M%&"
37155 .oindex "&%-q%&"
37156 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
37157 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
37158 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
37159 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
37160 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
37161 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
37162
37163 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
37164 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
37165 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
37166 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
37167 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
37168 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
37169 files.
37170
37171
37172
37173 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
37174 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
37175 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
37176 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
37177 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
37178 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
37179
37180
37181
37182 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
37183 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
37184 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
37185 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
37186 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
37187 this.
37188
37189
37190
37191 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
37192 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
37193 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
37194 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
37195 converted output.
37196
37197
37198
37199 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
37200 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
37201 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
37202 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
37203 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
37204
37205
37206
37207 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
37208 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
37209 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
37210 loading it.
37211
37212
37213 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
37214 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
37215 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
37216 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
37217 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
37218 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
37219 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
37220
37221 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
37222 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
37223 string.
37224
37225
37226
37227 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
37228 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
37229 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
37230 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
37231
37232
37233
37234 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
37235 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
37236 enough to hold the result.
37237 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
37238
37239
37240
37241
37242 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37243 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37244
37245 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
37246 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
37247 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
37248 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
37249 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
37250 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
37251 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
37252 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
37253 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
37254 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
37255 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
37256 themselves are recoverable.
37257
37258 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
37259 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
37260 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
37261
37262 .ilist
37263 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
37264 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
37265 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
37266 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
37267 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
37268 .next
37269 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
37270 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
37271 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
37272 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
37273 will always be the case.
37274 .next
37275 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
37276 .next
37277 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
37278 signature.
37279 .endlist
37280 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
37281
37282 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
37283 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
37284 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
37285 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
37286 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
37287 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
37288 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
37289 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
37290 attempt.
37291
37292 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
37293 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
37294 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
37295 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
37296 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
37297 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
37298 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
37299 normally the Exim user.
37300
37301 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
37302 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
37303 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
37304 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
37305 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
37306 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
37307 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
37308 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
37309
37310 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
37311 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
37312 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
37313 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
37314
37315 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
37316 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
37317
37318 .vlist
37319 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37320 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
37321 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
37322 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
37323 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
37324 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
37325 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
37326 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
37327 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
37328 newlines.
37329
37330 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37331 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
37332 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
37333 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37334 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37335 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37336
37337 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
37338 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
37339 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
37340 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
37341 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
37342 character. It may contain internal newlines.
37343
37344 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
37345 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
37346 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
37347
37348 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
37349 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
37350 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
37351 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
37352 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37353
37354 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
37355 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
37356 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
37357 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
37358 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
37359
37360 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
37361 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
37362 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
37363
37364 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
37365 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
37366 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
37367
37368 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37369 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
37370 present.
37371
37372 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
37373 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
37374 present if the number is greater than zero.
37375
37376 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
37377 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
37378 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
37379
37380 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
37381 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
37382 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
37383
37384 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37385 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
37386 command.
37387
37388 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37389 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
37390 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
37391 messages.
37392
37393 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
37394 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
37395 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
37396 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
37397
37398 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
37399 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
37400 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
37401
37402 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
37403 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
37404 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
37405 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
37406 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
37407 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
37408
37409 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
37410 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
37411 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
37412 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
37413 supplied by the remote host, if any.
37414
37415 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
37416 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
37417 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
37418 generated messages.
37419
37420 .vitem &%-local%&
37421 The message is from a local sender.
37422
37423 .vitem &%-localerror%&
37424 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
37425
37426 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
37427 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
37428 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
37429 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
37430
37431 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
37432 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
37433 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
37434
37435 .vitem &%-N%&
37436 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
37437 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
37438 &%-N%& is assumed.
37439
37440 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
37441 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
37442 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
37443
37444 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
37445 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
37446 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
37447
37448 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
37449 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
37450 of &$spam_score_int$&.
37451
37452 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
37453 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
37454 certificate was verified by the server.
37455
37456 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
37457 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
37458 name of the cipher suite that was used.
37459
37460 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
37461 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
37462 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
37463 certificate.
37464 .endlist
37465
37466 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
37467 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
37468 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
37469 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
37470 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
37471 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
37472 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
37473 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
37474 addresses are complete.
37475
37476 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
37477 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
37478 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
37479 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
37480 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
37481 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
37482 .code
37483 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
37484 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
37485 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37486 .endd
37487 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
37488 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
37489 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
37490 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
37491 example:
37492 .code
37493 4
37494 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37495 darcy@austen.fict.example
37496 rdo@foundation
37497 alice@wonderland.fict.example
37498 .endd
37499 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
37500 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
37501 line is of the following form:
37502 .display
37503 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
37504 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
37505 .endd
37506 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
37507 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
37508 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
37509 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
37510 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
37511 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
37512 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
37513 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
37514
37515
37516 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
37517 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
37518 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
37519 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
37520 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
37521 following:
37522
37523 .table2 50pt
37524 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
37525 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
37526 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
37527 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
37528 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
37529 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
37530 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
37531 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
37532 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
37533 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
37534 .endtable
37535
37536 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
37537 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
37538 typical set of headers:
37539 .code
37540 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
37541 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37542 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
37543 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
37544 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
37545 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
37546 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
37547 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37548 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
37549 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
37550 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
37551 .endd
37552 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
37553 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
37554 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
37555 .ecindex IIDforspo1
37556 .ecindex IIDforspo2
37557 .ecindex IIDforspo3
37558
37559 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37560 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37561
37562 .chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" "CHAPdkim" &&&
37563 "DKIM Support"
37564 .cindex "DKIM"
37565
37566 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
37567 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
37568 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
37569 DKIM is documented in RFC 4871.
37570
37571 Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
37572 disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
37573
37574 Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
37575 .olist
37576 Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
37577 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
37578 (including transport filters)
37579 except cutthrough delivery.
37580 .next
37581 Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
37582 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
37583 different signature contexts.
37584 .endlist
37585
37586 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
37587 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
37588 Exim's standard controls.
37589
37590 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
37591 on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
37592 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
37593 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
37594 .code
37595 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
37596 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
37597 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
37598 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
37599 .endd
37600 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
37601 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
37602 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
37603 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
37604 senders).
37605
37606
37607 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
37608 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
37609
37610 Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
37611 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
37612
37613 .option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
37614 MANDATORY:
37615 The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
37616 option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
37617
37618 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
37619 MANDATORY:
37620 This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
37621 variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
37622 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
37623 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
37624
37625 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
37626 MANDATORY:
37627 This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
37628 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
37629 The result can either
37630 .ilist
37631 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
37632 .next
37633 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
37634 the private key.
37635 .next
37636 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
37637 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
37638 is set.
37639 .endlist
37640
37641 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
37642 OPTIONAL:
37643 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
37644 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
37645 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
37646 only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
37647
37648 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
37649 OPTIONAL:
37650 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
37651 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
37652 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
37653 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
37654 variables here.
37655
37656 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
37657 OPTIONAL:
37658 When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
37659 list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
37660 signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
37661 used.
37662
37663
37664 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
37665 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
37666
37667 Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
37668 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
37669 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
37670 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
37671 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
37672 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message it is
37673 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
37674
37675 To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
37676 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
37677 runtime of the ACL.
37678
37679 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
37680 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
37681 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
37682 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
37683
37684 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
37685 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
37686 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
37687 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
37688 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
37689 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
37690 it defaults as:
37691 .code
37692 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
37693 .endd
37694 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
37695 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
37696 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
37697 .code
37698 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
37699 .endd
37700 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
37701 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
37702 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
37703 .code
37704 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
37705 .endd
37706
37707 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
37708 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
37709
37710
37711 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
37712 available (from most to least important):
37713
37714
37715 .vlist
37716 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
37717 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
37718 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
37719 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
37720 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
37721 A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
37722 .ilist
37723 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
37724 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37725 .next
37726 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
37727 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37728 .next
37729 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
37730 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
37731 .next
37732 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
37733 .endlist
37734 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
37735 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
37736 "fail" or "invalid". One of
37737 .ilist
37738 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
37739 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
37740 .next
37741 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
37742 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
37743 .next
37744 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
37745 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
37746 means that the message body was modified in transit.
37747 .next
37748 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
37749 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
37750 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
37751 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
37752 .endlist
37753 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
37754 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
37755 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
37756 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37757 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
37758 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
37759 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
37760 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
37761 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
37762 The key record selector string.
37763 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
37764 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
37765 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
37766 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37767 .vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
37768 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
37769 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
37770 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
37771 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
37772 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
37773 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
37774 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
37775 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
37776 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
37777 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
37778 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
37779 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
37780 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
37781 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
37782 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
37783 integer size comparisons against this value.
37784 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
37785 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
37786 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
37787 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
37788 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
37789 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
37790 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
37791 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37792 in the key record.
37793 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
37794 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
37795 in the key record.
37796 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
37797 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
37798 .endlist
37799
37800 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
37801
37802 .vlist
37803 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
37804 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
37805 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
37806 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
37807 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
37808
37809 .code
37810 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no signature at all
37811 warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
37812 sender_domains = gmail.com
37813 dkim_signers = gmail.com
37814 dkim_status = none
37815 .endd
37816
37817 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
37818 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
37819 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
37820 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
37821
37822 .code
37823 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
37824 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
37825 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
37826 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
37827 .endd
37828
37829 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
37830 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
37831 for more information of what they mean.
37832 .endlist
37833
37834 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37835 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37836
37837 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
37838 "Adding drivers or lookups"
37839 .cindex "adding drivers"
37840 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
37841 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
37842 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
37843 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
37844
37845 .olist
37846 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
37847 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
37848 .next
37849 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
37850 .display
37851 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
37852 .endd
37853 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
37854 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
37855 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
37856 .next
37857 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
37858 .code
37859 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
37860 .endd
37861 .next
37862 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
37863 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
37864 .next
37865 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
37866 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
37867 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
37868 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
37869 simple form that most lookups have.
37870 .next
37871 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
37872 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
37873 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
37874 .next
37875 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
37876 &_src_&.
37877 .next
37878 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
37879 as for other drivers and lookups.
37880 .endlist
37881
37882 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
37883 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
37884 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
37885 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
37886 searched using a binary chop procedure.
37887
37888 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
37889 the interface that is expected.
37890
37891
37892
37893
37894 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37895 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37896
37897 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37898 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
37899 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
37900 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
37901 . processors.
37902 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37903
37904 .literal xml
37905 <?sdop
37906 format="newpage"
37907 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
37908 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
37909 ?>
37910 .literal off
37911
37912 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
37913 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
37914 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
37915
37916
37917 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37918 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////